L1000a - TM - en - Siep C710616 33G - 6 - 0
L1000a - TM - en - Siep C710616 33G - 6 - 0
L1000a - TM - en - Siep C710616 33G - 6 - 0
To properly use the product, read this manual thoroughly and retain for
easy reference, inspection, and maintenance. Ensure the end user receives
this manual.
Receiving 1
Mechanical Installation 2
Electrical Installation 3
Start-Up Programming &
Operation 4
Parameter Details 5
Troubleshooting 6
Periodic Inspection &
Maintenance 7
Peripheral Devices &
Options 8
Specifications A
Parameter List B
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications C
Standards Compliance D
MANUAL NO. SIEP C710616 33G Quick Reference Sheet E
Copyright © 2009 YASKAWA ELECTRIC CORPORATION.
All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted,
in any form, or by any means, mechanical, electronic, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, without the prior
written permission of Yaskawa. No patent liability is assumed with respect to the use of the information
contained herein. Moreover, because Yaskawa is constantly striving to improve its high-quality products, the
information contained in this manual is subject to change without notice. Every precaution has been taken in
the preparation of this manual. Nevertheless, Yaskawa assumes no responsibility for errors or omissions.
Neither is any liability assumed for damages resulting from the use of the information contained in this
publication.
2 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Quick Reference
Drive a Synchronous PM Motor
L1000A can operate synchronous PM motors. Refer to Flowchart C: Auto-Tuning for PM Motors on page 97.
Perform Auto-Tuning
Automatic tuning sets motor parameters. Refer to Types of Auto-Tuning on page 99.
Standards Compliance
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 3
4 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Table of Contents
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
1. RECEIVING .......................................................................................................... 23
1.1 Section Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
1.2 General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
L1000A Model Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Control Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
1.3 Model Number and Nameplate Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Nameplate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Model Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
1.4 Component Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Exploded Views of Drive Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Front Views . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
3. ELECTRICAL INSTALLATION............................................................................ 45
3.1 Section Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
3.2 Standard Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
3.3 Main Circuit Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
3.4 Terminal Block Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 5
3.5 Terminal Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Removing/Reattaching the Terminal Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
3.6 Digital Operator and Front Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Removing/Reattaching the Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Removing/Reattaching the Front Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Main Circuit Terminal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Wire Gauges and Tightening Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Main Circuit Terminal and Motor Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Control Circuit Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Control Circuit Terminal Block Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Terminal Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Wiring the Control Circuit Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Switches and Jumpers on the Terminal Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
3.9 Control I/O Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Setting Sink/Source with Input Terminals SN and SP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Sinking/Sourcing Mode Selection for Safe Disable Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
MEMOBUS/Modbus Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
3.10 Connect to a PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
3.11 Wiring Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
6 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Up and Down Commands and Speed Reference Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Speed Selection Using Digital Inputs (b1-01 = 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Multi-Function Terminal Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Accel/Decel Ramp and Jerk Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Elevator Emergency Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Inspection Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Brake Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Adjustments for Elevator Ride Comfort . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Rescue Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
4.7 Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Cannot Change Parameter Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Motor Does Not Rotate Properly after Pressing RUN Button or
after Entering External Up/Down Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Motor is Too Hot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Drive Does Not Allow Selection the Desired Auto-Tuning Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Encoder Offset (E5-11) Set During Auto-Tuning (Rotational or Stationary)
Consistently Differs by 30 Degrees or More . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Electrical Noise From Drive or Output Lines When the Drive is Operating . . . . . . . . 138
A Residual Current Device (RCD, RCM) Trips during Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
The Safety Controller Does Not Recognize Safe Disable Monitor Output Signals
(Terminals DM+ and DM-) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Riding Comfort Related Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
4.8 Verifying Parameter Settings and Backing Up Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Backing Up Parameter Values: o2-03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Parameter Access Level: A1-01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Password Settings: A1-04, A1-05 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Copy Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 7
5.6 F: Option Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
F1: Encoder/PG Feedback Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
F3: Digital Input Card Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
F4: Analog Monitor Card Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
F5: Digital Output Card Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
F6: Communication Option Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
CANopen Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
5.7 H: Terminal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
H1: Multi-Function Digital Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
H2: Multi-Function Digital Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
H3: Multi-Function Analog Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
H4: Multi-Function Analog Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
H5: MEMOBUS/Modbus Serial Communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
5.8 L: Protection Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
L1: Motor Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
L2: Undervoltage Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
L3: Stall Prevention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
L4: Speed Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
L5: Automatic Fault Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
L6: Torque Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
L7: Torque Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
L8: Drive Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
5.9 n: Special Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
n1: Hunting Prevention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
n2: Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
n5: Inertia Compensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
n6: Online Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
n8: PM Motor Control Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
n9: Current Detection Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
o1: Digital Operator Display Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
o2: Digital Operator Keypad Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
o3: Copy Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
o4: Maintenance Monitor Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
S1: Brake Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
S2: Slip Compensation for Elevators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
S3: Start/Stop Optimization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
S4: Rescue Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
S5: Short Floor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
S6: Faults for Elevator Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
T: Motor Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
5.12 U: Monitor Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
U1: Operation Status Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
U2: Fault Trace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
U3: Fault History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
U4: Maintenance Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
U6: Control Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
6. TROUBLESHOOTING........................................................................................ 251
6.1 Section Safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Types of Alarms, Faults, and Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Alarm and Error Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
6.3 Fault Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
8 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Fault Displays, Causes, and Possible Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
6.4 Alarm Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
Alarm Codes, Causes, and Possible Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
6.5 Operator Programming Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
oPE Codes, Causes, and Possible Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
6.6 Auto-Tuning Fault Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Auto-Tuning Codes, Causes, and Possible Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
6.7 Copy Function Related Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Tasks, Errors, and Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
6.8 Diagnosing and Resetting Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Fault Occurs Simultaneously with Power Loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
If the Drive Still has Power After a Fault Occurs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Viewing Fault Trace Data After Fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Fault Reset Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
A. SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................................. 335
A.1 Three-Phase 200 V Class Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
A.2 Three-Phase 400 V Class Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 9
A.3 Drive Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
A.4 Drive Watt Loss Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
A.5 Drive Derating Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
Rated Current Depending on Carrier Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
Carrier Frequency Derating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
Temperature Derating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
Altitude Derating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
10 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Reading Drive MEMOBUS/Modbus Register Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403
Loopback Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403
Writing to Multiple Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404
Torque Compensation Through MEMOBUS/Modbus Communications . . . . . . . . . . 404
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405
Command Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405
Monitor Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
Broadcast Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413
Fault Trace Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413
Alarm Register Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
C.10 Enter Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
Enter Command Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
Parameter H5-11 and the Enter Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
C.11 Communication Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
MEMOBUS/Modbus Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
Slave Not Responding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
C.12 Self-Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 11
12 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
i
Preface & General Safety
This section provides safety messages pertinent to this product that, if not heeded, may result
in fatality, personal injury, or equipment damage. Yaskawa is not responsible for the
consequences of ignoring these instructions.
i.1 PREFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
i.2 GENERAL SAFETY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 13
i.1 Preface
i.1 Preface
Yaskawa manufactures products used as components in a wide variety of industrial systems and equipment. The selection
and application of Yaskawa products remain the responsibility of the equipment manufacturer or end user. Yaskawa
accepts no responsibility for the way its products are incorporated into the final system design. Under no circumstances
should any Yaskawa product be incorporated into any product or design as the exclusive or sole safety control. Without
exception, all controls should be designed to detect faults dynamically and fail safely under all circumstances. All
systems or equipment designed to incorporate a product manufactured by Yaskawa must be supplied to the end user with
appropriate warnings and instructions as to the safe use and operation of that part. Any warnings provided by Yaskawa
must be promptly provided to the end user. Yaskawa offers an express warranty only as to the quality of its products in
conforming to standards and specifications published in the Yaskawa manual. NO OTHER WARRANTY, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, IS OFFERED. Yaskawa assumes no liability for any personal injury, property damage, losses, or claims
arising from misapplication of its products.
This manual is designed to ensure correct and suitable application of L1000A-Series Drives. Read this manual before
attempting to install, operate, maintain, or inspect a drive and keep it in a safe, convenient location for future reference.
Be sure you understand all precautions and safety information before attempting application.
Applicable Documentation
The following manuals are available for L1000A series drives:
Read this manual first. This guide is packaged together with the product. It contains basic information required to install and wire
the drive, in addition to an overview of fault diagnostics, maintenance, and parameter settings. Use the information in this book to
F1 F2
YEG
LO
ESC
RE
prepare the drive for a trial run with the application and for basic operation.
RESET ENTER
RUN STOP
CIMR-AA2A0021FAA
200V 3Phase 5.5kW/3.7kW
S/N:
This manual provides detailed information on parameter settings, drive functions, and MEMOBUS/Modbus specifications. Use
٨ ⸅ࠄߥߢߊߛߐޕ
this manual to expand drive functionality and to take advantage of higher performance features.
Symbols
Note: Indicates a supplement or precaution that does not cause drive damage.
Trademarks
• EnDat is a trademark of Heidenhain Corporation.
• HIPERFACE is a trademark of SICK STEGMANN GmbH & Co., KG.
• CANopen is a trademark of CAN in Automation (CiA).
• Other companies and product names mentioned in this manual are trademarks of those companies.
14 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
i.2 General Safety
WARNING
Read and understand this manual before installing, operating or servicing this drive. The drive must be installed
according to this manual and local codes.
The following conventions are used to indicate safety messages in this manual. Failure to heed these messages could
result in serious or fatal injury or damage to the products or to related equipment and systems.
DANGER
Indicates a hazardous situation, which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.
WARNING
Indicates a hazardous situation, which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.
WARNING! may also be indicated by a bold key word embedded in the text followed by an italicized safety message.
CAUTION
Indicates a hazardous situation, which, if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate injury.
CAUTION! may also be indicated by a bold key word embedded in the text followed by an italicized safety message.
NOTICE
Indicates a property damage message.
NOTICE: may also be indicated by a bold key word embedded in the text followed by an italicized safety message.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 15
i.2 General Safety
Safety Messages
DANGER
Heed the safety messages in this manual.
Failure to comply will result in death or serious injury.
The operating company is responsible for any injuries or equipment damage resulting from failure to heed the warnings
in this manual.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not connect or disconnect wiring or service the drive while the power is on.
Failure to comply will result in death or serious injury.
Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment. The internal capacitor remains charged even after the power
supply is turned off. After shutting off the power, wait for at least the amount of time specified on the drive before
touching any components.
WARNING
Sudden Movement Hazard
The drive system or elevator may start unexpectedly upon application of power, resulting in death or serious
injury.
• Clear all personnel from the drive, motor, and machine area before applying power.
• Secure covers, couplings, shaft keys, and machine loads before applying power to the drive.
Ensure there are no short circuits between the main circuit terminals (R/L1, S/L2, and T/L3) or between the
ground and main circuit terminals before restarting the drive.
Failure to comply may result in serious injury or death and will cause damage to equipment.
System may start unexpectedly upon application of power when the Auto-restart function is enabled resulting in
death or serious injury.
Use care when enabling Auto-restart as this function may cause unintended start of the elevator.
Use parameter S1-12 to enable/disable automatic switching of the Motor Contactor Control output signal
during Auto-Tuning.
When using setting S1-12 = 1 or 2, ensure that the multi-function output terminals are properly wired and in the correct
state before setting parameter S1-12.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive, serious injury or death.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not attempt to modify or alter the drive in any way not explained in this manual.
Yaskawa is not responsible for damage caused by modification of the product made by the user. Failure to comply
could result in death or serious injury from operation of damaged equipment.
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
16 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
i.2 General Safety
WARNING
When a drive is running a PM motor, voltage continues to be generated at the motor terminals after the drive is
shut off while the motor coasts to stop. Take the precautions described below to prevent shock and injury:
• In applications where the machine can still rotate even though the drive has fully stopped a load, install a switch to
the drive output side to disconnect the motor and the drive.
• Do not allow an external force to rotate the motor beyond the maximum allowable speed or to rotate the motor when
the drive has been shut off.
• Wait for at least the time specified on the warning label after opening the load switch on the output side before
inspecting the drive or performing any maintenance.
• Do not open and close the load switch while the motor is running, as this can damage the drive.
If the motor is coasting, make sure the power to the drive is turned on and the drive output has completely stopped
before closing the load switch.
Do not connect or disconnect wiring to the drive or motor while the power is on.
Failure to comply will result in death or serious injury. Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment. The
internal capacitor remains charged even after the power supply is turned off. The charge indicator LED will extinguish
when the DC bus voltage is below 50 Vdc. To prevent electric shock, wait at least five minutes after all indicators are
OFF and measure the DC bus voltage level to confirm safe level.
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing, and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Do not change wiring, remove covers, connectors or options cards, or attempt to service the drive with power
applied to the drive.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all power to the drive and check for unsafe
voltages before servicing.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
Fire Hazard
Drive Short-Circuit Current Rating
Install adequate branch circuit protection according to applicable local codes and this Installation Manual.
Failure to comply could result in fire and damage to the drive or injury to personnel.
The device is suitable for use on a circuit capable of delivering not more than 100,000 RMS symmetrical amperes, 240
Vac maximum (200 V class) and 480 Vac maximum (400 V class), and 600 Vac maximum (600 V class) when
protected by branch circuit protection devices specified in this manual.
Applications using a braking option should wire a thermal relay so that the output contactor opens when the
thermal relay trips.
Inadequate braking circuit protection could result in death or serious injury by fire from overheating resistors.
Do not use improper combustible materials.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire.
Attach the drive to metal or other noncombustible material.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 17
i.2 General Safety
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Do not modify the drive circuitry.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive and will void warranty.
Yaskawa is not responsible for any modification of the product made by the user. This product must not be modified.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive or braking circuit.
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive, circuit boards, and option
cards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Do not operate damaged equipment.
Failure to comply could result in further damage to the equipment.
Do not connect or operate any equipment with visible damage or missing parts.
Do not lift the drive up while the cover is removed.
This can damage the terminal board and other components.
Do not expose the drive to halogen group disinfectants.
Failure to comply may cause damage to the electrical components in the drive.
Do not pack the drive in wooden materials that have been fumigated or sterilized.
Do not sterilize the entire package after the product is packed.
18 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
i.2 General Safety
Settings
DC Injection Braking
NOTICE: Excessive current during DC Injection Braking and excessive duration of DC Injection Braking can cause motor overheating.
Adjust DC Injection parameters to prevent motor overheating.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 19
i.2 General Safety
Acceleration/Deceleration Ramp
Acceleration and deceleration times are affected by the amount of torque generated by the motor, the load torque, and the
inertia moment. Set a longer accel/decel time when Stall Prevention is enabled. The accel/decel times are lengthened for
as long as the Stall Prevention function is in operation. Install one of the available braking options or increase the
capacity of the drive for faster acceleration and deceleration.
General Handling
Selecting a Molded Case Circuit Breaker or RCD/RCM Devices
Where an RCD (residual current device) or RCM (residual current monitor) at the drive power supply side is used for
protection in case of direct or indirect contact, only an RCD or RCM of type B according to IEC/EN 60755 is allowed.
Select a MCCB (Molded Case Circuit Breaker) or RCD/RCM with a rated current that is 1.5 to 2 times higher than the
rated current of the drive in order to avoid nuisance trips caused by harmonics in the drive input current. Also refer to
Installing a Molded Case Circuit Breaker (MCCB) on page 328.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Install a properly controlled contactor on the input-side of the drive for applications where
power should be removed from the drive during a fault condition. Improper equipment sequencing could result in death or serious
injury.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Shut off the drive with a magnetic contactor (MC) when a fault occurs in any external equipment such as
braking resistors. Refer to Installing a Magnetic Contactor at the Power Supply Side on page 329. Failure to comply may cause
resistor overheating, fire, and injury to personnel.
NOTICE: To get the full performance life out of the electrolytic capacitors and circuit relays, refrain from switching the drive power
supply off and on more than once every 30 minutes. Frequent use can damage the drive. Use the drive to stop and start the motor.
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Because the heatsink can get very hot during operation, take proper precautions to prevent burns. When
replacing the cooling fan, shut off the power and wait at least 15 minutes to be sure that the heatsink has cooled down. Failure to
comply may cause burn injury to personnel.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. When a drive is running a PM motor, voltage continues to be generated at the motor terminals
after the drive is shut off while the motor coasts to stop. Take the precautions described below to prevent shock and injury:
• In applications where the machine can still rotate after the drive has fully stopped a load, install a load disconnect
switch on the drive output side to disconnect the motor and the drive.
• Do not allow an external force to rotate the motor beyond the maximum allowable speed or to rotate the motor when
the drive is powered off.
• Wait for at least the time specified on the warning label after opening the load switch on the output side before
inspecting the drive or performing any maintenance.
• Do not open and close the load switch while the motor is running.
• If the motor is coasting, make sure the power to the drive is turned on and the drive output has completely stopped
before closing the load switch to reconnect the drive to the motor.
Wiring
Yaskawa recommends using ring terminals on all drive models for UL/cUL compliance. Use only the tools
recommended by the terminal manufacturer for crimping.
Transporting the Drive
NOTICE: Never steam clean the drive. During transport, keep the drive from coming into contact with salts, fluorine, bromine,
phthalate ester, and other such harmful chemicals. Failure to comply may damage the drive.
20 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
i.2 General Safety
NOTICE: Ensure that the motor is suitable for inverter duty and/or the motor service factor is adequate to accommodate the additional
heating with the intended operating conditions. A motor connected to a PWM drive may operate at a higher temperature than a utility-
fed motor and the operating speed range may reduce motor cooling capacity.
High-Speed Operation
NOTICE: Mechanical damage may occur with the motor bearings and dynamic balance of the machine when operating a motor
beyond its rated speed. Operate the motor within specifications to prevent motor damage.
Low-Speed Range
The cooling fan of a standard motor should sufficiently cool the motor at the rated speed. As the self-cooling capability
of such a motor reduces with the speed, applying full torque at low speed will possibly damage the motor. Reduce the
load torque as the motor slows to prevent motor damage from overheat. Use a motor designed specifically for operation
with a drive when 100% continuous torque is needed at low speeds.
Torque Characteristics
Torque characteristics differ compared to operating the motor directly from line power. The user should have a full
understanding of the load torque characteristics for the application.
Vibration and Shock
The drive allows selection of high carrier PWM control and low carrier PWM control. Selecting high carrier PWM can
help reduce motor oscillation.
If resonance occurs, install shock-absorbing rubber mounts around the base of the motor and utilize the Jump frequency
selection to prevent continuous operation in the resonant frequency ranges.
Audible Noise
Noise created during run varies by the carrier frequency setting. When using a high carrier frequency, audible noise from
the motor is comparable to the motor noise generated when running from line power. Operating above the rated r/min,
however, can create unpleasant motor noise.
Precautions for PM Motors
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Improper sequencing of output motor circuits could result in damage to the drive. Do not connect
electromagnetic switches or magnetic contactors to the output motor circuits without proper sequencing. Do not open the main circuit
between the drive and the motor while the PM motor is rotating.
• Contact Yaskawa or your Yaskawa agent if you plan to use any PM motor not endorsed by Yaskawa.
• When using a holding brake, release the brake prior to starting the motor. Failure to set the proper timing can result in
speed loss.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Use the Initial Pole Search Status Signal (H2-= 61) to interlock the brake to ensure the
brake is not released before the Initial Magnetic Pole Search is completed. Failure to comply may cause inadvertent elevator
movement resulting in serious injury.
This safety message is applicable under these conditions:
• When applying a PM motor, with an external brake sequence, and the PG-F3 option is not being used.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. The motor must be at a complete stop before performing any maintenance, inspection, or wiring.
• With a PM motor, drive output must be fully interrupted when the power is shut off and the motor is still rotating.
Failure to comply can result in personal injury from electrical shock.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 21
i.2 General Safety
WARNING
Risk of electric shock.
●
Read manual before installing.
●
Wait 5 minutes for capacitor
discharge after disconnecting
power supply.
●
To conform to requirements,
make sure to ground the supply
neutral for 400V class.
● After opening the manual switch
between the drive and motor,
please wait 5 minutes before
inspecting, performing
maintenance or wiring the drive.
Hot surfaces
●
Top and Side surfaces may
become hot. Do not touch.
Figure i.1 Warning Information
Figure i.2
YEG
F1 F2
LO
ESC
RE
RESET ENTER
RUN STOP
CIMR-AA2A0021FAA
200V 3Phase 5.5kW/3.7kW
S/N:
Warning Label
maintenance or wiring the drive. câblage du variateur.
Hot surfaces Surfaces Chaudes
●
Top and Side surfaces may ● Dessus et cotés du boitier Peuvent
become hot. Do not touch. devenir chaud. Ne Pas toucher.
危 険
けが.感電のおそれがあります。
● ● 据え付け、運転の前には必ず取扱説明書を読むこと。
●
● 通電中および電源遮断後5分以内はフロントカバー
を外さない事。
●
● 400V級インバータの場合は、電源の中性点が接地
されていることを確認すること。( 対応)
● 保守・点検、配線を行う場合は、出力側開閉器を
遮断後5分待って実施してください。
高温注意
● インバータ上部、両側面は高温になります。
● 触らないでください。
22 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1
Receiving
This chapter explains how to inspect the drive upon receipt, and gives an overview of the
different enclosure types and components.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 23
1.1 Section Safety
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Do not connect electromagnetic switches or magnetic contactors to the output motor circuits without proper
sequencing.
Improper sequencing of output motor circuits could result in damage to the drive.
Do not open the main circuit between the drive and the motor while the PM motor is rotating.
Improper sequencing of output motor circuits could result in damage to the drive.
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
A motor connected to a PWM drive may operate at a higher temperature than a utility-fed motor and the
operating speed range may reduce motor cooling capacity.
Ensure that the motor is suitable for drive duty and/or the motor service factor is adequate to accommodate the
additional heating with the intended operating conditions.
24 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1.2 General Description
<1> These values assume the carrier frequency is not set higher than 8 kHz.
<2> These values assume the carrier frequency is not set higher than 5 kHz.
Note: The drive automatically decreases the rated output current when setting higher carrier frequency.
Receiving
1
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 25
1.2 General Description
<1> For drives with B or earlier as the design revision order, 50 Hz is required. The design revision order and software version are printed on the
nameplate affixed to the side of the drive. Refer to Model Number on page 28 for details.
26 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1.3 Model Number and Nameplate Check
YEG
Quick Start Guide
Quantity 1 1 1
Nameplate
Figure 1.1
YEG
Receiving
INPUT : AC3PH 380-480V 50/60Hz 10.4A
IND.CONT.EQ.
Output specifications OUTPUT : AC3PH 0-480V 0-200Hz 9.2A 7J48
MASS : 3.5 kg PRG : 7010 Software version
Lot number O/N :
Serial number S/N :
<1> The address of the head office of Yaskawa Electric Corporation (responsible for
product liability) is shown on the nameplate.
Figure 1.1 Nameplate Information
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 27
1.3 Model Number and Nameplate Check
Model Number
CIMR - L C 4 A 0009 B A A
Drive L1000A Customized Enclosure Design
No. No. Type
Series Specifications Revision
A Standard model B IP20 <1> Order
No. Region
Code
Models in C IP20 <2>
C Europe compliance with
F IEC/EN 61508
SIL3 Safety
Integrity Level 3 Environmental
No.
Specification <3>
A Standard
YEG No.
2
Voltage Class
3-phase, 200-240 Vac
4 3-phase, 380-480 Vac
Refer to Table 1.3.
<1> These units fulfill IP20 requirements and provide wire bending space (space between terminals and cable entry point) as
recommended in the IEC/EN 61800-5.
<2> These units fulfill IP20 requirements, but the wire bending space provided is lower than recommended in the IEC/EN 61800-5.
<3> Contact Yaskawa for information about using drives in environments other than specified in this manual.
28 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1.4 Component Names
YEG
A
D
I
J
E
Receiving
K
F
L 1
G M
<1> Drive models CIMR-L20018B, 40006B, and 40009B have a single cooling fan.
Drive models CIMR-L20008B, 20011B, and 40005B do not have a cooling fan or fan
finger guard.
Figure 1.2 Exploded View of Drive Components (CIMR-L20025B)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 29
1.4 Component Names
A YEG
G
F
J
H K
E
L
I
O M
N
30 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1.4 Component Names
E YEG
A
B
G
H
I
D L
K
P
M
N
Receiving
A – Mounting hole I – USB port (type-B)
B – Heatsink J – Digital operator 1
C – Port CN19 cover K – Front cover screw
D – Terminal board L – Drive cover
E – Fan finger guard M – Terminal cover
F – Cooling fan N – Bottom front cover
G – Fan unit O – Bottom cover
H – Front cover P – Rubber bussing
Figure 1.4 Exploded View of Drive Components (CIMR-L20150C)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 31
1.4 Component Names
A YEG
B
G
C
H
I
J K
P
N
O
<1> Drive models CIMR-L20346C and 20415C come with a built-in circulation fan.
Figure 1.5 Exploded View of Drive Components (CIMR-L20216C)
32 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1.4 Component Names
Front Views
Figure 1.6
CIMR-L20018B CIMR-L20145C
H
H
I
I A
J
A B
C
J
K
B
D
C E
D
K
F
F
YEG
Receiving
1
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 33
1.4 Component Names
34 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
2
Mechanical Installation
This chapter explains how to properly mount and install the drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 35
2.1 Section Safety
CAUTION
Crush Hazard
Do not carry the drive by the front cover or the terminal cover.
Failure to comply may result in minor or moderate injury from the main body of the drive falling.
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Prevent foreign matter such as metal shavings or wire clippings from falling into the drive during drive
installation and project construction.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive.
Place a temporary cover over the top during installation. Be sure to remove the temporary cover before start-up, as the
cover will reduce ventilation and cause the unit to overheat.
Observe proper electrostatic discharge (ESD) procedures when handling the drive.
Failure to comply could result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Operating the motor in the low-speed range diminishes the cooling effects, increases motor temperature, and
may lead to motor damage by overheating.
Reduce the motor torque in the low-speed range whenever using a standard blower cooled motor. If 100% torque is
required continuously at low speed, consider using a special drive or vector-control motor.
The speed range for continuous operation differs according to the lubrication method and motor manufacturer.
If the motor is to be operated at a speed higher than the rated speed, consult with the manufacturer.
Continuously operating an oil-lubricated motor in the low-speed range may result in motor failure.
When the input voltage is 440 V or higher or the wiring distance is greater than 100 meters, pay special
attention to the motor insulation voltage or use a drive-rated motor with reinforced insulation.
Failure to comply could lead to motor winding failure.
Motor vibration may increase when operating a machine in variable-speed mode, if that machine previously
operated at a constant speed.
Install vibration-proof rubber on the motor base.
The motor may require more acceleration torque with drive operation than with a commercial power supply.
Set a proper V/f pattern by checking the load torque characteristics of the machine to be used with the motor.
Never lift the drive up while the cover is removed.
This can damage the terminal board and other components.
Improper application of peripheral devices could result in malfunction of drive due to electrical interference.
Follow manufacturers recommendations when installing electrical devices near the drive and take precautions to shield
the drive from electrical interference.
36 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
2.2 Mechanical Installation
Installation Environment
Install the drive in an environment matching the specifications below to help prolong the optimum performance life of
the drive.
Table 2.1 Installation Environment
Environment Conditions
Installation Area Indoors
IP20 enclosure: -10 to +50C
Drive reliability improves in environments without wide temperature fluctuations.
Ambient Temperature When using the drive in an enclosure panel, install a cooling fan or air conditioner in the area to ensure that the air temperature inside the enclosure
does not exceed the specified levels.
Do not allow ice to develop on the drive.
Humidity 95% RH or less and free of condensation
Storage Temperature -20 to 60C
Install the drive in an area free from:
• oil mist and dust
• metal shavings, oil, water or other foreign materials
• radioactive materials
Surrounding Area • combustible materials (e.g., wood)
• harmful gases and liquids
• excessive vibration
• chlorides
• direct sunlight
Altitude 1000 m or lower, up to 3000 m with derating (Refer to Drive Derating Data on page 340.)
10 to 20 Hz at 9.8 m/s2
Vibration 20 to 55 Hz at 5.9 m/s2 (CIMR-L20008 to 20180, 40005 to 40150)
2.0 m/s2 (CIMR-L20215 to 20415, CIMR-L40180 to 40216)
Orientation Install the drive vertically to maintain maximum cooling effects.
NOTICE: Avoid placing drive peripheral devices, transformers, or other electronics near the drive as the noise created can lead to
erroneous operation. If such devices must be used in close proximity to the drive, take proper steps to shield the drive from noise.
NOTICE: Prevent foreign matter such as metal shavings and wire clippings from falling into the drive during installation. Failure to
comply could result in damage to the drive. Place a temporary cover over the top of the drive during installation. Remove the
temporary cover before startup, as the cover will reduce ventilation and cause the drive to overheat.
Mechanical
Installation
2
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 37
2.2 Mechanical Installation
Installation Orientation
Install the drive upright as illustrated in Figure 2.1 to maintain proper cooling. Refer to Mechanical Installation on
page 37 for details on installing the drive.
Figure 2.1
OK Not OK Not OK
Installation Spacing
Figure 2.2 shows the installation distance required to maintain sufficient space for airflow and wiring.
Figure 2.2
A C
YEG
B B
C
D D
A
38 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
2.2 Mechanical Installation
Instructions on Installation
Eye bolts are used to install the drive or to temporarily lift the drive when replacing it. The drive can be installed in an
enclosure panel or on a wall. Do not leave the drive suspended by the wires in a horizontal or vertical position for long
periods of time. Do not transport the drive over long distances. Read the following precautions and instructions before
installing the drives.
WARNING! Be sure to observe the following instructions and precautions. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury
and damage to the drive from falling equipment.
• Before using wires to suspend the drive vertically and horizontally, make sure that the drive front cover,
terminal blocks and other drive components are securely fixed with screws.
• Do not subject the drive to vibration or impact greater than 1.96 m/s2 (0.2 G) while it is suspended by the
wires.
• Do not overturn the drive while it is suspended by the wires.
• Do not leave the drive suspended by the wires for long periods of time.
A B C D
A – No space between drive and washer C – Space between drive and washer
B – Spring washer: Fully closed D – Spring washer: Open
Figure 2.3 Details of Spring Washers
Mechanical
Installation
Vertical Suspension of the Drive (CIMR-L20346, 20415, 40216)
When vertical suspension of the drive is required in an enclosure panel, the orientation of the eye bolts for these drive
models can be easily changed by turning the eye bolts counterclockwise 90 degrees. 2
Figure 2.4
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 39
2.2 Mechanical Installation
Drive Operator
Comm Port
S / N : J007XE273710001
common_
TMonly
Communication Cable Connector
S / N : J007XE273710001
90
78
15
7.9 44
60
Minimum
50 Unit: mm
40 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
2.2 Mechanical Installation
NOTICE: Prevent foreign matter such as metal shavings or wire clippings from falling into the drive during installation and project
construction. Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive. Place a temporary cover over the top of the drive during
installation. Remove the temporary cover before drive start-up, as the cover will reduce ventilation and cause the drive to overheat.
External/Face-Mount
1. Cut an opening in the enclosure panel for the digital operator as shown in Figure 2.8.
2. Position the digital operator so the display faces outwards, and mount it to the enclosure panel as shown in
Figure 2.7.
Figure 2.6
Digital Operator M3 × 6
Phillips recessed
pan head machine screw × 2
Enclosure panel
common_TMonly
Mechanical
Installation
22
YEG
2
78
26
22
2
22
14
Unit: mm
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 41
2.2 Mechanical Installation
Internal/Flush-Mount
An internal flush-mount requires an installation support set that must be purchased separately. Contact a Yaskawa
representative to order an installation support set and mounting hardware. Figure 2.9 illustrates how to attach the
Installation Support Set A.
1. Cut an opening in the enclosure panel for the digital operator as shown in Figure 2.10.
2. Mount the digital operator to the installation support.
3. Mount the installation support set and digital operator to the enclosure panel.
Figure 2.8
Enclosure panel
Digital Operator
common_TMonly
120
45
YEG
59 +0.5
0
Unit : mm
42 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
2.2 Mechanical Installation
H1
H1
H0
H
H
t1 t1
D1
H2
H2
H3
W D1 W D
D
Figure 1 YEG Figure 2
W1
4-d t2 YEG
H1
H0
H
H2
Mechanical
Installation
H3
t1
D1
Max 10 W Max 10 D
2
Figure 3
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 43
2.2 Mechanical Installation
44 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3
Electrical Installation
This chapter explains proper procedures for wiring the control circuit terminals, motor, and
power supply.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 45
3.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Sudden Movement Hazard
Operating a drive with untested emergency circuits could result in death or serious injury.
Verify all drive emergency stop wiring and additional emergency circuits before operating the drive.
Ensure start/stop, I/O and safety circuits are wired properly and in the correct state before energizing or
running the drive.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury from moving equipment.
Ensure holding brake circuits are properly configured, load equipment may fall or drop during power loss or
drive fault, which could result in death or serious injury.
• Provide a separate holding brake if necessary.
• Always construct the external sequence to confirm that the holding brake is activated in the event of an emergency, a
power failure, or an abnormality in the drive.
• If using the drive with an elevator, provide safety measures on the elevator to prevent the elevator from dropping.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Always ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting the motor case.
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing, and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
Make sure the protective earthing conductor complies with technical standards and local safety regulations.
When an EMC filter is installed, the leakage current exceeds 3.5 mA. Therefore according to IEC/EN 61800-5, an
automatic power supply interruption in case of a broken earthing conductor must be provided. Alternatively a
protective earthing conductor with a cross section of at least 10 mm2 (Cu) or 16 mm2 (Al) must be used.
46 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Use appropriate equipment for residual current monitoring/detection (RCM/RCD).
This drive can cause a residual current with a DC component in the protective earthing conductor. Where a residual
current operated protective or monitoring device is used for protection in case of direct or indirect contact, always use
an RCM or RCD of type B according to IEC/EN 60755.
Improper equipment grounding may cause dangerous electrical potentials on equipment chassis, which could
result in death or serious injury. Always use a ground wire that complies with technical standards on electrical
equipment and minimize the length of the ground wire.
Make sure all ground terminals have been properly grounded.
Always ground the ground terminal. (200 V Class: Ground to 100 or less, 400 V Class: Ground to 10 or less).
Sudden Movement Hazard
Comply with proper wiring practices.
The motor may run in reverse if the phase order is backward, causing incorrect elevator direction movement and injury
to personnel.
Connect motor input terminals U, V and W to drive output terminals U/T1,V/T2, and W/T3. The phase order for the
drive and motor should match.
Install a properly controlled contactor on the input-side of the drive for applications where power should be
removed from the drive during a fault condition.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in death or serious injury.
Fire Hazard
Drive Short-Circuit Current Rating
Install adequate branch circuit protection according to applicable local codes and this Installation Manual.
Failure to comply could result in fire and damage to the drive or injury to personnel.
The device is suitable for use on a circuit capable of delivering not more than 100,000 RMS symmetrical amperes, 240
Vac maximum (200 V class) and 480 Vac maximum (400 V class) when protected by branch circuit protection devices
specified in this manual.
Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
Electrical Installation
Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
Improperly tightened terminal screws can also cause erroneous equipment operation.
Do not use improper combustible materials in drive installation.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire.
Attach the drive or braking resistors to metal or other noncombustible material.
Do not use an improper voltage source. 3
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire. Verify that the rated voltage of the drive matches the
voltage of the incoming power supply before applying power.
The braking resistor connection terminals are B1 and B2. Do not connect a braking resistor directly to any
other terminals.
Improper wiring connections could result in death or serious injury by fire.
Do not connect the AC power line to the output motor terminals of the drive. Failure to comply could result in
death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage application to output terminals.
• Do not connect AC line power to output terminals U, V, and W.
• Make sure that the power supply lines are connected to main circuit input terminals R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 (or R/L1 and S/
L2 for single-phase power).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 47
3.1 Section Safety
CAUTION
Crush Hazard
Carrying the drive by the front cover may cause the main body of the drive to fall, resulting in minor or
moderate injury.
Always hold the case when carrying the drive.
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Only connect recommended devices to the drives braking transistor terminals.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive or braking circuit. Carefully review instruction manual
TOBP C720600 0 when connecting a braking option to the drive.
Do not share the ground wire with other devices such as welding machines or large-current electrical
equipment.
Improper equipment grounding could result in drive or equipment malfunction due to electrical interference.
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Never connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in damage to the drive.
Do not use unshielded cable for control wiring.
Failure to comply may cause electrical interference resulting in poor system performance. Use shielded, twisted-pair
wires and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
Do not modify the drive circuitry.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive and will void warranty.
Yaskawa is not responsible for any modification of the product made by the user. This product must not be modified.
Check all the wiring to ensure that all connections are correct after installing the drive and connecting any other
devices.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive.
Connect braking circuits to the drive as shown in the I/O wiring examples.
Improperly wiring braking circuits could result in damage to the drive or equipment.
Do not check or test control circuit signals while the drive is running.
Improper use of test equipment could result in damage to the drive circuitry by short circuit.
Standard motors used with PWM drives may experience winding failures due to surge voltages, when input line
voltage is greater than 480 V or motor wire distance is greater than 100 meters.
Select a motor design with insulation tolerant of surge voltages and drive-rated motor for use with PWM drives.
Failure to comply could lead to motor winding failure.
Do not connect control circuit ground terminals to the drive enclosure.
Improper drive grounding can cause control circuit malfunction.
Do not use the negative DC bus terminal "-" as a ground terminal. This terminal is at high DC voltage potential.
Improper wiring connections could damage the drive.
Before applying power to the drive, use power-off resistance checks to check for short-circuits between (R/L1, S/
L2, and T/L3) or between main circuit terminals and ground.
Failure to comply may result in damage to the drive from short-circuit.
48 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.1 Section Safety
NOTICE
Prevent foreign matter such as metal shavings or wire clippings from falling into the drive during drive
installation and project construction.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive. Place a temporary cover over the top during installation. Be sure
to remove the temporary cover before start-up, as the cover will reduce ventilation and cause the unit to overheat.
Improper application of devices on drive output circuits can damage the drive.
Do not connect unapproved LC or RC interference suppression filters, capacitors, ground fault circuits, or overvoltage
protection devices to the output of the drive.
Insulate shields with heat shrink tubing or tape to prevent contact with other signal lines and equipment.
Improper wiring practices could result in drive or equipment damage due to short circuit.
Electrical Installation
3
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 49
3.2 Standard Connection Diagram
NOTICE: Inadequate wiring could result in damage to the drive. Install adequate branch circuit short circuit protection per applicable
codes. The drive is suitable for circuits capable of delivering not more than 100,000 RMS symmetrical amperes, 240 Vac maximum
(200 V Class) and 480 Vac maximum (400 V Class).
NOTICE: When the input voltage is 440 V or higher or the wiring distance is greater than 100 meters (328 ft.), pay special attention to
the motor insulation voltage or use a drive rated motor. Failure to comply could lead to motor insulation breakdown.
Note: Do not connect AC control circuit ground to drive enclosure. Improper drive grounding can cause control circuit malfunction.
NOTICE: The minimum load for the relay outputs M1-M2, M3-M4, M5-M6, and MA-MB-MC is 10 mA.
50 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.2 Standard Connection Diagram
Figure 3.1
Not Used S8
SN
MA Fault relay output <11>
Sink / Source mode SC 250 Vac, max. 1 A
MB
selection wire link 30 Vdc, max 1 A
(default: Sink) <5> SP MC (min. 5 Vdc, 10 mA)
+24 V
M1 Multi-function relay output (Brake Release Command)
250 Vac, max. 1 A
M2 30 Vdc, max 1 A
Shield ground terminal (min. 5 Vdc, 10 mA)
<6>
M3 Multi-function relay output (Motor Contactor Close Command)
+V Power supply +10.5 Vdc, max. 20 mA 250 Vac, max. 1 A
2 kΩ M4 30 Vdc, max 1 A
A1 Analog Input 1 (Speed Bias) (min. 5 Vdc, 10 mA)
Multi-function -10 to +10 Vdc (20 kΩ)
analog inputs M5 Multi-function relay output (Drive Ready)
A2 Analog Input 2 (Not used) 250 Vac, max. 1 A
M6 30 Vdc, max 1 A
-10 to +10 Vdc (20 kΩ)
(min. 5 Vdc, 10 mA)
AC
0V P1
−V Power supply, -10.5 Vdc, max. 20 mA Photo Coupler 1
C1 (During Frequency Output) Digital output
<6> Termination resistor 5 to 48 Vdc
(120 Ω, 1/2 W) P2 2 to 50 mA
Photo Coupler 2 (default setting)
DIP C2 (not used)
Switch S2
R+
R
MEMOBUS/Modbus S+ <7> FM
Multi-function analog output 1
Electrical Installation
comm. RS485/422
− + (Output Speed)
max. 115.2 kBps S FM -10 to +10 Vdc (2mA) <10>
IG
AM
Multi-function analog output 2
AC − + (Output Current)
AM
H1 <8> -10 to +10 Vdc (2mA)
0V
H2
E (G)
Safe Disable inputs
<9> shielded line
DM+
EDM (Safety Electronic Device Monitor)
3
twisted-pair shielded line
HC DM−
control circuit terminal
main circuit terminal
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 51
3.2 Standard Connection Diagram
<11> When the drive is set to trigger a fault output upon activation of the fault reset function (L5-02 = 1), a sequence to interrupt power
when a fault occurs will shut off the power to the drive when the drive attempts a reset. The default setting for L5-02 is 0 (fault output
not active during reset attempt).
<12> Wire fault contact outputs MA, MB, and MC. Wire so that a fault will open the safety circuit and interrupt drive output.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Ensure start/stop and safety circuits are wired properly and in the correct state before
energizing the drive. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury from moving equipment.
NOTICE: When using the automatic fault reset function with wiring designed to shut off the power supply upon drive fault, make sure
the drive does not trigger a fault output during fault reset (L5-02 = 0, default). Failure to comply will prevent the automatic fault reset
function from working properly.
52 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.3 Main Circuit Connection Diagram
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Separate motor and/or braking circuit wiring (terminals, U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, +3, +2, +1,(-), B1, B2, from all
other wiring. Place motor wiring within its own conduit or cable tray with appropriate divider, and use shielded motor cable where
appropriate. Improper wiring practices could result in malfunction of drive due to electrical interference.
B1 B2 B1 B2
+1 +1
+2 Relay Relay
Current DC Current
sensor reactor sensor
R/L1 U/T1 R/L1 U/T1
S/L2 + +
V/T2 S/L2 V/T2
T/L3 W/T3 T/L3 W/T3
– –
YEG
+3 +3
Electrical Installation
+1 +1
Relay Relay
DC Current DC Current
reactor sensor reactor sensor
R/L1 U/T1 R/L1 U/T1
+ +
S/L2 V/T2 S/L2 V/T2
T/L3 W/T3 T/L3 W/T3
– YEG –
YEG 3
Control 24 V Control
Gate board Operator Power Gate board Operator
board Supply board
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 53
3.4 Terminal Block Configuration
YEG
54 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.5 Terminal Cover
YEG
Figure 3.4 Removing the Terminal Cover
2. Push in on the tab located on the bottom of the terminal cover and gently pull forward to remove the terminal
cover.
Figure 3.4
YEG
Electrical Installation
Figure 3.5 Removing the Terminal Cover
Models CIMR-L20085 to 20180 and 40045 to 40150
1. Loosen the screws on the terminal cover, then pull down on the cover.
CAUTION! Do not completely remove the cover screws, just loosen them. If the cover screws are removed completely, the terminal
cover may fall off causing an injury.
Note: The shape of the terminal covers and the numbers of screws differ depending on the drive models. Refer to Component Names
3
on page 29 for details.
Figure 3.5
YEG
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 55
3.5 Terminal Cover
YEG
Figure 3.7 Removing the Terminal Cover
Reattach the terminal cover after completing the wiring to the drive and other devices.
Figure 3.7
56 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.6 Digital Operator and Front Cover
YEG
Figure 3.10 Removing the Digital Operator
Electrical Installation
YEG
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 57
3.6 Digital Operator and Front Cover
YEG
Figure 3.12 Remove the Front Cover (Models CIMR-L20008 to 20075 and 40005 to 40039)
Models CIMR-L20085 to 20415 and 40045 to 40216
1. Remove the terminal cover and the digital operator.
2. Loosen the installation screw on the front cover.
3. Use a straight-edge screwdriver to loosen the hooks on each side of the cover that hold it in place.
Figure 3.12
Hook Hook
58 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.6 Digital Operator and Front Cover
Electrical Installation
3
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 59
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
NOTICE: Do not use the negative DC bus terminal “-” as a ground terminal. This terminal is at high DC voltage potential.
Improper wiring connections could damage the drive.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Separate motor and/or braking circuit wiring (terminals, U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, +3, +2, +1,(-), B1, B2, from all
other wiring. Place motor wiring within its own conduit or cable tray with appropriate divider, and use shielded motor cable where
appropriate. Improper wiring practices could result in malfunction of drive due to electrical interference.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Comply with proper wiring practices. The motor may run in reverse if the phase order is backward,
causing incorrect elevator direction movement. Connect motor input terminals U, V and W to drive output terminals U/T1,V/T2, and W/
T3. The phase order for the drive and motor should match.
NOTICE: Do not solder the ends of wire connections to the drive. Soldered wiring connections can loosen over time. Improper wiring
practices could result in drive malfunction due to loose terminal connections.
NOTICE: Do not switch the drive input to start or stop the motor. Frequently switching the drive on and off shortens the life of the DC
bus charge circuit and the DC bus capacitors, and can cause premature drive failures. For the full performance life, refrain from
switching the drive on and off more than once every 30 minutes.
R/L1
S/L2 Main circuit power supply input Connects line power to the drive 51
T/L3
U/T1
V/T2 Drive output Connects to the motor 51
W/T3
B1 Available for connecting a braking resistor or a
Braking resistor Not available 326
B2 braking resistor unit option
+2 • DC reactor connection (+1, Not available
+1 +2) (remove the shorting bar For connection
between +1 and +2) DC power supply input • DC power supply input • of the drive to a DC power supply (terminals +1
• DC power supply input (+1, –) 330
– (+1, –) and – are not UL approved)
(+1, –) • Braking unit connection • of dynamic braking options
(+3, –)
+3 Not available
– Grounding terminal 65
Note: Use terminal B1 and - terminals when installing the braking unit (CDBR type) to the drives with built-in braking transistor
(20008 to 20115, 40005 to 40060).
60 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
• Consider the amount of voltage drop when selecting wire gauges. Increase the wire gauge when the voltage drop is
greater than 2% of motor rated voltage. Ensure the wire gauge is suitable for the terminal block. Use the following
formula to calculate the amount of voltage drop:
Line drop voltage (V) = 3 wire resistance (/km) wire length (m) current (A) 10-3
• Refer to instruction manual TOBP C720600 0 for braking transistor option or braking resistor option wire gauges.
• Use terminal +1 and the negative terminal when connecting a regenerative converter or a regen unit.
• Use terminal B1 and - terminals when installing the braking unit to the drives with built-in braking transistor (20008
to 20115, 40005 to 40060).
• Refer to UL Standards Compliance on page 429 for information on UL compliance.
Yaskawa recommends using closed-loop crimp terminals on all drive models. UL/cUL approval requires the use of
closed-loop crimp terminals when wiring the drive main circuit terminals on models CIMR-L20085 to 20415 and
40045 to 40216. Use only the tools recommended by the terminal manufacturer for crimping. Refer to Closed-Loop
Crimp Terminal Size on page 433 for closed-loop crimp terminal recommendations.
The wire gauges listed in the following tables are Yaskawa recommendations. Refer to local codes for proper wire gauge
selections.
Three-Phase 200 V Class
Table 3.2 Wire Gauge and Torque Specifications (Three-Phase 200 V Class)
Applicable Tightening
Model Recommended Gauge Screw
Terminal Gauge Torque
CIMR-L mm2 Size
mm2 Nm (lb.in.)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 2.5 2.5 to 6
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 2.5 2.5 to 6
–, +1, +2 – 2.5 to 6 1.2 to 1.5
20008 M4
(10.6 to 13.3)
B1, B2 – 2.5 to 6
2.5 <1> 2.5 to 6
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 2.5 2.5 to 6
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 2.5 2.5 to 6
–, +1, +2 – 2.5 to 6 1.2 to 1.5
20011 M4
(10.6 to 13.3)
B1, B2 – 2.5 to 6
2.5 <1> 2.5 to 6
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 4 2.5 to 6
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 2.5 2.5 to 6
1.2 to 1.5
Electrical Installation
20018 –, +1, +2 – 4 to 6 M4
(10.6 to 13.3)
B1, B2 – 2.5 to 6
4 <1> 4 to 6
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 6 4 to 16
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 6 4 to 16 2.1 to 2.3
M4
–, +1, +2 – 6 to 16 (18.6 to 20.4)
20025
B1, B2 – 4 to 6
6 <2> 6 to 10 M5
2.0 to 2.5
(17.7 to 22.1) 3
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 10 6 to 16
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 10 6 to 16 2.1 to 2.3
M4
–, +1, +2 – 16 (18.6 to 20.4)
20033
B1, B2 – 4 to 6
2.0 to 2.5
10 6 to 10 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 16 16 to 25
5.4 to 6.0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 16 16 to 25 M6
(47.8 to 53.1)
–, +1, +2 – 16 to 25
20047 2.7 to 3.0
B1, B2 – 6 to 10 M5
(23.9 to 26.6)
5.4 to 6.0
16 10 to 16 M6
(47.8 to 53.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 25 16 to 25
9.9 to 11.0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 16 16 to 25 M8
(87.6 to 97.4)
–, +1, +2 – 25
20060 2.7 to 3.0
B1, B2 – 10 to 16 M5
(23.9 to 26.6)
5.4 to 6.0
16 16 to 25 M6
(47.8 to 53.1)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 61
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
<1> When using the wire of this gauge in accordance with IEC/EN 61800-5-1, install an ELCB.
<2> When using the wire of this gauge in accordance with IEC/EN 61800-5-1, install an ELCB, or use copper wire of 10 mm2 (AWG 8).
Note: When connecting peripheral devices and options to the terminals –, +1, +3, B1, and B2, refer to the instruction manuals for each
device. For more information, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative.
62 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
Electrical Installation
5.4 to 6.0
10 6 to 16 M6
(47.8 to 53.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 16 16 to 25
5.4 to 6.0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 16 16 to 25 M6
(47.8 to 53.1)
–, +1, +2 – 16 to 25
40039 2.7 to 3.0
B1, B2 – 6 to 10 M5
(23.9 to 26.6)
5.4 to 6.0
16 10 to 16 M6
(47.8 to 53.1) 3
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 16 10 to 50
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 16 10 to 50
–, +1 – 16 to 50 9 to 11
40045 M8
(79.7 to 97.4)
B1, B2 – 10 to 50
16 10 to 16
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 16 16 to 50
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 25 16 to 50
–, +1 – 25 to 50 9 to 11
40060 M8
(79.7 to 97.4)
B1, B2 – 16 to 50
16 16 to 25
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 25 16 to 70
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 25 25 to 70
–, +1 – 25 to 70 9 to 11
40075 M8
(79.7 to 97.4)
+3 – 16 to 70
16 16 to 25
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 35 25 to 70
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 35 25 to 70
–, +1 – 25 to 70 9 to 11
40091 M8
(79.7 to 97.4)
+3 – 25 to 70
16 16 to 25
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 63
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
<1> When using the wire of this gauge in accordance with IEC/EN 61800-5-1, install an ELCB.
<2> When using the wire of this gauge in accordance with IEC/EN 61800-5-1, install an ELCB, or use copper wire of 10 mm2 (AWG 8).
Note: When connecting peripheral devices and options to the terminals –, +1, +3, B1, and B2, refer to the instruction manuals for each
device. For more information, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Verify motor wiring bare wire ends do not contact the drive chassis or enclosure when wiring
drive terminals U/T1, V/T2, W/T3. Failure to comply may result in serious injury or death due to electrical shock.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting the motor
case. Always properly ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque. Loose electrical connections could result in
death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections. Improperly tightened terminal screws can also cause
erroneous equipment operation.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Do not use an improper voltage source. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire. Verify
that the rated voltage of the drive matches the voltage of the incoming power supply before applying power.
WARNING! Do not connect the AC power line to the output motor terminals of the drive. Failure to comply could result in death or
serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage application to output terminals.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Separate motor and/or braking circuit wiring (terminals, U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, +3, +2, +1,(-), B1, B2, from all
other wiring. Place motor wiring within its own conduit or cable tray with appropriate divider, and use shielded motor cable where
appropriate. Improper wiring practices could result in malfunction of drive due to electrical interference.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Comply with proper wiring practices. The motor may run in reverse if the phase order is backward,
causing incorrect elevator direction movement and injury to personnel. Connect motor input terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 to drive
output terminals U/T1,V/T2, and W/T3. The phase order for the drive and motor should match.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Improper equipment sequencing could shorten useful life of the electrolytic capacitors and circuit relays
of the drive. Refrain from switching an input contactor more often than once every 30 minutes. Normally the drive I/O should be used
to stop and start the motor.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Standard motors used with PWM drives may experience winding failures due to surge voltages, when
input line voltage is greater than 480 V or motor wire distance is greater than 100 meters. Select a motor design with insulation tolerant
of surge voltages and drive-rated motor for use with PWM drives. Failure to comply could lead to motor winding failure.
NOTICE: Do not use the negative DC bus terminal "-" as a ground terminal. This terminal is at high DC voltage potential. Improper
wiring connections could damage the drive.
64 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
NOTICE: Improper application of devices on drive output circuits can damage the drive. Do not connect unapproved LC or RC
interference suppression filters, capacitors, ground fault circuits, or overvoltage protection devices to the output of the drive.
NOTICE: Do not connect phase-advancing capacitors or LC/RC noise filters to the output circuits. Failure to comply could result in
damage to the drive, phase-advancing capacitors, LC/RC noise filters or residual current devices.
NOTICE: Properly integrate auxiliary contacts into the control logic circuit to avoid unnecessary fault displays caused by contactors or
output switches placed between drive and motor. Improper installation of input and output contactors could result in damage to the
drive.
NOTICE: Before applying power to the drive, use power-off resistance checks to check for short-circuits between (R/L1, S/L2, and
T/L3) or between main circuit terminals and ground. Failure to comply may result in damage to the drive.
Note: When setting carrier frequency for drives running multiple motors, calculate cable length as the total wiring distance to all
connected motors.
Ground Wiring
Follow the precautions to wire the ground for one drive or a series of drives.
WARNING! When using an EMC filter, the leakage current exceeds 3.5 mA. Therefore, according to IEC/EN 61800-5-1, at least one of
the conditions below must be satisfied:
a) The cross-section of the protective earthing conductor must be at least 10 mm2 (Cu) or 16 mm2 (Al).
b) The power supply must be disconnected automatically in case of discontinuity of the protective earthing conductor.
Electrical Installation
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Always use a ground wire that complies with technical standards on electrical equipment and
local installation regulations. Minimize the length of the ground wire. Improper equipment grounding may cause dangerous electrical
potentials on equipment chassis, which could result in death or serious injury.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Be sure to ground the drive ground terminal. Improper equipment grounding may cause
dangerous electrical potentials on equipment chassis, which could result in death or serious injury.
NOTICE: Do not share the ground wire with other devices such as welding machines or large-current electrical equipment. Improper
equipment grounding could result in drive or equipment malfunction due to electrical interference. 3
NOTICE: When using more than one drive, ground multiple drives according to instructions. Improper equipment grounding could
result in abnormal operation of drive or equipment.
Refer to Figure 3.16 when using multiple drives. Do not loop the ground wire.
Figure 3.15
OK OK Not OK
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 65
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
A – Protecting Cover
Figure 3.17 Protecting Cover to Prevent Miswiring (CIMR-L20047)
66 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Always check the operation and wiring of control circuits after being wired. Operating a drive
with untested control circuits could result in death or serious injury.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Confirm the drive I/O signals and external sequence before starting test run. Failure to comply
may result in death or serious injury.
NOTICE: Frequently switching the drive power supply to stop and start the motor can damage the drive.
NOTICE: To get the full performance life out of the electrolytic capacitors and circuit relays, refrain from switching the drive power
supply off and on more than once every 30 minutes. Frequent use can damage the drive. Use the drive to stop and start the motor.
Note: Do not solder the ends of wire connections to the drive. Soldered wiring connections can loosen over time. Improper wiring
practices could result in drive malfunction due to loose terminal connections.
Input Terminals
Table 3.5 lists the input terminals on the drive. Text in parenthesis indicates the default setting for each multi-function
input.
Table 3.5 Control Circuit Input Terminals
Type No. Terminal Name (Function) Function (Signal Level) Default Setting Page
Electrical Installation
S1 Up Command (Closed: Up, Open: Stop)
S2 Down Command (Closed: Down, Open: Stop)
S3 Multi-function input 1 (Nominal Speed)
Photocoupler
S4 Multi-function input 2 (Inspection Operation) 24 Vdc, 8 mA
Digital Inputs 359
S5 Multi-function input 3 (Intermediate Speed 1) Use the wire link between terminals SC and SN or between SC and SP to select
sinking or sourcing, and to select the power supply.
S6 Multi-function input 4 (Leveling Speed)
S7 Multi-function input 5 (Not used)
S8 Multi-function input 6 (Not used) 3
SC Multi-function input common
24 Vdc, 150 mA (only when DI-A3 is not used)
Digital Input
SN 0V Use the wire jumper between terminals SC and SN or between SC and SP to select 73
Power Supply
sinking or sourcing, and to select the power supply.
SP +24 Vdc
H1 Safe Disable input 1 24 Vdc, 8 mA
One or both open: Drive output disabled
Both closed: Normal operation
Safe Disable Internal impedance: 3.3 k
H2 Safe Disable input 2 438
Inputs Off time of at least 1 ms
Set the S3 jumper to select sinking or sourcing, and to select the power supply.
HC Safe Disable function common Common for the Safe Disable function
+V Power supply for analog inputs 10.5 Vdc (max allowable current 20 mA) 149
-V Power supply for analog inputs -10.5 Vdc (max allowable current 20 mA) –
149
A1 Multi-function analog input 1 (Speed reference bias) -10 to 10 Vdc, 0 to 10 Vdc (input impedance: 20 k)
196
Analog Inputs
149
A2 Multi-function analog input 2 (Not used) -10 to 10 Vdc, 0 to 10 Vdc (input impedance: 20 k)
197
AC Analog input common 0V 149
E (G) Ground for shielded lines and option cards – –
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 67
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
Output Terminals
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. The logic of terminals DM+/DM- is inverted between drive models CIMR-LA and CIMR-
LF. Check all wiring to ensure that the sequence is correct after installing the drive and connecting any other devices. Improper
wiring connections could result in death or serious injury.
Table 3.6 lists the output terminals on the drive. Text in parenthesis indicates the default setting for each multi-function
output.
Note: Multi-function relay output terminals are rated at a minimum of 10 mA. If less than 10 mA is required, use the photocoupler
outputs (P1-C1, P2-C2). Using the wrong current output level may cause the output to malfunction when the terminal is
activated.
Table 3.6 Control Circuit Output Terminals
Type No. Terminal Name (Function) Function (Signal Level) Default Setting Page
MA N.O.
30 Vdc, 10 mA to 1 A; 250 Vac, 10 mA to 1 A
Fault Relay MB N.C. output 187
Minimum load: 5 Vdc, 10 mA
MC Fault output common
M1
Multi-function relay output 1 (Brake release command)
M2
Contact relay output
Multi-Function M3 30 Vdc, 10 mA to 1 A
Relay Output Multi-function relay output 2 (Output contactor close command) 187
M4 250 Vac, 10 mA to 1 A
Minimum load: 5 Vdc, 10 mA
M5
Multi-function relay output 3 (Drive ready)
M6
P1
Photocoupler output 1 (During Frequency output)
Multi-Function C1
Photocoupler 48 Vdc, 2 to 50 mA –
Output P2
Photocoupler output 2 (Not Used/Through Mode)
C2
FM Analog monitor output 1 (Output speed)
-10 to +10 Vdc or 0 to +10 Vdc 199
Monitor Output AM Analog monitor output 2 (Output current)
AC Monitor common 0V –
Safety Monitor DM+ Safety monitor output
Outputs status of Safe Disable function. Up to +48 Vdc 50 mA 441
Output DM- Safety monitor output common
<1> Enable the termination resistor in the last drive in a MEMOBUS network by setting DIP switch S2 to the ON position. For more information on
the termination resistor, refer to Control I/O Configuration on page 73.
68 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
Terminal Configuration
Control circuit terminals are arranged as shown in Figure 3.18.
Figure 3.17
YEG
V+ AC V- A1 A2 FM AM AC P1 C1 P2 C2 M1 M2 M5
E(G) HC H1 H2 DM+ DM- IG R+ R- S+ S-
M3 M4 M6
V+ AC V- A1 A2 FM AM AC P1 C1 P2 AC
C2 M1 M2 M5
S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8 SN SC SP MA MB MC
S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8 SN SC SP MA MB MC
Wire Size
WARNING! Fire hazard. Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical
connections. Improperly tightened terminal screws can also cause erroneous equipment operation.
Select appropriate wire type and gauges from Table 3.8. For simpler and more reliable wiring, use crimp ferrules on the
wire ends. Refer to Table 3.9 for ferrule terminal types and sizes.
Table 3.8 Wire Gauges
Bare Wire Terminal Ferrule-Type Terminal
Terminal Applicable Wire Size Recommended Wire Applicable Wire Size Recommended Wire Wire Type
Size Size
mm2 (AWG) mm2 (AWG)
mm2 (AWG) mm2 (AWG)
S1 to S8, SN, SC, SP, V+, AC, V-, A1, A2, Stranded wire:
Electrical Installation
FM, AM, P1-C1, P2-C2, E(G), HC, H1, H2, 0.25 to 1.0 (24 to 17) 0.75 0.25 to 0.5 0.5
Shielded wire, etc.
DM+, DM-, IG, R+, R-, S+, S-, MA, MB, Solid wire: (18) (24 to 20) (20)
MC, M1-M2, M3-M4, M5-M6 0.25 to 1.5 (24 to 16)
d2
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 69
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
WARNING! Fire hazard. Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque. Loose electrical connections could result in
death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not remove covers or touch the circuit boards while the power is on. Failure to comply could
result in death or serious injury.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment and lock out the power source. Failure to
comply may result in injury from electrical shock. Wait at least five minutes after all indicators are OFF and measure the DC bus
voltage level and main circuit terminals to confirm the circuit is safe before wiring.
WARNING! Sudden Movement and Hazard. Install additional emergency circuits separately from the drive emergency stop circuits.
Failure to comply may result in personal injury.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Do not connect control circuit ground terminals to the drive enclosure. Improper drive grounding can
cause control circuit malfunction.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Insulate shields with heat shrink tubing or tape to prevent contact with other signal lines and equipment.
Improper wiring practices could result in drive or equipment malfunction due to short circuit.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Use twisted-pair or shielded twisted-pair cables for control circuits. Improper wiring practices could result
in drive or equipment malfunction or nuisance trips.
NOTICE: Connect the shield of shielded cable to the appropriate ground terminal. Improper equipment grounding could result in drive
or equipment malfunction or nuisance trips.
NOTICE: Separate wiring for output terminals MA, MB, MC, M1 and M2 from wiring to other control circuit lines. Improper wiring
practices could result in drive or equipment malfunction or nuisance trips.
NOTICE: Separate control circuit wiring from main circuit wiring (terminals R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, B1, B2, U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, -, +1, +2) and
other high-power lines. Improper wiring practices could result in drive malfunction due to electrical interference.
NOTICE: Use a class 2 power supply (UL standard) when connecting to the control terminals. Improper application of peripheral
devices could result in drive performance degradation due to improper power supply.
NOTICE: Do not exceed 50 meters (164 feet) for the control line between the drive and the operator when using an analog signal from
a remote source to supply the frequency reference. Failure to comply could result in poor system performance.
NOTICE: Do not use unshielded cable for control wiring. Failure to comply may cause electrical interference resulting in poor system
performance. Use shielded, twisted-pair wires, and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
NOTICE: Insulate shields with tape or shrink tubing to prevent contact with other signal lines and equipment. Improper wiring practices
could result in drive or equipment malfunction due to short circuit.
Wire the control circuit only after terminals have been properly grounded and main circuit wiring is complete. Refer to
Figure 3.20 and Figure 3.21 for details. Prepare the ends of the control circuit wiring as shown in Figure 3.22. Refer to
Wire Size on page 69.
NOTICE: Use shielded twisted-pair cables as indicated to prevent operating faults. Improper wiring practices could result in drive or
equipment malfunction due to electrical interference.
70 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
Control Wires
Terminal Board
YEG
45
Electrical Installation
E B
A C
NOTICE: Do not exceed 50 meters (164 ft.) for the control line between the drive and the operator when using an analog signal from a
remote source to supply the frequency reference. Failure to comply could result in poor system performance.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 71
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
YEG
Jumper S3
Terminal H1/H2
Sink/Source Sel.
V+ AC V- A1 A2 FM AM AC P1 C1 P2 C2 M1 M2 M5
S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8 SN SC SP MA MB MC
DIP Switch S2
RS-422/485 Termination
Resistor
Off On
72 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.9 Control I/O Configuration
Table 3.10 Digital Input Sink / Source / External Power Supply Selection
Drive Internal Power Supply (Terminal SN and SP) External 24 Vdc Power Supply
S7 S7
S8 S8
SC SC
24 Vdc 24 Vdc
SP External SP
24 Vdc
S7 S7
S8 S8
SC SC
24 Vdc 24 Vdc
External
SP SP
24 Vdc
Electrical Installation
Sinking/Sourcing Mode Selection for Safe Disable Inputs
Use jumper S3 on the terminal board to select between Sink mode, Source mode or external power supply for the Safe
Disable inputs H1 and H2 as shown in Table 3.11 (Default: Sink mode, internal power supply).
Table 3.11 Safe Disable Input Sink / Source / External Power Supply Selection
Drive Internal Power Supply External 24 Vdc Power Supply
Jumper S3 Jumper S3 3
24 Vdc 24 Vdc
HC HC
External
24 Vdc
Sinking Mode
H1 H1
H2 H2
Jumper S3 Jumper S3
24 Vdc 24 Vdc
HC HC
External
24 Vdc
Sourcing Mode
H1 H1
H2 H2
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 73
3.9 Control I/O Configuration
MEMOBUS/Modbus Termination
This drive is equipped with a built in termination resistor for the RS-422/485 communication port. DIP switch S2 enables
or disabled the termination resistor as shown in Table 3.12. The OFF position is the default. The termination resistor
should be placed to the ON position when the drive is the last in a series of slave drives. Refer to Switches and Jumpers
on the Terminal Board on page 72 for locating switch S2.
Table 3.12 MEMOBUS/Modbus Switch Settings
S2 Position Description
ON Internal termination resistor ON
OFF Internal termination resistor OFF (default setting)
74 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.10 Connect to a PC
3.10 Connect to a PC
This drive is equipped with a USB port (type-B).
The drive can connect to a USB port on a PC using a USB 2.0, AB-type cable (sold separately). After connecting the
drive to a PC, Yaskawa DriveWizard Plus software can be used to monitor drive performance and manage parameter
settings. Contact Yaskawa for more information on DriveWizard Plus.
Download and install the USB driver before connecting L1000A to a PC with the USB cable. The driver is available at
www.yaskawa.eu.com
Figure 3.23
USB Cable
(Type-AB)
(Type-B) (Type-A)
PC
YEG
Figure 3.24 Connecting to a PC (USB)
Electrical Installation
3
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 75
3.11 Wiring Checklist
2 Make sure you have the correct braking resistors, DC reactors, noise filters, and other peripheral devices installed. 314
9 Properly wire the power supply to drive terminals R/L1, S/L2, and T/L3. 53
Properly wire the drive and motor together.
10 The motor lines and drive output terminals R/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 should match in order to produce the desired phase order. If the phase order 64
is incorrect, the drive will rotate in the opposite direction.
11 Use 600 Vac vinyl-sheathed wire for the power supply and motor lines. 60
Use the correct wire gauges for the main circuit. Refer to Wire Gauges and Tightening Torque on page 60. 60
• Consider the amount of voltage drop when selecting wire gauges. Increase the wire gauge when the voltage drop is greater than 2% of motor
12 rated voltage. Ensure the wire gauge is suitable for the terminal block. Use the following formula to calculate the amount of voltage drop: 60
Line drop voltage (V) = 3 wire resistance (/km) wire length (m) current (A) 10-3
• If the cable between the drive and motor exceeds 50 m (164 feet), adjust the carrier frequency set to C6-02 accordingly. 65
23 Ensure that no frayed wires on the terminal block are touching other terminals or connections. –
27 Check the logic of the Safe Disable monitor output signals (terminals DM+ and DM-). 438
76 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4
Start-Up Programming & Operation
This chapter explains the functions of the digital operator and provides programming
instructions for initial drive operation.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 77
4.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Sudden movement Hazard
Do not perform elevator test operations or drive setup when the elevator is occupied.
The elevator car may not stop properly during test operation resulting in serious injury to personnel. Additionally,
ensure these parameters are set correctly and tested before operating an occupied elevator:
• parameter o1-20 (Traction Sheave Diameter)
• parameter S5-11 (Deceleration Distance), or
• parameter S5-12 (Stop Distance)
Use the Initial Pole Search Status Signal (H2- = 61) to interlock the brake to ensure the brake is not released
before the Initial Magnetic Pole Search is completed.
Failure to comply may cause inadvertent elevator movement resulting in serious injury.
This safety message is applicable under these conditions:
-When applying a PM motor, with an external brake sequence, and the PG-F3 option is not being used.
Ensure all personnel are clear of the motor and elevator before Auto-Tuning.
The motor or equipment may suddenly rotate during the Auto-Tuning process, which may result in serious personal
injury or death.
Electrical Shock Hazard
When a drive is running a PM motor, voltage continues to be generated at the motor terminals after the drive is
shut off while the motor coasts to stop.
Take the precautions described below to prevent shock and injury:
• In applications where the machine can still rotate even though the drive has fully stopped a load, install a switch to
the drive output side to disconnect the motor and the drive.
• Do not allow an external force to rotate the motor beyond the maximum allowable speed or to rotate the motor when
the drive has been shut off.
• Wait for at least the time specified on the warning label after opening the load switch on the output side before
inspecting the drive or performing any maintenance.
• Do not open and close the load switch while the motor is running, as this can damage the drive.
• If the motor is coasting, make sure the power to the drive is turned on and the drive output has completely stopped
before closing the load switch.
78 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Sudden Movement Hazard
Ensure all personnel are clear of the motor and elevator before Auto-Tuning.
The motor or equipment may suddenly rotate during the Auto-Tuning process, which may result in serious personal
injury or death.
The drive is capable of running the motor at high speed. Verify the maximum drive output frequency before
starting the drive.
Failure to comply may cause injury or death due to inadvertent high speed operation.
Verify drive parameter b1-03 Stopping Method is set to 0:Ramp to Stop before starting the drive.
Failure to comply may cause the elevator to free-fall when the Up/Down command is removed.
System may start unexpectedly upon application of power when the Auto-Reset function is enabled resulting in
death or serious injury.
Use care when enabling Auto-Reset as this function may cause unintended start of the elevator.
Ensure holding brake circuits are properly configured, load equipment may fall or drop during power loss or
drive fault, which could result in death or serious injury.
• Provide a separate holding brake if necessary.
• Always construct the external sequence to confirm that the holding brake is activated in the event of an emergency, a
power failure, or an abnormality in the drive.
• If using the drive with an elevator, provide safety measures on the elevator to prevent the elevator from dropping.
Install additional emergency circuits separately from drive emergency stop circuits.
Failure to comply may result in personal injury.
Remove the Up/Down Command before resetting alarms and faults.
Failure to comply can result in death or serious injury.
The drive and motor may start unexpectedly during Auto-Tuning, which could result in death or serious injury.
• Remove main power from the drive before servicing the drive or motor.
• Do not touch the motor during Auto-Tuning.
• Ensure the area surrounding the drive motor and load are clear before proceeding with Auto-Tuning.
System may start unexpectedly, resulting in death or serious injury.
Start-Up Programming
Before starting or applying power to the drive, clear all personnel from the drive, motor and machine area and check
sequence and safety circuitry. Secure covers, couplings, shaft keys and machine loads.
Electrical Shock Hazard
& Operation
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may include drives without covers or safety shields to illustrate details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual. 4
Do not remove covers or touch circuit boards while the power is on.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
Burn Hazard
Do not touch a hot drive heatsink.
Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the power to the drive when replacing the cooling
fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and make sure heatsink has cooled down.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 79
4.1 Section Safety
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Only perform Rotational Auto-Tuning with the motor disconnected from the load (ropes removed from traction
sheave).
Failure to comply will cause the drive will be unable to automatically set motor parameters correctly. This will result in
erroneous operation.
Do not check or test control circuit signals while the drive is running.
Improper use of test equipment could result in damage to the drive circuitry by short circuit.
Do not use the Rescue Operation feature for extended periods.
Failure to comply may result in drive heat sink overtemperature alarms (oH).
Set parameter E1-01 to match the input voltage of the drive. The drive input voltage (not motor voltage) must
be set in E1-01 for the protective features to function properly.
Failure to set the correct drive input voltage may result in improper drive operation.
Use the drives Torque Detection function to notify the PLC of potential overcurrent or overload situations at the
load prior to a drive overload fault.
Failure to comply may cause the drive to fault leaving the motor coasting, potentially damaging equipment.
Correctly set parameter o2-04 when replacing the control terminal board.
Failure to comply may result in drive damage due to lack of protective functions and poor drive performance.
80 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.2 Using the Digital Operator
1
11
F1 F2
2 ESC
LO
9 YEG
RE
3 RESET ENTER
8
10 RUN STOP
4 5 6 7
Figure 4.1 Keys and Displays on the Digital Operator
F1
Function Key The functions assigned to F1 and F2 vary depending on the currently displayed menu. The name of each
1
(F1, F2) function appears in the lower half of the display window.
F2
Start-Up Programming
Up Arrow Key Scrolls up to display the next item, select parameter numbers, and increment setting values.
5
6 Down Arrow Key Scrolls down to display the previous item, select parameter numbers, and decrements setting values.
& Operation
7 STOP STOP Key <1> Stops drive operation.
Switches drive control between the operator (LOCAL) and the control circuit terminals (REMOTE) for the 4
9 LO LO/RE Selection Key <2> Run command and speed reference. The LED is on when the drive is in the LOCAL mode (operation from
RE keypad).
10 RUN Light Lit while the drive is operating the motor. Refer to page 84 for details.
RUN
11 LO LO/RE Light Lit while the operator is selected to run the drive (LOCAL mode). Refer to page 84 for details.
RE
12 ALM LED Light Refer to ALARM (ALM) LED Displays on page 83.
<1> The STOP key has highest priority. Pressing the STOP key will always cause the drive to stop the motor, even if an Up/Down command is
active at any external Up/Down command source. To disable the STOP key priority, set parameter o2-02 to 0.
<2> The LO/RE key can only switch between LOCAL and REMOTE when the drive is stopped. By default settings the LO/RE key function is
disabled. To allow using the LO/RE key for switching between LOCAL and REMOTE, set parameter o2-01 to 1.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 81
4.2 Using the Digital Operator
LCD Display
Figure 4.2
1 2 3
9 8 7
Figure 4.2 LCD Display
Table 4.1 Display and Contents
No. Name Display Content
MODE Displayed when in Mode Selection.
MONITR Displayed when in Monitor Mode.
VERIFY Indicates the Verify Menu.
1 Operation Mode Menus
PRMSET Displayed when in Parameter Setting Mode.
A.TUNE Displayed during Auto-Tuning.
SETUP Displayed when in Setup Mode.
DRV Displayed when in Drive Mode.
2 Mode Display Area
PRG Displayed when in Programming Mode.
3 Ready Rdy Indicates the drive is ready to run.
4 Data Display – Displays specific data and operation data.
OPR Displayed when the speed reference source is assigned to the LCD Operator.
Speed Reference Source
5 COM Displayed when the speed reference source is assigned to MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication.
Assignment <1>
OP Displayed when the speed reference is assigned to an option card.
RSEQ Displayed when the Up/Down command is supplied from a remote source.
LO/RE LSEQ Displayed when the Up/Down command is supplied from the operator keypad.
6
Display <2> RREF Displayed when the speed reference is supplied from a remote source.
LREF Displayed when the speed reference is supplied from the operator keypad.
FWD/REV Pressing F1 switches between Up and Down when the Up/Down command is set from the digital operator.
82 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.2 Using the Digital Operator
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Operating a drive with untested emergency circuits could result in death or serious injury.
Always check the operation of any emergency circuits after they are wired. Emergency circuits are required to provide safe and quick
shutdown of the drive.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Ensure start/stop and safety circuits are wired properly and in the correct state before
energizing the drive. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury from moving equipment.
Status Display
When the power supply to the drive is turned on, the digital operator lights will appear as follows:
- MODE - DRV
Data displayed varies by the type of fault. Refer to Fault Displays, Causes, and Possible Solutions on page 259
Start-Up Programming
Fault EF3
Ext Fault S3
YEG for more information and possible solutions. ALM LED is lit and DRV displayed.
FWD RESET
& Operation
ALARM (ALM) LED Displays
Table 4.2 ALARM (ALM) LED Status and Contents
State Content Display 4
Illuminated When the drive detects an alarm or error.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 83
4.2 Using the Digital Operator
Examples
<1> Refer to Figure 4.3 for the difference between “flashing” and “flashing quickly”.
Figure 4.3
1s
ON ON
Flashing
common_TM
only
Flashing ON ON ON ON
quickly
84 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.2 Using the Digital Operator
- MODE - PRG
Programming Mode <2>
Quick Setting
Initial Display <5>
L1000A
HELP FWD DATA XXXVX.X/X.XkW
L1000A XX.XX/XX.XXA
YASKAWA <XXXXXXXXX>
<6>
- MODE - PRG
Programming
AUTO
Start-Up Programming
Figure 4.5 Digital Operator Menu and Screen Structure
<1> Pressing RUN will start the motor.
& Operation
<2> Drive cannot operate the motor.
<3> Flashing characters are shown as 0 .
<4> An "X" character is used as a placeholder for illustration purposes in this manual. The LCD Operator will display the actual setting
values.
<5> The Speed Reference appears after the initial display which shows the product name. 4
<6> The information that appears on the display will vary depending on the drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 85
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
- MODE - PRG
Modified Consts
Verify Menu Modified YEG Lists all parameters that have been edited or changed from default settings. Refer to Verifying Parameter
X Parameters Changes: Verify Menu on page 89.
HELP FWD DATA
- MODE - PRG
Quick Setting
Programming A select list of parameters necessary to get the drive operating quickly. Refer to Using the Setup Group on
Mode Setup Group
YEG page 90.
- MODE - PRG
Programming
Parameter Setting
Mode Allows the user to access and edit all parameter settings. Refer to Parameter Table on page 346.
YEG
HELP FWD DATA
- MODE - PRG
Auto-Tuning
Auto-Tuning Mode Motor parameters are calculated and set automatically. Refer to Auto-Tuning on page 99.
Programming AUTO YEG
Mode
HELP FWD DATA
86 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
Speed reference
display at power up
F1 F2
- MODE - DRV Rdy -MONITR- DRV Rdy
Speed Ref (OPR) Spd Ref 1(d1-01) left right
U1-01= 0.00%
U1-01= 000.00%
U1-02= 0.00% RSEQ 㧔0.00㨪100.00㧕
U1-03= 0.00A LREF ̌0.00%̍
Press until the frequency
FWD FWD/REV
← FWD
→ reference changes to 010.00%
YEG
-MONITR- DRV Rdy -MONITR- DRV Rdy - MODE - DRV Rdy
Spd Ref 1(d1-01) Spd Ref 1(d1-01) Speed Ref (OPR)
ESC U1-01= 10.00%
U1-01= 010.00% U1-01= 010.00%
㧔0.00㨪100.00㧕 Entry Accepted 㧔0.00㨪100.00%㧕 U1-02= 0.00% RSEQ
̌0.00%̍ ̌0.00%̍ U1-03= 0.00A LREF
← FWD
→ ← FWD
→ FWD FWD/REV
Figure 4.6 Setting the Speed Reference while in the Drive Mode
Note: The drive will not accept a change to the speed reference until the ENTER key is pressed after the speed reference is entered.
This feature prevents accidental setting of the speed reference. To have the drive accept changes to the speed reference as soon as
changes are made without requiring the ENTER key, set o2-05 to 1.
Start-Up Programming
• Parameter Setting Mode: Access and edit all parameter settings.
• Verify Menu: Check a list of parameters that have been changed from their original default values.
• Setup Group: Access a list of commonly used parameters to simplify setup (refer to Simplified Setup Using the Setup
& Operation
Group on page 90).
• Auto-Tuning Mode: Automatically calculate and set motor parameters to optimize drive performance.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 87
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
Step Display/Result
- MODE - PRG
Programming
2.
Press or until the Parameter Setting Mode screen appears.
HELP FWD DATA
-PRMSET- PRG
Initialization
3. A1-00=0
Press to enter the parameter menu tree. Select Language
← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG
Basic Setup
4. C1-01 = 1.50 sec
Press or to select the C parameter group. Accel Ramp 1
← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG -PRMSET- PRG
Accel/Decel Accel Ramp 1
5. C1-01= 1.50 sec C1-01= 1.50 sec
Press two times. Accel Ramp 1
(0.0~600.00)
“1.50 sec”
← FWD
→ ← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG
Decel Ramp 1
6. C1-02= 1.50 sec
Press or to select the parameter C1-02. (0.0~600.00)
“1.50 sec”
φ FWD
ψ
-PRMSET- PRG
Decel Ramp 1
7. C1-02= 001.50 sec
Press to view the current setting value (1.50 s). The left most digit flashes. (0.0~600.00)
“1.50 sec”
← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG
Decel Ramp 1
8. Press F1 , F2 or until the desired number is selected. “1” flashes. C1-02=001.50 sec
(0.0~600.00)
left right “1.50 sec”
← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG
Decel Ramp 1
C1-02=002.50 sec
9. (0.0~600.00)
Press and enter 002.50.
“1.50 sec”
← FWD
→
10.
Press to confirm the change. Entry Accepted
-PRMSET- PRG
Decel Ramp 1
11. The display automatically returns to the screen shown in Step 4. C1-02= 2.50 sec
(0.0~600.00)
“1.50 sec”
φ FWD
ψ
- MODE - DRV Rdy
Speed Ref (OPR)
U1-01= 0.00%
12.
Press as many times as necessary to return to the initial display. U1-02= 0.00% RSEQ
U1-03= 0.00A LREF
FWD FWD/REV
88 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
The following example is a continuation of the steps above. Here, parameter C1-02 is accessed using the Verify Menu,
and is changed again from 1.50 s to 2.50 s.
The steps below are an example of how to check the list of edited parameters:
Step Display/Result
- MODE - PRG
Modified Consts
2. Press or until the display shows the top of the Verify Menu. Modified
X Parameters
HELP FWD DATA
Start-Up Programming
& Operation
4
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 89
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
Speed reference
appears when
powered up
- SETUP - PRG Rdy
<1> Control Method
A1-02= 2 ∗2∗
Open Loop Vector
<1> Use the up and down arrow keys to scroll through the Setup Group. Press the ENTER key to view or change parameter settings.
<2> To return to the previous menu without saving changes, press the ESC key.
90 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
Note: Parameter availability depends on the control mode set in A1-02; some parameters listed above may not be accessible in all
control modes.
Step Display/Result
Start-Up Programming
1. Turn on the power to the drive. The initial display appears. U1-01= 0.00%
U1-02= 0.00% RSEQ
U1-03= 0.00A RREF
YEG FWD FWD/REV
& Operation
DIGITAL OPERATOR JVOP-180 ALM
YEG
F1 F2
Press . The LO/RE light will light up. The drive is now in LOCAL. LO
2.
ESC
RE
RESET ENTER
4
RUN STOP
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 91
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
92 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
START
Start-Up Programming
Analog Input
& Operation
Set up: Set up:
• Acceleration/deceleration ramp (C1-) • Preset speed references (d1-)
• Jerk settings (C2-) • Acceleration/deceleration ramp (C1-)
• Jerk settings (C2-)
4
Set up the Inspection Operation sequence.
Fine-tuning
• Adjust settings for the brake sequence (S1-) .
• Adjust speed control loop (C5-) etc.
FINISH
Figure 4.8 Installation, Wiring, Basic Setup for Motor and Elevator
Note: Set parameter H5-11 to 1 when setting parameters using MEMOBUS/Modbus communications.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 93
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
Power On
Take the following precautions before applying main power to the drive:
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Ensure start/stop, I/O and safety circuits are wired properly and in the correct state before
energizing or running the drive. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury from moving equipment.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Do not use an improper voltage source. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire. Verify
that the rated voltage of the drive matches the voltage of the incoming power supply before applying power.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical
connections. Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Do not connect the AC power line to the output motor terminals of the drive. Failure to comply could result in
death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage application to output terminals.
• Do not connect AC line power to output terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3.
• Make sure that the power supply lines are connected to main circuit input terminals R/L1, S/L2, and T/L3
(or R/L1 and S/L2 for single-phase power).
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Clear personnel, secure equipment and check sequence and safety circuitry before starting
the drive. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury from moving equipment.
• Clear all personnel from the drive, motor, and machine area.
• Secure covers, couplings, shaft keys, and machine loads.
• Ensure start/stop and safety circuits are wired properly and in the correct state.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Operating a drive with untested emergency circuits could result in death or serious injury.
Always check the operation of any emergency circuits after they are wired. Emergency circuits are required to provide safe and quick
shutdown of the drive.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Comply with proper wiring practices. The motor may run in reverse if the phase order is backward.
Connect motor input terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 to drive output terminals U/T1,V/T2, and W/T3. The phase order for the drive and
motor should match.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Check all the wiring including the PG encoder wiring and PG option jumper settings, to ensure that all
connections are correct after installing the drive and connecting any other devices. Failure to comply could result in damage to the
drive.
After applying the power, the drive mode display should appear and no fault or alarm should be displayed. In the event of
a drive fault or error code, refer to Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors on page 254.
94 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
DANGER! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not connect or disconnect wiring while the power is on. Failure to comply will result in death or
serious injury. Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment. The internal capacitor remains charged even after the power
supply is turned off. The charge indicator LED will extinguish when the DC bus voltage is below 50 Vdc. To prevent electric shock, wait
at least five minutes after all indicators are OFF and measure the DC bus voltage level to confirm safe level.
Note: Always perform motor rotation direction setup prior to setting the encoder rotation direction.
PG Encoder Setup
PG Encoder Resolution Setup
Set the encoder resolution (incremental signal in the case of absolute encoders with Sin/Cos channels) in parameter F1-
01.
PG Encoder Rotation Direction Setup
Perform the following steps to make sure the PG encoder rotation direction is set up correctly in the drive.
If information about the signal sequence of the PG encoder is available:
1. Check the sequence of PG encoder phases A and B when the motor drives the elevator in the up direction.
2. If the PG encoder A phase leads phase B, make sure F1-05 is set to 0.
3. If the PG encoder B phase leads phase A, make sure F1-05 is set to 1.
If no information about the signal sequence of the PG encoder is available:
1. Turn the motor manually in elevator up direction while checking the value of monitor U1-05.
2. If the value in U1-05 is positive, the set PG encoder direction is correct.
3. If the value in U1-05 is negative, alter the setting of parameter F1-05.
Note: Always set the motor rotation direction prior to the encoder rotation direction. Refer to Motor Rotation Direction Setup on
page 94.
Display Unit
o1-03 Setting Speed Setting/Monitors Accel/Decel Ramp Jerk Settings
(d1-, U1-02, U1-02,...) (C1-) (C2-)
Start-Up Programming
0 0.01 Hz
1 (default) 0.01% 0.01 s 0.01 s
Set as the time in required to accelerate from zero Set as the time used to change the accel/decel ramp
2 1 rpm
to the rated speed, and to decelerate from rated from zero to the accel/decel ramp setting of C1-
3 User defined speed to zero. and vice versa.
& Operation
4 0.01 m/s
5 0.01 m/s 0.01 m/s2 (Set as accel/decel ramp) 0.01 m/s3 (set as jerk value)
6 0.1 ft/min 0.01 ft/s2 (Set as accel/decel ramp) 0.01 ft/s3 (set as jerk value)
Certain mechanical data must be programmed to the drive prior to setting o1-03 to 4, 5, or 6. Perform the following steps 4
when using one of those settings:
1. Make sure motor data are set up correctly. Verify the setting of the maximum output frequency in parameter E1-
04 and the setting for the number of motor poles in parameter E2-04 or E5-04.
2. Set the traction sheave diameter in units of mm to parameter o1-20.
3. Set the correct roping to parameter o1-21.
4. If a mechanical gear is used, set the gear ratio (nMotor/nTraction Sheave) to parameter o1-22. If a gearbox is not used,
make sure o1-22 is set to 1.0.
5. Change parameter o1-03 to setting 4 or 5. The unit and setting values of related parameters will be changed
automatically.
Refer to o1: Digital Operator Display Selection on page 371 for details.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 95
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
START
YEG
No
Yes
A1-02=2 or 3
(Ropes removed)
Is the Control Mode Can the motor
V/f Control ? rotate freely?
Yes
A1-02=0 No
Refer to Enter the data in to T1- parameters as indicated on the Enter the data in to T1- parameters as
Auto-Tuning Fault Detection display. indicated on the display.
on page 279. Press the Up key until “Tuning Ready” is displayed. <1> Press the Up key until “Tuning Ready” is
Remove the source of Fault/Alarm displayed. <1>
and repeat Auto Tuning.
Release the Brake.
Tuning
No Successful?
(Alarm or Fault code
displayed Yes
(“Entry Accepted”
displayed) <2>
FINISH
96 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
START
Set terminals H1-HC and H2-HC if Safe Disable function is used. YEG
Set the Baseblock input (H1- = 8/9) if used.
No
Is the motor data
sheet available?
Yes
No
(Alarm or Fault code
Tuning displayed
Successful?
Yes
(“Entry Accepted”
displayed<2>
Start-Up Programming
Continue with encoder offset tuning.
Refer to Flowchart D: PG Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning on page 98.
& Operation
Can the motor No
rotate freely?
FINISH
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 97
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
START
Yes
(Stationary PG Encoder Offset Absolute PG No
Auto-Tuning possible)
encoder used? (PG-X3, Incremental
Yes PG encoder used)
(EnDat, ...)
No Refer to
Tuning Auto-Tuning Fault Detection
Successful? on page 279.
Remove the Fault/Alarm source
Yes and repeat Auto Tuning.
FINISH
98 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.5 Auto-Tuning
4.5 Auto-Tuning
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. The drive and motor may start unexpectedly during Auto-Tuning, which could result in death
or serious injury. Ensure the area surrounding the drive motor and load are clear before proceeding with Auto-Tuning. Remove main
power from the drive before servicing the drive or motor. Do not touch the motor during Auto-Tuning.
Note: When using a PM motor for the first time, or when replacing the drive or PM motor, always make sure that motor parameters are
set properly and the speed detection functions accurately prior to operation. Using a PM motor requires that the encoder offset be
set correctly in addition to entering motor data to corresponding parameters. If the motor, encoder, or drive are ever replaced, be
sure to perform Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning.
Insufficient torque can cause the elevator car to move in the direction of the load, or cause the motor to behave erratically
(reverse operation, stand still, sudden accelerations, etc.).
For more information, refer to the instruction manual included with the motor.
Types of Auto-Tuning
The drive offers different types of Auto-Tuning for induction motors and permanent magnet motors. The type of Auto-
Tuning used differs further based on the control mode and other operating conditions. Refer to the tables below to select
the type of Auto-Tuning that bests suits the application. Directions for performing Auto-Tuning are listed in Start-Up
Flowcharts on page 92.
Note: The drive will only show Auto-Tuning parameters that are valid for the control mode that has been set in A1-02. If the control
mode is for an induction motor, the Auto-Tuning parameters for PM motors will not be available. If the control mode is for a PM
motor, the Auto-Tuning parameters for induction motors will not be available. Inertia Tuning and ASR Gain Tuning parameters
and setting options will be visible only when the drive is set for operation with CLV or CLV/PM.
Start-Up Programming
Stationary Auto-Tuning for the motor cable has changed.
T1-01 = 2 Yes Yes Yes
Line-to-Line Resistance • Used in V/f control if drive and motor capacities differ.
• Should not be used for any vector control modes unless the motor cable has changed.
• A motor test report is available. Once the no-load current and the rated slip have been entered, the drive
& Operation
Stationary Auto-Tuning 2 T1-01 = 4 calculates and sets all other motor-related parameters. No Yes Yes
• Use if ropes cannot be removed and if slip and no-load current data are available.
Table 4.6 lists the data that must be entered for Auto-Tuning. Make sure this data is available before starting Auto-
Tuning. The necessary information is usually listed on the motor nameplate or in the motor test report provided by the
motor manufacturer. Also refer to Flowchart B: Auto-Tuning for Induction Motors on page 96 for details on Auto- 4
Tuning process and selections.
Table 4.6 Auto-Tuning Input Data
Tuning Type (T1-01)
Input 2
Input Value Unit 0 1 4
Parameter Line-to-Line
Standard Stationary 1 Stationary 2
Resistance
Control Mode A1-02 – 2, 3 2, 3 0, 1, 2, 3 2, 3
Motor Rated Power T1-02 kW YES YES YES YES
Motor Rated Voltage T1-03 Vac YES YES N/A YES
Motor Rated Current T1-04 A YES YES YES YES
Motor Rated Frequency T1-05 Hz YES YES N/A YES
Number of Motor Poles T1-06 – YES YES N/A YES
Motor Rated Speed T1-07 r/min YES YES N/A YES
PG Number of Pulses per Revolution T1-08 – YES <1> YES <1> N/A YES <1>
Motor No-load Current T1-09 A N/A YES N/A YES
Motor Rated Slip T1-10 Hz N/A N/A N/A YES
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 99
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Table 4.8 lists the data that must be entered for Auto-Tuning. Make sure the data is available before starting Auto-
Tuning. The information needed is usually listed on the motor nameplate or in the motor test report provided by the
motor manufacturer. Also refer to Flowchart C: Auto-Tuning for PM Motors on page 97 for details on the tuning mode
selection and the tuning process.
Table 4.8 Auto-Tuning Input Data
Tuning Type (T2-01)
3 12
Initial 4 10 Auto-
Input 0 2 Encoder Encoder
Input Value Unit Magnet 11 Tuning of
Parameter Motor 1 Stationary Pole Search Offset Offset
Back EMF PG-E3
Parameter Stationary Stator Parameters Stationary Rotational
Settings Resistance Auto- Auto- Constant Encoder
Auto- Character-
Tuning Tuning Tuning istics
Control Mode A1-02 – 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7
Motor Rated Power T2-04 kW Yes Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
Motor Rated Voltage T2-05 V Yes Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
Motor Rated Current T2-06 A Yes Yes Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
Number of Motor Poles T2-08 N/A Yes Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
Motor Rated Speed T2-09 r/min Yes Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
Stator 1 Phase Resistance T2-10 Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
d-Axis Inductance T2-11 mH Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
q-Axis Inductance T2-12 mH Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
Induced Voltage Constant Unit
T2-13 N/A Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
Selection
Voltage Constant T2-14 <2> Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
PG Number of Pulses per
T2-16 N/A Yes Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
Revolution
Z Pulse Offset T2-17 deg (mech.) Yes N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
Speed Reference for
Auto-Tuning of PG-E3 Encoder T2-18 r/min N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A Yes
Characteristics <1>
Rotation Direction for
Auto-Tuning of PG-E3 Encoder T2-19 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A Yes
Characteristics <1>
100 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Start-Up Programming
of parameters F1-66 to F1-81 are modified at completion of Auto-Tuning of PG-E3 encoder characteristics.
& Operation
Check the items below before Auto-Tuning the drive.
Basic Auto-Tuning Preparations and Precautions
4
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. When performing Rotational Auto-Tuning for motor data or PG encoder offset, always
uncouple the motor from the mechanical system (remove ropes from traction sheave). Performing Rotational Auto-Tuning with the
mechanical system connected to the motor can cause hazardous situations, injury to personnel and damage to the equipment.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not touch the motor during Auto-Tuning. Lethal voltages may be present on the motor case.
Failure to comply may result in serious injury from electrical shock.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. When executing Stationary Auto-Tuning for motor data or PG encoder offset, the motor does not
rotate, however, power is applied. Do not touch the motor until Auto-Tuning is completed. Failure to comply may result in death or
serious injury from electrical shock.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Use parameter S1-12 to enable/disable automatic switching of the Motor Contactor Control
output signal during Auto-Tuning. When using setting S1-12 = 1 or 2, ensure that the multi-function output terminals are properly wired
and in the correct state before setting parameter S1-12. Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive, serious injury or death.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. If installed, do not release the mechanical brake during Stationary Auto-Tuning. Inadvertent
brake release may cause damage to equipment or injury to personnel. Ensure that the mechanical brake release circuit is not
controlled by the drive multi-function digital outputs.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 101
4.5 Auto-Tuning
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. System may start unexpectedly upon application of power, resulting in death or serious injury.
Clear all personnel from the drive, motor and machine area before applying power. Secure covers, couplings, shaft keys and machine
loads before applying power to the drive.
Table 4.10 describes digital input and output terminal operation while Auto-Tuning is executed.
Table 4.10 Digital Input and Output Operation During Auto-Tuning
Motor Type Auto-Tuning Type Digital Input Digital Output
Rotational Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Functions the same as during normal operation
Stationary Auto-Tuning 1 Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
IM Motor
Stationary Auto-Tuning for Line-to-Line Resistance Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Stationary Auto-Tuning 2 Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Motor Data Input Digital input functions are disabled. Digital output functions are disabled.
Stationary Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Stationary Stator Resistance Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Initial Magnet Pole Search Parameters Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
PM Motor
Stationary PG Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Rotational PG Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Rotational Back EMF Constant Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Functions the same as during normal operation
Auto-Tuning of PG-E3 Encoder Characteristics Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Note: When using a PM motor for the first time or when replacing the drive or PM motor, be sure to set the motor parameters properly
and check that the speed detection functions properly prior to operation. Using a PM motor requires setting the encoder offset
correctly and entering motor data. Perform Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning after replacing the motor, encoder, or drive. Insufficient
torque may cause the elevator car to move in the direction of the load or cause the motor to behave erratically (reverse operation,
stand still, sudden accelerations, etc.). For more information, refer to the instruction manual included with the motor.
102 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Step Display/Result
- MODE - DRV Rdy
Speed Ref (OPR)
U1-01= 0.00%
1. Turn on the power to the drive. The initial display appears.
U1-02= 0.00% RSEQ
U1-03= 0.00A LREF
FWD FWD/REV
- MODE - PRG
Auto-Tuning
2.
Press or until the Auto-Tuning display appears. AUTO
- A.TUNE - PRG
Tuning Mode
3. Press to begin setting parameters.
T1-01= 0 ∗0∗
Standard Tuning
- A.TUNE - PRG
Tuning Mode
4. T1-01= 0 ∗0∗
Press to select the value for T1-01. Standard Tuning
“0”
FWD
5.
Save the setting by pressing . Entry Accepted
- A.TUNE - PRG
Tuning Mode
6. The display automatically returns to the display shown in Step 3. T1-01= 0 ∗0∗
Standard Tuning
Start-Up Programming
Note: These instructions continue from Step 6 in “Selecting the Type of Auto-Tuning”.
Step Display/Result
& Operation
- A.TUNE - PRG
Mtr Rated Power
1. T1-02= 3.70kW
Press to access the motor output power parameter T1-02. (0.00 ~ 650.00)
“3.70kW”
ESC FWD DATA
- A.TUNE - PRG
4
Mtr Rated Power
2. T1-02= 003.70kW
Press to view the default setting. (0.00 ~ 650.00)
“3.70kW”
FWD
- A.TUNE - PRG
Mtr Rated Power
3. Press F1 , F2 , , and to enter the motor power nameplate data in kW. T1-02= 004.00kW
left right (0.00 ~ 650.00)
“3.70kW”
FWD
4.
Press to save the setting. Entry Accepted
- A.TUNE - PRG
Mtr Rated Power
5. The display automatically returns to the display in Step 1. T1-02= 4.00kW
(0.00 ~ 650.00)
“3.70kW”
ESC FWD DATA
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 103
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Step Display/Result
- A.TUNE - PRG
Mtr Rated Power
T1-02= 4.00kW
(0.00 ~ 650.00)
“3.70kW”
Repeat Steps 1 through 5 to set the following parameters: ESC FWD DATA
• T1-03, Motor Rated Voltage
• T1-04, Motor Rated Current
6.
• T1-05, Motor Base Frequency
• T1-06, Number of Motor Poles
• T1-07, Motor Base Speed - A.TUNE - PRG
Rated Speed
T1-07= 1450RPM
(0 ~ 24000)
“1450RPM”
ESC FWD DATA
Note: Refer to Parameter Settings during Induction Motor Auto-Tuning: T1 on page 105 for details.
Starting Auto-Tuning
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. The drive and motor may start unexpectedly during Auto-Tuning, which could result in death
or serious injury. Ensure the areas surrounding the drive, motor and load are clear before proceeding with Auto-Tuning.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. High voltage will be supplied to the motor when Stationary Auto-Tuning is performed even with
the motor stopped, which could result in death or serious injury. Do not touch the motor until Auto-Tuning has been completed.
WARNING! When performing Rotational Auto-Tuning for motor data or PG encoder offset, always uncouple the motor from the
mechanical system (remove ropes from traction sheave). Performing Rotational Auto-Tuning with the mechanical system connected to
the motor can cause hazardous situations, injury to personnel and damage to the equipment.
NOTICE: Rotational Auto-Tuning will not function properly if a holding brake is applied on the load. Ensure the motor can freely spin
before beginning Auto-Tuning. Failure to comply could result in improper operation of the drive.
Enter the required information from the motor nameplate. Press to proceed to the Auto-Tuning start display.
Note: These instructions continue from Step 6 in “Enter Data from the Motor Nameplate”.
Step Display/Result
- A.TUNE - DRV
Auto-Tuning
1. 0.00 Hz/ 0.00A
After entering the data listed on the motor nameplate, press to confirm. Tuning Ready ?
Press RUN key
ESC FWD
- MODE - DRV
FWD RESET
104 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Start-Up Programming
T1-03 Motor Rated Voltage 0.0 to 255.5 V <1> 200.0 V <1>
<1> Values shown are specific to 200 V class drives. Double value for 400 V class drives.
& Operation
T1-04: Motor Rated Current
Sets the motor rated current according to the motor nameplate value. Set the motor rated current between 50% and 100%
of the drive rated current for optimal performance in OLV or CLV. Enter the current at the motor base speed.
4
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
T1-04 Motor Rated Current 10 to 200% of drive rated current Depending on o2-04
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 105
4.5 Auto-Tuning
<1> The value will have two decimal places (0.01 A) in the drive models 20008 to 20033 and 40005 to 40018 (refer to Table A.1 and
Table A.2), and one decimal place (0.1 A) in the drive models 20047 to 20415 and 40024 to 40216.
106 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Start-Up Programming
<1> Values shown are specific to 200 V class drives. Double value for 400 V class drives.
& Operation
Enter the PM motor rated current in amps.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 107
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Setting 0: mV/min-1
Setting 1: mVs/rad
Note: If T2-13 is set to 0, then the drive will use E5-24 (Motor Induction Voltage Constant 2), and will automatically set E5-09 (Motor
Induction Voltage Constant 1) to 0.0. If T2-13 is set to 1, then the drive will use E5-09 and will automatically set E5-24 to 0.0.
Sets the speed reference for execution of Auto-Tuning of PG-E3 encoder characteristics (T2-01 = 12).
108 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Sets the direction of motor rotation for execution of Auto-Tuning of PG-E3 encoder characteristics (T2-01 = 12).
Start-Up Programming
& Operation
4
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 109
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Verify drive parameter b1-03 Stopping Method is set to 0:Ramp to Stop before starting the
drive. Failure to comply may cause the elevator to free-fall when the Up/Down command is removed.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. The drive is capable of running the motor at high speed. Verify the maximum drive output
frequency before starting the drive. Failure to comply may cause injury or death due to inadvertent high speed operation.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Use the Initial Pole Search Status Signal (H2- = 61) to interlock the brake to ensure the
brake is not released before the Initial Magnetic Pole Search is completed. Failure to comply may cause inadvertent elevator
movement resulting in serious injury.
NOTICE: Always turn off the RUN command before changing the setting of parameters d1-18 (Speed Reference Selection Mode), b1-
01 (Speed Reference Selection), or H1- (Multi-Function Digital Inputs). If the RUN command is on when changing any of these
settings, the motor may unexpectedly start running, and could result in injury.
<1> If source of the speed reference is assigned to the control terminals (b1-01 = 1), then d1-18 will automatically be set to 0 (so that the drive uses
multi-speed references d1-01 to d1-08).
<2> If the speed reference selection in d1-18 is set so that either the high speed reference has priority (d1-18 = 1), or so that the leveling speed has
priority (d1-18 = 2), then the drive will look to the multi-function input terminals for the speed reference.
110 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Travel Stop
The drive stops under the following conditions:
• The Up or Down command is removed.
• d1-18 is set to 1 or 2 and the Up/Down or Leveling Speed signal (H1- = 53) is removed.
• d1-18 is set to 3 and all speed inputs are removed.
• A fault occurs. The stopping method depends on the specific fault that occurred, in combination with certain parameter
settings.
• The Safe Disable inputs are opened or a Base Block signal is input. In this case, the brake is applied immediately and
the drive output shuts off.
Different speed reference settings can be selected by combining the three digital inputs as shown in the table below.
Start-Up Programming
Note: Parameters d1-19 through d1-26 are displayed only if d1-18 is set to 1 or 2.
& Operation
Multi-Speed Multi-Speed Multi-Speed
d1-18 = 0 d1-18 = 3
Reference 1 Reference 2 Reference 3
0 0 0 Speed reference 1 (d1-01) Stop
1 0 0 Speed reference 2 (d1-02 or terminal A1, A2 input value if H3-02 or H3-10 is set to 2)
0 1 0 Speed reference 3 (d1-03 or terminal A1, A2 input value if H3-02 or H3-10 is set to 3)
1 1 0 Speed reference 4 (d1-04)
4
0 0 1 Speed reference 5 (d1-05)
1 0 1 Speed reference 6 (d1-06)
0 1 1 Speed reference 7 (d1-07)
1 1 1 Speed reference 8 (d1-08)
0 = Off, 1 = On
Setting d1-18 = 0
Up to eight speed references can be set using parameters d1-01 to d1-08. The drive starts with an Up or Down command,
and stops when the Up or Down command is removed. When d1-18 = 0, parameters d1-19 through d1-23 will not be
displayed.
Setting d1-18 = 3
Allows seven speed references to be set using parameters d1-02 to d1-08. The drive starts with an Up or Down
command, and stops either when all three input terminals that set the speed reference are released, or when the Up/Down
command is released. When d1-18 = 0, parameters d1-19 through d1-23 will not be displayed.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 111
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Different speed settings can be selected depending on the assignment of the speed selection digital inputs (H1-) as
shown in the table below.
Note: Parameters d1-19 through d1-26 are displayed only if d1-18 is set to 1 or 2.
Leveling and Nominal Speed assigned Leveling speed not assigned Nominal Speed not assigned
Selected Speed (H1-50 and H1-53) (H1- 53) (H1- 50)
50 51 52 53 50 51 52 51 52 53
Nominal Speed (d1-19) 1 0 0 A 1 0 0 0 0 0
Intermediate Speed 1 (d1-20) 0 1 0 A 0 1 0 1 0 0
Intermediate Speed 2 (d1-21) 1 1 1 A 1 1 1 N/A N/A N/A
Intermediate Speed 3 (d1-22) 0 1 1 A 0 1 1 1 1 0
Releveling Speed (d1-23) 0 0 1 A 0 0 1 0 1 0
Leveling Speed (d1-26) 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 B B B
Zero Speed 0 0 0 0 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
0 = Off, 1 = On, A = 0 when d1-18 = 2 and no influence when d1-18=1, B = no influence, N/A = Not available
Higher Speed has Priority and the Leveling Speed Input is Assigned (d1-18 = 1 and H1- = 53) (Default)
The higher speed has priority over the leveling speed. The leveling signal is disregarded as long as any other speed
selection input is active. The drive decelerates to the leveling speed (d1-26) when the selected speed reference signal is
removed.
DC Injection/ DC Injection/
Position lock Position lock
Speed
Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on)
and Baseblock off (H1- = 8/9)
Up/Down Command
Leveling speed
Selected speed (other than leveling)
Input is set No effect
Higher Speed Priority is Selected and the Leveling Speed Input is Not Assigned (d1-18 = 1 and H1- 53)
The drive decelerates to the leveling speed (d1-26) when the selected speed reference signal is removed.
If no speed reference is selected at start, the drive will trigger an “FrL” fault. Set parameter S6-15 to 0 to disable Speed
Reference Missing (FrL) detection. With this setting the drive starts using leveling speed if no other speed reference is
selected.
DC Injection/ DC Injection/
Position lock Position lock
Speed
112 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Leveling Speed has Priority and the Leveling Speed Input is Assigned (d1-18 = 2, H1- = 53)
The leveling signal has priority over other speed references. The drive decelerates to the leveling speed (d1-26) when the
leveling speed selection input is activated. The drive stops when either the leveling input or the Up/Down command is
released.
DC Injection/ DC Injection/
Position lock Position lock
Speed
Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on)
and Baseblock off (H1- = 8/9)
Up/Down Command
Leveling speed Leveling speed has priority
Leveling Speed Priority is Selected and the Nominal Speed Input is Not Assigned (d1-18 = 2, H1- 50)
The drive runs at nominal speed (d1-19) when no speed selection input is set. When the leveling speed signal is set, the
drive decelerates to the leveling speed. The leveling speed signal has priority over all other speed signals.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. This function may not work properly if a broken wire connection to the drive I/O causes improper
elevator speed selection. Properly tighten wire connections at the drive terminals before enabling this function.
DC Injection/ DC Injection/
position lock position lock
Speed
Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on)
and Baseblock off (H1- = 8/9)
Up/Down Command
Leveling speed
Input is set No effect
Start-Up Programming
Multi-Function Analog Inputs
The H3 parameters assign functions to analog input terminals A1 and A2 analog input functions, refer to Multi-Function
Analog Input Terminal Settings on page 198.
& Operation
Multi-Function Analog Outputs
The H4 parameters assign functions to analog output terminals FM and AM. Select the function for these terminals by
entering the last three digits of the desired U monitor. For a list of analog output functions, refer to U: Monitors on
page 379.
4
C2-03
(Jerk at
C2-02 Decel Start)
(Jerk at
Accel End) C2-04
(Jerk at
C2-01 Decel End) C2-05 (Jerk Below Leveling Speed)
C1-01
(Jerk at (Accel Ramp 1)
Accel Start) d1-26 (Leveling Speed)
C1-02
(Decel Ramp 1)
Figure 4.13 Accel/Decel Ramp and the Jerk Function
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 113
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Units used to set the acceleration and deceleration ramp as well as the Jerk function change with the setting of parameter
o1-03. Refer to Digital Operator Display Unit Selection on page 95 for details.
Selected Speed
S1-11
(Output Contactor Open
DC Injection Braking/ S1-26 Delay Time)
Position Lock at Start Emergency Stop
Speed Start Level Coast to Stop
Up/Down Command
Enabled
Enabled
Figure 4.15 With Up/Down command cleared and U1-05 < S1-26
114 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Inspection Operation
Start Condition in Inspection Operation
NOTICE: Always turn off the RUN command before changing the setting of parameters d1-18 (Speed Reference Selection Mode), b1-
01 (Speed Reference Selection), or H1- (Multi-Function Digital Inputs). If the RUN command is on when changing any of these
settings, the motor may unexpectedly start running, and could result in injury.
Inspection operation is performed when an Up or Down signal is input while one of the following conditions is true:
• Parameter d1-18 is set to 0 or 3 and the selected speed is higher than d1-28 but lower than d1-29.
• Parameter d1-18 is set to 1 or 2 and a digital input programmed for Inspection Operation Speed (H1- = 54) is
enabled.
Inspection Operation uses the same acceleration characteristics and brake sequence at start as normal operation.
The carrier frequency is set to 2 kHz during Inspection Operation, but can be changed using parameter C6-21.
Stop Condition in Inspection Operation
To stop the drive during Inspection Operation, either remove the Up or Down command or reset the input terminal for
Inspection Operation.
A deceleration ramp can be set for Inspection Operation using parameter C1-15.
• If C1-15 = 0.00, the drive immediately applies the brake, shuts off the drive output, and opens the motor contactor, i.e.,
the multi-function output terminals set for “Brake Control” (H2- = 50) and “Output Contactor Control” (H2- =
51) are cleared.
• If C1-15 > 0.00, the drive decelerates to stop at the rate set to C1-15, then applies the brake, shuts the output off, and
opens the motor contactor.
Inspection Operation Timing Chart
A timing chart for Inspection Operation appears in Figure 4.16.
Inspection Operation without Decel Ramp (C1-15 = 0) Inspection Operation with Decel Ramp (C1-15 > 0)
Start-Up Programming
Speed Speed
Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on) Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on)
and Baseblock off (H1- = 8/9) and Baseblock off (H1- = 8/9)
H1- = 54 (Inspection Operation) H1- = 54 (Inspection Operation)
<1> <1>
& Operation
Up/Down command Up/Down command
H2- = 51 (Output Cont. Contr.) H2- = 51 (Output Cont. Contr.)
H2- = 50 (Brake Control) H2- = 50 (Brake Control)
Enabled
<1> The drive stops if either the Up/Down command or Inspection Operation signals are removed. 4
Figure 4.16 Inspection Operation Sequence
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 115
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Brake Sequence
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Rapid deceleration may cause the drive to fault on an overvoltage condition, resulting in death
or serious injury due to an uncontrolled motor state. Be sure to set an acceptable deceleration time in parameter C1-09, Emergency
Stop Ramp, when using the fast-stop feature.
NOTICE: Always turn off the RUN command before changing the setting of parameters d1-18 (Speed Reference Selection Mode), b1-
01 (Speed Reference Selection), or H1-(Multi-Function Digital Inputs). If the RUN command is on when changing any of these
settings, the motor may unexpectedly start running, and could result in injury.
The drive supports two types of brake sequences, one with torque compensation at start using an analog input terminal
(H3- = 14) and the other without torque compensation at start.
Brake Sequence without Torque Compensation
To configure the brake sequence operation without torque compensation, do not set any analog input terminals for
“Torque compensation” (H3- = 14).
Figure 4.12
S1-04 S1-05
S1-10 (DC Injection/ Selected Speed (DC Injection
(Up/Down Command PositionLock Braking/Position
Time at Start) Lock Time at stop) S1-11
Delay Time) d1-26 (Output Contactor
DC Injection Braking/ (Leveling Speed) DC Injection/ Open Delay Time)
Position Lock at Start Position Lock at Stop
Speed
S1-06 S1-07
(Brake (Brake
Release Close
Delay
Time) Delay
Up/Down Command Time)
Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on)
and Baseblock off (H1- = 8/9)
Output Contactor Control
(H2-= 51)
Motor Contactor Response
(H1- = 56)
Brake Control (H2- = 50)
t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9
Enabled
116 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9
Enabled
Start-Up Programming
If the motor contactor feedback signal is not used, then the drive waits for the operation start delay time set in S1-10 to pass, then proceeds to the
next step.
The drive reads the torque value from the analog input (load cell).
& Operation
After the delay time set in S1-10 has passed, the drive outputs current to the motor. Position Lock begins.
The torque value from the analog input is latched and internal torque compensation value is increased from zero to the latched value using the
t2 time constant set in S3-10.
After the internal torque compensation level reaches the latched value, the drive sets the “Brake Control” output (H2- = 50) in order to release
the brake.
t3 The brake is released and the drive executes Position Lock until the time set in S1-04 has passed. 4
The drive accelerates up to the selected speed.
t4 After the torque compensation diminish speed level (S3-14) is reached during acceleration, the internal torque compensation value is reduced in
accordance with the time constant set in S3-10.
t5 Leveling speed is selected. The drive decelerates to the leveling speed and maintains that speed until the Up or Down command is removed.
t6 The Up or Down signal is cleared. The drive decelerates to zero speed.
The motor speed reaches the zero speed level (S1-01).
t7 DC Injection Braking or Position Lock is then executed for the time set in S1-05.
After the delay time to close the brake set in S1-07 has passed, the drive clears the “Brake Control” output (H2- = 50). The brake applies.
t8 The drive continues DC Injection or Position Lock until the time S1-05 has passed. When S1-05 has passed the drive output is shut off.
After the delay for the magnetic contactor set in S1-11 has passed, the drive resets the output terminal set for “Output Contactor Control” (H2-
t9 = 51).
The Safe Disable Inputs can be cleared and Baseblock can be enabled.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 117
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
To use torque compensation at start, apply at least 50% of the maximum weight to the elevator car and set the drive
according to the Load Condition 2 procedure below. If using a voltage signal to the analog input terminals as a load
sensor, then that input signal will determine the rate of torque compensation applied according to S3-27 and S3-28.
Before the torque compensation function can be used, the analog input scaling must be adjusted to the load sensor output.
This can be done by bringing the elevator into two different load conditions and teaching the corresponding analog input
value and torque reference value to the drive.
Note: 1. This torque compensation requires a closed loop control mode (CLV, CLV/PM).
2. The torque compensation value is limited to 120%.
Set an analog input terminal for torque compensation (H3- = 14) and proceed with the steps below.
Procedure for Load Condition 1 (S3-27, S3-29)
1. Make sure the drive is wired properly. For instructions, refer to Standard Connection Diagram on page 50.
2. Set the speed reference to 0%.
3. Apply no weight to the elevator car.
4. Note the value of the analog input monitor for the load signal input is connected to (U1-13 for terminal A1, U1-14
for terminal A2).
5. Provide an elevator Up or Down command, using Inspection Operation or normal operation mode. The car
should be held in place when the brake releases.
6. Note the drives internal torque reference monitor U1-09.
7. Stop the drive.
8. Set the value noted in step 4 to parameter S3-29. Set the value noted in step 6 to parameter S3-27.
Procedure for Load Condition 2 (S3-28, S3-30)
1. Set the speed reference to 0%.
2. Apply load to the car has much as possible (at least 50% of the maximum weight).
3. Note the value of the analog input monitor for the load signal input connected to (U1-13 for terminal A1, U1-14
for terminal A2).
4. Provide an elevator Up or Down command, using Inspection Operation or normal operation mode. The car
should be held in place when the brake releases.
5. Note the drives internal torque reference monitor U1-09.
6. Stop the drive.
7. Set the value noted in step 3 to parameter S3-30. Set the value noted in step 5 to parameter S3-28.
Figure 4.19 shows the Torque Compensation at Start settings with parameters S3-27 to S3-30.
The solid line in Figure 4.19 indicates the torque compensation at start when the elevator moves up or down.
Figure 4.14
S3-28
During Load Condition 2
(Torque Compensation
Value with Load Condition 2) S3-29
(Analog Input from
Load Sensor
with Load
Condition 1)
Analog Input Voltage (V)
0 S3-30
(Analog input
S3-27 from Load Sensor
(Torque Compensation Value with Load Condition 2)
with Load Condition 1)
During Load Condition 1
Figure 4.19 Torque Compensation at start for the Elevator in Up and Down Direction
Note: PRG: 7015 or earlier will apply a limit at 0 V torque compensation input value.
PRG: 7016 or later have no torque compensation limit when adding negative voltage to analog input voltage (see Figure 4.19).
118 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
After setting load conditions 1 and 2, perform a trial run. If required, parameter S3-12 can be set up to add a bias to the
load sensor input when riding in a Down direction (default: 0.0%, same torque compensation characteristics in up and
down direction). Figure 4.20 illustrates the effect of torque compensation on the settings of S3-12 and S3-27 through S3-
30.
Figure 4.15
S3-27
(Torque Compensation Value
with Load Condition 1) During Load Condition 1
Figure 4.20 Torque Compensation at start for the Elevator in Up and Down Direction
Start-Up Programming
& Operation
4
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 119
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
π nr_Mot
Motor Acceleration Time n5-02 n5-02 = JMot • JMot - Motor inertia in kgm2
30 Tr_Mot • nr_Mot - Rated motor speed in min-1
• Tr_Mot - Rated motor torque in Nm
30 vr_Elev 2 • JTS - Traction sheave inertia in kgm2
ΣJ = JTS i2 + Σm • i - Gear ratio (nLoad/nMot)
Inertia Compensation Gain π nr_Mot
n5-03 • vr_Elev - Rated elevator speed in m/s
• m - Mass of all moved parts (car, counterweight, ropes, load <1>) in kg
n5-03 = ΣJ / JMot
<1> Insert 0 kg for the load to calculate the lowest setting, insert the elevator rated load to calculate the maximum setting for n5-03. Use the lower
setting for initial trials.
4. Change the setting of n5-03 within the limits calculated in step 3 until the desired performance is achieved.
If possible, trace the output speed after soft starter (U1-16) and the motor speed (U1-05) values. Increase n5-03
if the motor speed does not follow the speed after soft start. Decrease n5-03 if the motor overshoots the
designated speed at the end of acceleration or undershoots the speed at the end of deceleration.
120 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Rescue Operation
In the event of a power outage, Rescue Operation allows the elevator to travel to the nearest floor by switching to a
backup battery or UPS (Uninterruptable Power Supply) for power.
An input terminal set for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55) can be used to initiate Rescue Operation. During Rescue
Operation, the drive uses the speed reference set in S4-15 to travel to the nearest floor.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Do not use the Rescue Operation feature for extended periods. Failure to comply may result in drive
heat sink overtemperature alarms (oH).
NOTICE: When changing parameters while the drive is supplied from the rescue operation power supply, wait at least 5 s after
entering parameters before switching off the power supply. Instantly switching off the power can cause parameter settings corruption
that can only be resolved by initializing the drive. This may cause erroneous drive performance.
NOTICE: Always turn off the RUN command before changing the setting of parameters d1-18 (Speed Reference Selection Mode), b1-
01 (Speed Reference Selection), or H1- (Multi-Function Digital Inputs). If the RUN command is on when changing any of these
settings, the motor may unexpectedly start running, and could result in injury.
Start-Up Programming
If the DC bus voltage is low, the overload protection level (oL2 fault detection level) will be reduced due to the low speed
run and the drive overload (oL2) will be triggered. If oL2 is detected, select the battery or UPS so that the output speed is
equal to or greater than 6 Hz.
& Operation
The upper speed limit during rescue operation can be monitored by U4-40.
Table 4.13 Power Supply Ratings for Rescue Operation
Motor Type Speed Feedback DC Bus Voltage Control Circuit Voltage
Without PG Encoder or Incremental PG 200 V class drives: 48 to 340 Vdc 4
Induction Motor
Encoder with PG-B3 or PG-X3 option card 400 V class drives: 48 to 680 Vdc
Incremental PG Encoder with PG-X3 option
card 200 V class drives: 280 to 340 Vdc When supplied from a battery or the drive DC bus:
“End8” to “End10” error occurs during Initial 400 V class drives: 560 to 680 Vdc 200 V class drives: 250 to 340 Vdc
Magnet Pole Search Auto-Tuning. 400 V class drives: 280 to 680 V (recommended: 500 to 680 Vdc)
Incremental PG Encoder with PG-X3 option
Permanent Magnet Motor When supplied via a 24 Vdc control power backup unit:
card 200 V class drives: 72 to 340 Vdc
No error occurs during Initial Magnet Pole 400 V class drives: 144 to 680 Vdc 200 V and 400 V class drives: 24 Vdc
Search Auto-Tuning.
Absolute PG Encoder with PG-F3 or PG-E3 200 V class drives: 48 to 340 Vdc
option card 400 V class drives: 48 to 680 Vdc
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 121
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Parameter Setup
Adjust drive parameters as described below when using Rescue Operation.
• Select the type of Rescue Operation power supply for the drives main circuit in parameter S4-06.
• When using a UPS, set the UPS power value to parameter S4-07. Use parameter S4-08 to decide if the Rescue
Operation speed shall be limited automatically depending on the UPS power.
• If deterioration of the battery or UPS shall be detected, also set up parameters S4-12 and S4-13. Measure the DC bus
voltage during operation using the rescue power supply and set the measured value to parameter S4-12. Set the
deterioration detection level to parameter S4-13.
• Set parameters S4-01 to S4-04 if light load direction search shall be automatically performed when Rescue Operation
is started.
Wiring Examples
Switching the main power supply to a battery or UPS requires magnetic contactors that must be controlled by an external
controller. Wiring methods and the sequence used for the magnetic contactors depend on the application. This instruction
manual describes the following configurations:
• A single-phase, 230 V UPS is used as backup power supply for a 200 V or 400 V class drive.
• Two separate batteries for the main power and control power supplies. Main power battery voltage is below 250 Vdc
for 200 V class drives or 500 Vdc for 400 V class drives.
• Two separate batteries. One is used for the main power supply, a second battery supplies the controller via an optional
24 V Backup Power Supply Unit.
• A single battery with minimum 250 Vdc for 200 V class drives or 500 Vdc for 400 V class drives is used for the main
and control power supply.
Select the configuration that matches your application. Follow the corresponding instructions for wiring and drive
settings. For configurations not covered in the list above, contact your Yaskawa representative or our sales office directly
for consultation.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not connect or disconnect wiring while the power is on. Never remove or install option cards
or attempt to replace the cooling fan while the drive is switched on. Make sure that the drive and all devices connected to the drive
have been shut off prior to performing and type of maintenance or wiring. After shutting off the power, wait for at least the amount of
time specified on the drive before touching any components or perform wiring. The internal capacitor remains charged even after the
power supply is turned off.
NOTICE: Be sure to thoroughly read the instructions for wiring and magnetic contactor sequence described in this section before
setting up the drive for Rescue Operation. Failure to follow these instructions can damage the drive.
NOTICE: Refrain from using Rescue Operation for extend periods of time. Rescue Operation uses a low DC bus voltage, which can
cause the cooling fan to shut off temporarily during Rescue Operation. Continuing to operate under these conditions can trigger an
overheat fault and damage the drive.
NOTICE: Install the inrush current suppression circuit outside the drive if the DC bus battery voltage is lower than 190 Vdc for 200 V
NOTICE: Install the inrush current suppression circuit outside the drive if the DC bus battery voltage is lower than 190 Vdc for 200 V
class drives of models CIMR-L20215 to 20415 and 380 Vdc for 400 V class drives of models CIMR-L40150 to 40216.
Failure to comply will cause the soft-charge bypass relay to remain open and result in damage to the drive.
122 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Elevator
control
system Magnetic L1000A
Contactor A B2
N UPS
sine wave
230 Vac
single-phase +1
+2 U/T1
R/L1
L1 V/T2
S/L2
L2 W/T3
T/L3
L3
Magnetic -
Contactor B
Power supply Control
circuit
CN19
1
H1- = غغ55 S3 to S8
(Rescue Operation) SC
Magnetic Contactor A
H1- = غغ55
(Rescue Operation)
Operation Sequence
Start-Up Programming
Starting Rescue Operation
1. Open contactor B.
2. Set the input terminal programmed for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
& Operation
3. Close contactor A.
4. Set the Up/Down command.
Ending Rescue Operation
4
1. After the car has stopped open contactor A.
2. Clear the input terminal set for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Close contactor B to return to operation with normal power supply.
Application Precautions
The drive may fault on a control power supply fault (Uv2) if the UPS can’t provide enough voltage, or if the Light Load
Direction Search is not set properly. If this problem occurs, take the following corrective actions:
Corrective Action:
• Use a separate battery for the controller power supply.
• Use a battery with a voltage higher than 250 Vdc for 200 V class drives or 500 Vdc for 400 V class drives and connect
it to the control power supply input (CN19). Alternatively use a 24 Vdc battery and an optional 24 V Backup Power
Supply Unit.
• Enable Light Load Direction Search (S4-01 = 1).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 123
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Using Separate Batteries for DC Bus and Control Power Supply, DC Bus Battery under 250
Vdc (500 Vdc)
Follow these instructions when using separate batteries for Rescue Operation with the battery for the DC bus having a
lower voltage than 250 Vdc for 200 V class drives and 500 Vdc for 400V class drives.
Follow the wiring diagram shown in Figure 4.22 to Figure 4.24. When connecting the battery for the control power
supply to the L1000A, use the 1.1 m cable packaged with the product. The connector cover must first be removed in
order to access connection port CN19 for the battery. Refer to Connecting the Drive and Battery on page 131 for details.
Wiring for CIMR-L20008 to 20180 and 40005 to 40112
Figure 4.17
L1000A
YEG
B2
B1
Magnetic Contactor A
+1
+2 U/T1
DC bus power supply
Battery for DC bus R/L1
L1 V/T2
48 to 250 Vdc
S/L2
(48 to 500 Vdc) L2 W/T3
T/L3
L3
Magnetic Contactor B -
Control
Magnetic Contactor C Power supply
CN19 circuit
Battery for 1
control circuit
250 to 340 Vdc
(500 to 680 Vdc) 4
H1- = غغ55 S3 to S8
(Rescue Operation) SC
5s 0.5 s
Magnetic Contactor A
Magnetic Contactor C
H1- = غغ55
(Rescue Operation)
Figure 4.22 Wiring Two Batteries for DC Bus and Control Power Supply
(DC Bus Battery is less than 250 Vdc)
Operation Sequence
Starting Rescue Operation
1. Open contactor B and wait at least 5 seconds.
2. Set the input terminal programmed for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Close contactors A and C.
4. Set the Up/Down command.
Ending Rescue Operation
1. After the car has stopped, open contactors A and C.
2. Clear the input terminal set for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Wait at least 0.5 s and then close contactor B to return to operation with normal power supply.
124 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Wiring for CIMR-L20215 to 20415 and 40150 to 40216
• Voltage Lower Than 48 to 190 Vdc for 200 V Class Drives, 96 to 380 Vdc for 400 V Class Drives
Figure 4.18
Inrush current
suppression circuit <1>
Inrush current suppression resistor L1000A
(A)
+3
(D)
+1
DC bus Current
Relay
Battery for DC bus power supply (B) sensor
48 to 190 Vdc L1 R/L1
(48 to 380 Vdc) U/T1
L2 S/L2 + V/T2
L3 T/L3
W/T3
-
Power
YEG supply
board
Control OPE
board
Battery for control circuit (C) CN19
250 to 340 Vdc
(500 to 680 Vdc)
H1- = 55 S3 to S12
(Rescue Operation) SC
Magnetic Contactor B
Magnetic Contactor A
Magnetic Contactor C
Magnetic Contactor D
H1- = 55
(Rescue Operation)
Start-Up Programming
Figure 4.23 Voltage Lower Than 48 to 190 Vdc for 200 V Class Drives, 96 to 380 Vdc for 400 V Class Drives
& Operation
<1> Install the inrush current suppression circuit outside the drive if the DC bus battery voltage is lower than 190 Vdc for 200 V class drives
and 380 Vdc for 400 V class drives. Failure to comply will cause the soft-charge bypass relay to remain open and result in damage to the
drive.
Refer to the following table to install the inrush current suppression circuit for battery.
4
Table 4.14 Installation of the Inrush Current Suppression Circuit for Battery
Drive Model
Voltage Resistor Relay
CIMR-L
20215 1.0 , 80 W
20283 1.0 , 80 W
200 V
20346 1.0 , 80 W
20415 1.0 , 80 W <1>
40150 1.0 , 120 W
400 V 40180 1.0 , 220 W
40216 1.0 , 220 W
<1> Select the appropriate relay referring to the following calculation even if the battery voltage or main power current is applied.
Motor rated power (kW) × Operation frequency when running battery (Hz) × 2 × 1000
Load current of battery (A) =
Battery voltage (Vdc) × 0.6 (Motor efficiency) × Motor rated frequency (Hz)
YEG
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 125
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
• Voltage Lower Than 190 to 250 Vdc for 200 V Class Drives, 380 to 680 Vdc for 400 V Class Drives
Figure 4.19
L1000A
+3
(A)
+1
DC bus Relay Current
DC bus power supply power supply (B) sensor
190 to 250 Vdc L1 R/L1
(380 to 500 Vdc) U/T1
L2 S/L2 + V/T2
L3 T/L3
W/T3
-
YEG
Power
supply
Control OPE
board
board
Battery for control circuit (C) CN19
250 to 340 Vdc
(500 to 680 Vdc)
H1- = 55 S3 to S12
(Rescue Operation) SC
0.5 s
Magnetic Contactor A
Magnetic Contactor C
H1- = 55
(Rescue Operation)
Figure 4.24 Voltage Lower Than 190 to 250 Vdc for 200 V Class Drives, 380 to 500 Vdc for 400 V Class Drives
126 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Using a Battery for the DC Bus and 24 V Power Supply Unit Option for the Control Circuit
Follow the instructions when using a 24 V Power Supply Unit option for the control circuit and a battery for the main
circuit. The main circuit battery voltage must be higher than 48 Vdc for 200 V and 400 V class drives.
Yaskawa offers a 24 V Power Supply Option for the control circuit that is useful in applications unable to connect to a
backup battery greater than 250 V. Wiring instructions can be found in Figure 4.25 to Figure 4.27. For a more detailed
explanation of the 24 V Power Supply Option, refer to the manual provided with the option.
Wiring for CIMR-L20008 to 20180 and 40005 to 40112
Figure 4.20
L1000A
YEG B2
B1
Magnetic Contactor A
+1
S3 to S8
H1- = غغ55
(Rescue Operation) SC
5s 0.5 s
Magnetic Contactor A
Magnetic Contactor C
H1- = غغ55
(Rescue Operation)
Figure 4.25 Using a Battery for the DC Bus and 24 V Power Supply Unit Option for the Control Circuit
Start-Up Programming
Operation Sequence
Starting Rescued Operation
& Operation
1. Open contactor B and wait at least 5 seconds.
2. Set the input terminal programmed for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Close contactors A and C.
4. Set the Up/Down command.
4
Ending Rescue Operation
1. After the car has stopped, open contactors A and C.
2. Clear the input terminal set for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Wait at least 0.5 s and then close contactor B to return to operation with normal power supply.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 127
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Inrush current
suppression circuit <1>
Inrush current suppression resistor L1000A
(A)
+3
(D)
+1
DC bus Current
Relay
Battery for DC bus power supply (B) sensor
48 to 190 Vdc L1 R/L1
(48 to 380 Vdc) U/T1
L2 S/L2 + V/T2
L3 T/L3
W/T3
-
Power
YEG Magnetic Contactor C
supply
board
Control OPE
CN19 board
Battery for 24 V
control circuit Power
Supply
24 Vdc
Unit
H1- = 55 S3 to S12
(Rescue Operation) SC
Magnetic Contactor B
Magnetic Contactor A
Magnetic Contactor C
Magnetic Contactor D
H1- = 55
(Rescue Operation)
Figure 4.26 Using a Battery for the DC Bus and 24 V Power Supply Unit Option for the Control Circuit
(CIMR-L20215 to 20415 and 40150 to 40216)
<1> Install the inrush current suppression circuit outside the drive if the DC bus battery voltage is lower than 190 Vdc for 200 V class drives
and 380 Vdc for 400 V class drives. Failure to comply will cause the soft-charge bypass relay to remain open and result in damage to the
drive.
Refer to Table 4.14 for the installation of the inrush current suppression circuit for battery.
128 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
• Voltage Lower Than 190 to 250 Vdc for 200 V Class Drives, 380 to 500 Vdc for 400 V Class Drives
Figure 4.22
L1000A
+3
(A)
+1
DC bus Relay Current
DC bus power supply power supply (B) sensor
190 to 250 Vdc L1 R/L1
(380 to 500 Vdc) U/T1
L2 S/L2 + V/T2
L3 T/L3
W/T3
-
YEG
Power
supply
Magnetic Contactor C Control OPE
CN19 board
board
Battery for 24 V
control circuit Power
Supply
24 Vdc
Unit
H1- = 55 S3 to S12
(Rescue Operation) SC
0.5 s
Magnetic Contactor A
Magnetic Contactor C
H1- = 55
(Rescue Operation)
Figure 4.27 Voltage Lower Than 190 to 250 Vdc for 200 V Class Drives, 380 to 500 Vdc for 400 V Class Drives
Start-Up Programming
& Operation
4
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 129
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
L1000A
YEG
B2
B1
Magnetic Contactor A
Magnetic Contactor B -
Power supply Control
CN19 circuit
1
H1- = غغ55 S3 to S8
(Rescue Operation) SC
Magnetic Contactor A
H1- = غغ55
(Rescue Operation)
Figure 4.28 Using a Backup Battery With Minimum 250 Vdc (500 Vdc)
Operation Sequence
Starting Rescue Operation
1. Open contactor B.
2. Set the input terminal programmed for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Close contactor A.
4. Set the Up/Down command.
Ending Rescue Operation
1. After the car has stopped, open contactor A.
2. Clear the input terminal set for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Close contactor B to return to operation with normal power supply.
130 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
DANGER! Switch off the power supply before wiring and connecting the battery cable. Failure to comply will lead to death or serious
injury from electric shock.
NOTICE: A straight-edge screwdriver should be inserted into the opening provided on the connector cover at the proper angle.
Attempting to insert the screwdriver blade at a different angle could damage the drive.
Figure 4.24
Port CN19
Start-Up Programming
& Operation
4
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 131
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
3. Use a pair of diagonal cutters to cut an opening in the connector cover that allows the cable to pass through. The
cable should pass through the connector cover with the cover fastened to the drive.
Figure 4.26
Connect
to battery.
132 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Screw
Connector
cover
Phillips screwdriver
Start-Up Programming
& Operation
4
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 133
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
NOTICE: Be sure that the connector fastens at the correct angle to the CN19 connector port. The incorrect angle could damage the
battery, cable, or connector.
Figure 4.32
Port CN19
Battery cable
Downward Leftward
134 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
7. Use a Phillips screwdriver to fasten the screw that holds the CN19 connector cover in place.
NOTICE: Use the screw provided to fasten the connector cover into place. Using a different screw may damage the internal drive
components.
Figure 4.35
Connect
to battery
Start-Up Programming
& Operation
4
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 135
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Up command (internal) Up Up
Up command (internal) Up
136 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.7 Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions
Symptom Page
Cannot Change Parameter Settings 137
Motor Does Not Rotate Properly after Pressing RUN Button or after Entering Exter- Motor Does Not Rotate 137
nal Up/Down Command Motor Rotates in the Opposite Direction from the Up/Down Command 138
Motor Gets Too Hot 138
Drive Does Not Allow Selection of Rotational Auto-Tuning 138
Encoder Offset (E5-11) Set During Auto-Tuning (Rotational or Stationary) Consistently Differs by 30 Degrees or More 138
Noise From Drive or Output Lines When the Drive is Powered On 138
Residual Current Device (RCD, RCM) 138
The Safety Controller Does Not Recognize Safe Disable Monitor Output Signals (Terminals DM+ and DM-) 139
Riding comfort related problems 139
Motor Does Not Rotate Properly after Pressing RUN Button or after Entering
External Up/Down Command
Motor Does Not Rotate
Cause Possible Solutions
Start-Up Programming
• Check if the DRV on the digital operator is displayed.
The drive is not in the Drive Mode.
• Enter the Drive Mode. Refer to The Drive and Programming Modes on page 86.
Stop the drive and check if the correct frequency reference source is selected. If the digital operator is the source, the
LO/RE button LED must be on. If the source is REMOTE, it must be off.
& Operation
Take the following steps to solve the problem:
The button is enabled (o2-01=1) and was pushed.
• Push the button.
• o2-01 is set to 0 by default, i.e. the LO/RE button is disabled.
• When Auto-Tuning completes, the drive is switched back to the Programming Mode. The Up/Down command will
Auto-Tuning has just completed. not be accepted unless the drive is in the Drive Mode.
• Use the digital operator to enter the Drive Mode. Refer to The Drive and Programming Modes on page 86. 4
An Emergency Stop was executed and is not reset. Reset the Emergency Stop command.
Check parameter b1-02 (Up/Down Command Selection).
Set b1-02 so that it corresponds with the correct Up/Down command source.
Settings are incorrect for the source that provides the Up/Down 0: Digital operator
command. 1: Control circuit terminal (default setting)
2: MEMOBUS/Modbus communications
3: Option card
• Check the wiring for the control terminal.
There is faulty wiring in the control circuit terminals. • Correct wiring mistakes.
• Check the input terminal status monitor (U1-10).
Check parameter b1-01 (Speed Reference Selection).
Set b1-01 to the correct source of the speed reference.
0: Digital operator
The speed reference source setting is incorrect.
1: Control circuit terminal (default setting)
2: MEMOBUS/Modbus communications
3: Option card
The settings for the analog speed reference are incorrect. Check the settings (signal level, function, bias, gain) for the analog input that supplies the speed reference.
Selection for the sink/source mode and the internal/external power
Check the position of the jumper and setting for S3. Refer to Control I/O Configuration on page 73.
supply is incorrect.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 137
4.7 Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions
• When the STOP button is pressed, the drive will decelerate to stop.
The STOP button is enabled (o2-02=1) and was pressed
• Switch off the Up/Down command and then re-enter a new Up/Down command.
when the drive was started from a REMOTE source. • o2-02 is set to 0 by default, i.e. the Stop button is disabled.
Electrical Noise From Drive or Output Lines When the Drive is Operating
Cause Possible Solutions
• Lower the carrier frequency (C6-03).
• Install a noise filter on the input side of drive input power. Refer to Input-Side Noise Filter on page 331.
• Install a noise filter on the output side of the drive. Refer to Output-Side Noise Filter on page 332.
PWM switching in the drive generates excessive noise. • Place the wiring inside a metal conduit to shield it from switching noise.
• Ground the drive and motor properly.
• Separate the main circuit wiring and the control lines.
• Make sure wires and the motor have been properly grounded.
138 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.7 Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions
The Safety Controller Does Not Recognize Safe Disable Monitor Output Signals
(Terminals DM+ and DM-)
Cause Possible Solutions
• Check the wiring and logic for the Safe Disable monitor output terminal.
There is faulty wiring in the Safe Disable monitor output terminals.
• Correct wiring mistakes.
Start-Up Programming
Rollback occurs before the brake applies at stop.
CLV/PM • Increase the Position Lock Gain at Stop S3-03 gradually until no rollback
occurs. If vibration occurs reduce the gain S3-03.
• Increase the Torque Compensation Delay Time (C4-02).
OLV Too fast torque or slip compensation.
• Increase the Slip Compensation Delay Time (C3-02).
& Operation
• Adjust the Speed Control Loop Gain C5-01 and Integral Time C5-02.
Speed control loop setting is too soft or too hard. • Adjust Inertia Compensation parameters (n5-) if speed control loop
settings cannot solve the problem
Jerk occurs due to overshoot
CLV • For induction motors readjust the motor data (E2-), especially the slip
when the motor reaches top
CLV/PM Incorrect motor data. (E2-02) and no-load current values (E2-03), or perform Auto-Tuning again.
speed.
• For PM motors readjust the motor data in E5- or perform Auto-Tuning. 4
If the Inertia Compensation Function is used (n5-01=1) make sure the values
Inertia compensation function is not set up correctly.
in n5-02 and n5-03 are correct.
The acceleration rate changes too quickly when reaching the Decrease the Jerk at the End of Acceleration. Decrease C2-02 if set in m/s2,
All
selected speed. increase C2-02 if set in s.
Increase the Minimum and Middle Voltage Levels for the V/f pattern voltage
V/f and OLV Not enough torque at low speed. (E1-10 and E1-08 respectively). Make sure that the Starting and Leveling
Current does not rise too high.
OLV and Motor data incorrect. Adjust the motor data (E2-), especially the motor slip (E2-02) and no-
CLV Too much slip compensation. load current values (E2-03), or perform Auto-Tuning.
Motor stops shortly (under- Increase the Speed Control Gain and reduce the Speed Control Integral Time
shoot) when the leveling used for Low Speed at Stop. The parameters to be changed depend on the set-
speed is reached. Speed control loop responds too slow.
CLV ting of C5-05 and whether a third set of speed loop settings is used. Refer to
CLV/PM Speed Loop Adjustments (CLV and CLV/PM) on page 120.
If the Inertia Compensation Function is used (n5-01 = 1) make sure the values
The inertia compensation function is not set up correctly.
in n5-02 and n5-03 are correct.
The deceleration rate changes too quickly when reaching Decrease the Jerk at the End of Deceleration. Decrease C2-04 if set in m/s2,
All
leveling speed. increase C2-04 if set in s.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 139
4.7 Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions
140 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.8 Verifying Parameter Settings and Backing Up Changes
Start-Up Programming
Parameters selected by the user are saved as User Parameters, including recently viewed parameters and parameters
specifically selected for quick access.
A2-01
User Parameters If parameter A2-33 is set to 1, recently viewed parameters will be listed between A2-17 and A2-32. Parameters A2-01 A1-00 to
to –
1 to 32 through A2-16 must be manually selected by the user. S6-16
& Operation
A2-32
If A2-33 is set to 0, recently viewed parameters will not be saved to the group of User Parameters. A2- parameters
are now available for manual programming.
0: Parameters A2-01 through A2-32 are reserved for the user to create a list of User Parameters.
User Parameter
1: Save history of recently viewed parameters. Recently edited parameters will be saved to A2-17 through A2-32 for
A2-33 Automatic Selec- 0, 1 1
quick access. The most recently changed parameter is saved to A2-17. The second most recently changed parameter is
tion
saved to A2-18.
4
Password Settings: A1-04, A1-05
The user can set a password in parameter A1-05 to restrict access to the drive. The password must be entered to A1-04 to
unlock parameter access (i.e., parameter setting A1-04 must match the value programmed into A1-05). The following
parameters cannot be viewed or edited until the value entered to A1-04 correctly matches the value set to A1-05: A1-01,
A1-02, A1-03 and A2-01 through A2-33.
Note: Parameter A1-05 is hidden from view. To display A1-05, access parameter A1-04 and press and simultaneously.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 141
4.8 Verifying Parameter Settings and Backing Up Changes
Copy Function
Parameter settings can be copied to another drive to simplify parameter restoration or multiple drive setup. The drive
supports the following copy options:
• LCD Operator (standard in all models)
The LCD operator used to operate the drive supports copying, importing, and verifying parameter settings. Refer to o3:
Copy Function on page 230 for details.
• USB Copy Unit and CopyUnitManager
The Copy Unit is an external option connected to the drive to copy parameter settings from one drive and save those
settings to another drive. Refer to the manual supplied with the USB Copy Unit for instructions.
CopyUnitManager is a PC software tool that allows the user to transfer parameter settings between the Copy Unit and
a PC. This tool is especially useful when managing parameters for various drives or applications. Refer to the manual
supplied with CopyUnitManager for instructions.
• DriveWizard Plus
DriveWizard is a PC software tool for parameter management, monitoring, and diagnosis. DriveWizard can load, store,
and copy drive parameter settings. For details, refer to Help in the DriveWizard software.
Note: To obtain the driver and software of USB Copy Unit, Copy Unit Manager and DriveWizardPlus, access these sites:
China: http://www.yaskawa.com cn
Europe: http://www.yaskawa.eu.com
Japan: http://www.e-mechatronics.com
U.S.A.: http://www.yaskawa.com
Other areas: contact a Yaskawa representative.
142 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5
Parameter Details
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 143
5.1 A: Initialization
5.1 A: Initialization
The initialization group contains parameters associated with initial setup of the drive. Parameters involving the display
language, access levels, initialization, and password are located in this group.
A1: Initialization
A1-00: Language Selection
Selects the display language for the digital operator.
Note: This parameter is not reset when the drive is initialized using parameter A1-03.
Setting 0: English
Setting 1: Japanese
Setting 2: German
Setting 3: French
Setting 4: Italian
Setting 5: Spanish
Setting 6: Portuguese
Setting 7: Chinese
Setting 8: Czech
Setting 9: Russian
Setting 10: Turkish
Setting 11: Polish
Setting 12: Greek
144 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.1 A: Initialization
Note: This parameter is not reset when the drive is initialized using parameter A1-03.
Setting 0: V/f Control for Induction Motors
Use this mode for simple speed control and for multiple motor applications with low demands to dynamic response or
speed accuracy. This control mode is also used when the motor parameters are unknown and Auto-Tuning cannot be
performed. The speed control range is 1:40.
Setting 2: Open Loop Vector Control
Use this mode for general, variable-speed applications with a speed control range of 1:200 that require precise speed
control, quick torque response, and high torque at low speed without using a speed feedback signal from the motor.
Setting 3: Closed Loop Vector Control
Use this mode for general, variable-speed applications that require precise speed control down to zero speed, quick
torque response or precise torque control, and a speed feedback signal from the motor. The speed control range is up to
1:1500.
Setting 7: Closed Loop Vector Control for PM Motors
Use this mode for high-precision control of a PM motor in constant torque or variable torque applications. The speed
control range reaches 1:1500. A speed feedback signal is required.
A1-03: Initialize Parameters
Resets parameters back to the original default values. After initialization, the setting for A1-03 automatically returns to 0.
Setting 0: No initialization
Setting 1110: User Initialize
Drive parameters are reset to values selected by the user as User Settings. User Settings are stored when parameter o2-03
is set to “1: Set defaults”.
Note: User Initialization resets all parameters to a user-defined set of default values previously saved to the drive. Set parameter o2-03
Parameter Details
to 2 to clear the user-defined default values.
Setting 2220: 2-Wire Initialization
Resets all parameters back to their original default settings with digital inputs S1 and S2 configured as Forward run and
Reverse run, respectively.
Setting 5550: oPE04 Reset
An oPE04 error appears on the digital operator when a terminal block with settings saved to its built-in memory is
5
installed in a drive that has edited parameters. Set A1-02 to 5550 to use the parameter settings saved to the terminal block
memory.
Notes on Parameter Initialization
The parameters shown in Table 5.1 will not be reset when the drive is initialized by setting A1-03 = 2220 or 3330.
Although the control mode in A1-02 is not reset when A1-03 is set to 2220 or 3330, it may change when an application
preset is selected.
Table 5.1 Parameters not Changed by Drive Initialization
No. Parameter Name
A1-00 Language Selection
A1-02 Control Method Selection
E1-03 V/f Pattern Selection
E5-02 Motor Rated Capacity (for PM)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 145
5.1 A: Initialization
- MODE - PRG
Programming
2.
Press or until the Parameter Setting Mode screen appears.
HELP FWD DATA
-PRMSET- PRG
Initialization
3. A1-00=0
Press to enter the parameter menu tree. Select Language
← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Language
4. Select the flashing digits by pressing F1 , F2 or . A1-00=0 ∗0∗
left right English
← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG
Enter Password
5. Select A1-04 by pressing .
A1- 04 = 0
(0~9999)
“0”
← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Password
Press while holding down at the same time. A1-05 will appear. A1- 05 = 04
6. (0~9999)
“0”
Note: Because A1-05 is hidden, it will not be displayed by simply pressing .
←“05” flashes→
FWD
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Password
7. Press .
A1- 05 = 0000
(0~9999)
“0”
← FWD
→
146 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.1 A: Initialization
Step Display/Result
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Password
8. Use F1 , F2 , , and to enter the password. A1-05= 1234
(0~9999)
left right “0”
← FWD
→
9.
Press to save what was entered. Entry Accepted
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Password
10. The display automatically returns to the display shown in step 5. A1- 05 = 1234
(0~9999)
“0”
← FWD
→
Table 5.3 Check to see if A1-02 is locked (continuing from step 10 above)
Step Display/Result
-PRMSET- PRG
Control Method
A1-02= 2 ∗2∗
1.
Press to display A1-02. Open Loop Vector
← FWD
→
“02” flashes
2. – –
Press to make sure that the setting values cannot be selected.
- MODE - PRG
Programming
3. Press to return to the first display.
HELP FWD DATA
Table 5.4 Enter the Password to Unlock Parameters (continuing from step 3 above)
Step Display/Result
-PRMSET- PRG
Initialization
1. A1-00=0
Press to enter the parameter setup display. Select Language
← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Language
A1-00=0 ∗0∗
2. Press F1 , F2 or to select the flashing digits as shown. English
left right
←“00”FWD →
flashes
Parameter Details
-PRMSET- PRG
Enter Password
3. A1- 04 = 0
Press to scroll to A1-04 and . (0~9999)
“0”
← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG
5.
Press to save the new password. Entry Accepted
-PRMSET- PRG
Enter Password
6. Drive returns to the parameter display. A1- 04 = 0
(0~9999)
“0”
← FWD
→
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 147
5.1 A: Initialization
Step Display/Result
-PRMSET- PRG
Control Method
7. A1-02= 2 ∗2∗
Press and scroll to A1-02. Open Loop Vector
← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG
Control Method
8. A1-02= 2 ∗2∗
Press to display the value set to A1-02. If the first “2” blinks, parameter settings are unlocked. Open Loop Vector
← FWD
→
-PRMSET- PRG
Control Method
A1-02= 0 ∗2∗
9. V/F Control
Use or to change the value if desired (though changing the control mode at this point is not typically done). “2”
← FWD
V/f
→
10.
Press to save the setting, or press to return to the previous display without saving changes. Entry Accepted
-PRMSET- PRG
Control Method
11. The display automatically returns to the parameter display. A1-02= 0 ∗0∗
V/F Control
← FWD
→
Note: Parameter settings can be edited after entering the correct password. Performing a 2-wire initialization resets the password to
“0000”. Reenter the password to parameter A1-05 after drive initialization.
148 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.2 b: Application
5.2 b: Application
b1: Operation Mode Selection
b1-01: Speed Reference Selection
Selects the frequency reference source for the REMOTE mode.
NOTICE: Always turn off the RUN command before changing the setting of parameters d1-18 (Speed Reference Selection Mode), b1-
01 (Speed Reference Selection), or H1- (Multi-Function Digital Inputs). If the RUN command is on when changing any of these
settings, the motor may unexpectedly start running, and could result in injury.
Note: 1. If an Up/Down command is input to the drive but the speed reference entered is 0 or below the minimum frequency, the RUN
indicator LED on the digital operator will light.
2. Press the LO/RE key to set the drive to LOCAL and use the digital operator keypad to enter the speed reference.
Parameter Details
0 to 10 Vdc H3-01 = 0 H3-02 = 0
A1 H3-03 H3-04 –
-10 to +10 Vdc H3-01 = 1 (speed reference bias)
0 to 10 Vdc H3-09 = 0 H3-10 = 0
A2 H3-11 H3-12 –
-10 to +10 Vdc H3-09 = 1 (speed reference bias)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 149
5.2 b: Application
Setting 0: Operator
Allows the user to enter Up/Down commands from the digital operator. Use this setting when performing a test run only.
Setting 1: Control Circuit Terminal
Up/Down commands are issued from the control circuit terminals. This is the standard setting used in most elevator
applications.
Setting 2: MEMOBUS/Modbus Communications
This setting requires entering the Up/Down commands via serial communications by connecting the RS-485/422 serial
communication cable to control terminals R+, R-, S+, and S- on the removable terminal block. Refer to MEMOBUS/
Modbus Configuration on page 392 for instructions.
Setting 3: Option Card
This setting requires entering the Up/Down commands via the communication option card by plugging a communication
option card into the CN5-A port on the control board. Refer to the option card manual for instructions on integrating the
drive into the communication system.
Note: If b1-02 is set to 3, but an option card is not installed in CN5-A, an oPE05 operator programming error will be displayed on the
digital operator and the drive will not run.
<1> Setting 4 is available in the control mode CLV or CLV/PM for drives with software versions PRG: 7017 or later. The setting is 0 or 1 for
software version PRG: 7016.
150 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.2 b: Application
Setting 0: Disabled
An Up/Down command is not accepted while the digital operator is in the Programming Mode.
Setting 1: Enabled
An Up/Down command is accepted in any digital operator mode.
Setting 2: Prohibit programming during run
It is not possible to enter the Programming Mode as long as the drive output is active. The Programming Mode cannot be
displayed during Run.
b1-14: Phase Order Selection
Sets the phase order for drive output terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3. Switching motor phases will reverse the direction
of the motor. Use this parameter to switch the direction of the Up and Down commands.
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
b1-14 Phase Order Selection 0 or 1 0
Parameter Details
for the development of more flux to facilitate starting machines that require high starting torque or motors with a large
rotor time constant.
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
b2-08 Magnetic Flux Compensation Value 0 to 1000% 0%
When an Up/Down command is issued, the DC current level injected into the motor changes linearly from the level set to
b2-08 to the level set to E2-03 within the time set to b2-03.
5
Figure 5.1
Output Speed
b2-08 common_TMonly
E2-03
Magnetizing Current
Reference Time
S1-04
Figure 5.1 Magnetic Flux Compensation
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 151
5.2 b: Application
The level of the DC current injected to the motor is limited to 80% of the drive rated current or to the motor rated current,
whichever value is smaller.
Note: 1. If b2-08 is set below 100%, it can take a relatively long time for flux to develop.
2. If b2-08 is set to 0%, the DC current level will be the DC Injection current set to S1-02.
3. As DC Injection can generate a fair amount of noise, b2-08 may need to be adjusted to keep noise levels acceptable.
OFF ON OFF
Up/Down Command
common_TMonly
b6-01 b6-03
Output Speed
b6-02 b6-04
152 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.2 b: Application
Speed
Speed reference
Torque
0 100%
Figure 5.4 Droop Control Gain
Parameter Details
b7-02 Droop Control Delay Time 0.03 to 2.00 s 0.05 s
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 153
5.2 b: Application
154 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.3 C: Tuning
5.3 C: Tuning
C parameters set the characteristics for acceleration, deceleration, and Jerk. Other parameters in the C group cover
settings for slip compensation, torque compensation, and carrier frequency.
<1> The setting range and default value depend on the display units set in parameter o1-03. If o1-03 is set between 0 and 4, the time required to go
from 0% speed to 100% maximum speed is expressed in seconds. If o1-03 is set to 5 or 6, then setting units will appear in m/s2 or ft/s2. If the
drive is in V/f control mode the accel/decel ramps can be set in seconds only.
Figure 5.5 shows an operation example for changing accel/decel ramps. The example below requires that the stopping
method be set for “Ramp to stop” (b1-03 = 0).
Parameter Details
Figure 5.5
ON OFF ON ON OFF ON
Up/Down
command
ON OFF ON
Accel/Decel Ramp Selection 1
(Terminals S3 to S8, H1- = “7”)
ON
Accel/Decel Ramp Selection 2
(Terminals S3 to S8, H1- = “1A”)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 155
5.3 C: Tuning
Output Speed
common_TMonly
C1-11
Accel/Decel
Switching Speed
<1> The setting range and default value depend on the display units set in parameter o1-03. If o1-03 is set between 0 and 4, the time required to go
from 0% speed to 100% maximum speed is expressed in seconds. If o1-03 is set to 5 or 6, then setting units will appear in m/s2 or ft/s2. If the
drive is in V/f control mode, the Emergency stop ramp can be set in seconds only.
NOTICE: Rapid deceleration can trigger an overvoltage fault. The drive output shuts off when faulted and the motor coasts. Set an
appropriate Emergency Stop time to C1-09 to avoid this uncontrolled motor state and to ensure that the motor stops quickly and safely.
156 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.3 C: Tuning
<1> The setting range and default value depend on the display units set in parameter o1-03. If o1-03 is set between 0 and 4, the time required to go
from 0% speed to 100% maximum speed is expressed in seconds. If o1-03 is set to 5 or 6, then setting units will appear in m/s2 or ft/s2. If the
drive is in V/f control mode, the inspection deceleration ramp can be set in seconds only.
Parameter Details
<1> The setting range and default value depend on the display units set in parameter o1-03. If o1-03 is set between 0 and 4, the time required to go
from 0% speed to 100% maximum speed is expressed in seconds. If o1-03 is set to 5 or 6, then setting units will appear in m/s2 or ft/s2.
Figure 5.7
C2-01
Time
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 157
5.3 C: Tuning
The slip compensation limit is constant throughout the constant torque range (speed reference E1-06). In the constant
power range (speed reference E1-06), it is increased based on C3-03 and the output speed as shown in Figure 5.8.
Figure 5.8
E1-04
E1-06 × C3-03
C3-03
common_TMonly
Output speed
E1-06 E1-04
Base Maximum
Frequency Frequency
Figure 5.8 Slip Compensation Limit
Setting 0: Disabled
Slip compensation is not provided. The actual motor speed might be higher than the speed reference.
Setting 1: Enabled (6 Hz and above)
Slip compensation is enabled during regenerative operation. It will not be active at output frequencies below 6 Hz.
158 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.3 C: Tuning
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
C3-21: Motor 2 Slip Compensation Gain
Used to improve speed accuracy for motor 2. Functions in the same way that C3-01 functions for motor 1.
Adjust this parameter only after the motor rated current (E4-01), motor rated slip (E4-02), and the motor no-load current
(E4-03) have all been set.
Refer to C3-01: Slip Compensation Gain on page 158 for details on adjusting this parameter.
Note: Default setting is 0.0 in V/f Control (A1-02 = 0). Default setting is 1.0 in Open Loop Vector Control (A1-02 = 2) and Closed
Loop Vector Control (A1-02 = 3). In Closed Loop Vector Control, slip compensation gain acts as an adaptable gain.
Note: The default for V/f Control (A1-02 = 0) is 2000 ms. The default for Open Loop Vector Control (A1-02 = 2) is 200 ms.
Parameter Details
C3-23: Motor 2 Slip Compensation Limit
Sets the upper limit for the slip compensation function as a percentage of the motor rated slip (E4-02).
E3-04
E3-06 × C3-23
common_TMonly
C3-23
Output Frequency
E3-06 E3-04
Base Maximum
Frequency Frequency
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 159
5.3 C: Tuning
Adjustment
Although C4-02 rarely needs to be changed, adjustments may be necessary in the following situations:
• Increase this setting if the motor vibrates.
• Decrease this setting if the motor responds too slowly to changes in the load.
C4-03: Torque Compensation at Forward Start
Sets the amount of torque at start in the forward direction to improve motor performance during start with a heavy load.
Compensation is applied using the time constant set in parameter C4-05. Enable this function when the load pulls the
motor in reverse when starting with a Forward Up/Down command. Setting of 0.0% disables this feature.
160 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.3 C: Tuning
Torque limits
C5-01, C5-03, C5-13, C5-19
+ + Torque reference
Primary
Speed reference P filter
–
I +
common_TMonly
I limit
C5-06
L7-01 to L7-04
Detected speed C5-02, C5-04, C5-08
C5-14, C5-20
Figure 5.10 Speed Control Block Diagram
Parameter Details
switching speed is defined (C5-07 = 0) the drive will use one set of speed loop parameters only (C5-01/02).
However, in order to achieve adequate performance in all sections of a trip, for the most installations it will be necessary
to use two or all three sets of speed loop settings.
Additional Speed loop settings are provided for Position Lock. Those can be used to prevent rollback especially in
gearless applications. 5
Also refer to C5-01, C5-03, C5-13 / C5-02, C5-04, C5-14: Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain 1, 2, 3 / Speed
Control Loop Integral Time 1, 2, 3 on page 162.
Perform the following steps for adjusting Speed Control Loop parameters:
1. Check parameter C5-07 and set a speed loop setting switching point. For CLV/PM the drive is preset to 2%. For
CLV set C5-07 between 8~10%.
2. Start a trip and check for any problems like rollback, vibration, overshoot, etc.
3. Adjust C5-19/20 in order to solve rollback problems During Position Lock right before the motor starts
accelerating. Increase C5-19, then shorten C5-20 if the motor rolls back right after the brake releases. Set them
in the opposite way if vibration occurs. If the rollback cannot be eliminated by setting C5-19/10, refer to
parameters S3-01/02 (Position Lock Gains at Start).
4. Adjust C5-03/04 in order to improve the performance at start after Position Lock has been finished. Increase C5-
03, then shorten C5-04 if the speed response is slow. Set them in the opposite way if vibration occurs.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 161
5.3 C: Tuning
5. Adjust C5-01/02 in order to solve problems that occur at speeds higher than C5-07. Increase C5-01, then
shorten C5-02 if overshoot when reaching the top speed occurs. Set them in the opposite way if vibration
occurs.
6. Adjust C5-13/14 in order to improve the stopping behavior. Increase C5-13, then shorten C5-14 if the landing
accuracy is poor. Adjust them in the opposite way if vibrations occur. If problems cannot be resolved by setting
C5-13/14, refer to parameter S3-03 Position Lock Gain at Stop). Note that C5-13/14 settings will not be effective
if the speed reference is set from an analog input.
7. Repeat steps 2 to 6 until the desired riding comfort has been reached. Also refer to Riding Comfort Related
Problems on page 139.
C5-01, C5-03, C5-13 / C5-02, C5-04, C5-14: Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain 1, 2, 3 /
Speed Control Loop Integral Time 1, 2, 3
These parameters adjust the responsiveness of the Speed Control Loop.
P = C5-01
common_
P,I
I = C5-02 TMonly
P = C5-03
I = C5-04
Speed
0 C5-07
162 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.3 C: Tuning
Figure 5.12
common_
P,I
P = C5-01
TMonly
I = C5-02
P = C5-13
I = C5-14
Speed
0 C5-07
Figure 5.12 Settings at Low and High Speed during Deceleration (Leveling Speed is Selected)
C5-19, C5-20: Speed Control Loop P Gain Time, I Time during Position Lock
These parameters adjust the responsiveness of Speed Control Loop during Position Lock. Increase C5-19 and shorten
C5-20 if the motor rolls back immediately after the brake releases. Decrease C5-19 and lengthen C5-20 if vibrations
occur.
Parameter Details
C5-19 Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain Time during Position Lock 0.00 to 300.00 Determined by A1-02
C5-20 Speed Control Loop Integral Time during Position Lock 0.000 to 10.000 s 0.100 s
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 163
5.3 C: Tuning
Setting 0: 5 kHz
Setting 1: Same value set to C6-03
C6-21: Inspection Operation Carrier Frequency
Sets the carrier frequency during Inspection Run.
Setting 0: 2 kHz
Setting 1: Use the value set to C6-03
C6-31: Carrier Frequency during Rescue Operation
Note: Available in drive software PRG: 7016 or later.
164 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.4 d: Reference Settings
<1> Setting units and the default setting are determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection (o1-
03) on page 389 for details.
Parameter Details
d1-18 is set to “1”, parameter d1-01 to d1-08 are not displayed. Refer to Separate Speed Inputs (d1-18 = 1 or 2) on
page 112 for details.
Setting 2: Leveling speed reference has priority
Six different speeds (d1-19 to d1-23, d1-26) can be programmed to the drive and can be selected using dedicated digital
inputs. The leveling speed reference in d1-26, however, takes priority over all other speed references when enabled via 5
one of the multi-function input terminals (H1-= 53). When d1-18 is set to “2”, parameters d1-01 to d1-08 are not
displayed. Refer to Separate Speed Inputs (d1-18 = 1 or 2) on page 112 for details.
Setting 3: Use multi-speed references d1-02 to d1-08, no speed selection stops the drive
Up to seven separate preset speed references can be programmed to the drive using parameters d1-02 through d1-08 can
be selected using binary coded digital inputs. When d1-18 is set to “3”, parameters d1-19 through d1-23 are not
displayed. Refer to Multi-Speed Inputs 1, 2 (d1-18 = 0 or 3) on page 111 for details.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 165
5.4 d: Reference Settings
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 389 for details.
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 389 for details.
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 389 for details.
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 389 for details.
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 389 for details.
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 389 for details.
166 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.4 d: Reference Settings
<1> Enter the same values to the E3 and E4 parameters that are set for the E1 and E2 parameters.
Note: 1. The drive will control motor 1 when this parameter is set to 0.00.
2. Set the accel/decel times in parameters C1-12 and C1-13 when using motor 2.
3. When motor 2 is selected, the following monitors will display values in Hz: U1-01, U1-02, U1-05, U4-19, U4-20.
Parameter Details
d6: Field Forcing
Field Forcing
The Field Forcing function compensates the delaying influence of the motor time constant when changing the excitation
current reference. Field Forcing can improve the motor responsiveness. It is ineffective during DC Injection Braking.
d6-03: Field Forcing Selection 5
Enables or disables the Field Forcing function.
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
d6-06: Field Forcing Limit
Sets the maximum level at which the Field Forcing function can boost the excitation current reference. The value is set as
a percentage of the motor no load current. This parameter does not normally need to be changed.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 167
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
(Approximate Values)
Voltage Setting Value of
E1-01 Braking Transistor Uv Detection Level
ov Detection Level Operation Level <1> (L2-05)
200 V Class All settings 410 V 394 V 190 V
setting 400 V 820 V 788 V 380 V
400 V Class
setting < 400 V 820 V 788 V 350 V
<1> The braking transistor operation levels are valid for the internal braking transistor of the drive. When using an external CDBR braking chopper,
refer to the instruction manual of that unit.
Note: Parameter is not reset to the default value when the drive is initialized using A1-03.
168 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
common_TMonly
Frequency (Hz)
Figure 5.13 V/f Pattern
Note: 1. The following condition must be true when setting up the V/f pattern: E1-09 E1-07 E1-06 E1-11 E1-04
2. To make the V/f pattern a straight line below E1-06, set E1-09 = E1-07. In this case the E1-08 setting is disregarded.
3. E1-03 is unaffected when the parameters are initialized using parameter A1-03, but the settings for E1-04 through E1-13 are returned
to their default values.
4. Parameters E1-11, E1-12, and E1-13 should only be used to fine-tune the V/f pattern in the constant output range. These parameters
rarely need to be changed.
Parameter Details
E2-01 Motor Rated Current 10% to 200% of the drive rated current. Determined by o2-04
Note: 1. The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L20008 to 20033 and 40005 to
40018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L20047 to 20415 and 40024 to 40216 display values in 0.1 A
units.
2. Setting the motor rated current in E2-01 lower than the motor no-load current in E2-03 will trigger an oPE02 error. Set E2-03
correctly to prevent this error.
5
E2-02: Motor Rated Slip
Sets the motor rated slip in Hz to protect the motor and calculate torque limits. This value is automatically set during
Auto-Tuning (Rotational Auto-Tuning, Stationary Auto-Tuning 1 and 2).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 169
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
Note: The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L20008 to 20033 and 40005 to
40018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L20047 to 20415 and 40024 to 40216 display values in
0.1 A units.
170 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
Parameter Details
The default setting of the no-load current is for performance with a 4-pole Yaskawa motor.
Setting the Number of Motor Poles
Only required in V/f Control with PG and Closed Loop Vector Control. Enter the number of motor poles as indicated on
motor nameplate.
Setting the Line-to-Line Resistance
5
E2-05 is normally set during Auto-Tuning. If Auto-Tuning cannot be performed, contact the motor manufacturer to
determine the correct resistance between motor lines. The motor test report can also be used to calculate this value using
the formulas below:
• E-type insulation: Multiply 0.92 times the resistance value () listed on the test report at 75°C.
• B-type insulation: Multiply 0.92 times the resistance value () listed on the test report at 75°C.
• F-type insulation: Multiply 0.87 times the resistance value () listed on the test report at 115°C.
Setting the Motor Leakage Inductance
The motor leakage inductance set to E2-06 determines the amount of voltage drop relative to the motor rated voltage.
Enter this value for motors with a low degree of inductance, such as high-speed motors. This information is usually not
listed on the motor nameplate. Contact the motor manufacturer if the data cannot be found.
Setting the Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient 1, 2
E2-07 and E2-08 are set when Auto-Tuning is performed.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 171
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
E3-04 to E3-10
Parameters E3-04 through E3-10 set up the V/f pattern used for motor 2 as shown in Figure 5.14.
Note: Certain E3- parameters might not be visible depending on the control mode. Refer to Parameter Table on page 346 for
details.
Output (V)
E3-05
E3-08
E3-10 common_TMonly
E3-09 E3-07 E3-04
Frequency (Hz)
172 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
Note: 1. The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L20008 to 20033 and 40005 to
40018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L20047 to 20415 and 40024 to 40216 display values in 0.1 A
units.
2. An oPE02 error will occur if the motor rated current in E4-01 is set lower than the motor no-load current in E4-03. Set E4-03
correctly to prevent this error.
Parameter Details
Note: The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L20008 to 20033 and 40005 to
40018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L20047 to 20415 and 40024 to 40216 display values in
0.1 A units.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 173
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
Note: The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L20008 to 20033 and 40005 to
40018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L20047 to 20415 and 40024 to 40216 display values in
0.1 A units.
174 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
Note: 1. Set E5-24 to 0 when setting E5-09. However, setting both E5-09 and E5-24 to 0.0 will trigger oPE08. oPE08 will also be triggered if
neither E5-09 nor E5-24 are set to 0.0.
2. This parameter is not reset when the drive is initialized using parameter A1-03.
Note: 1. Set E5-09 to 0.0 when setting E5-24. However, setting both E5-09 and E5-24 to 0.0 will trigger oPE08. oPE08 will also be triggered
if neither E5-09 nor E5-24 are set to 0.0.
2. This parameter is not reset when the drive is initialized using parameter A1-03.
Parameter Details
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 175
5.6 F: Option Settings
F1-03, F1-08, F1-09: Overspeed (oS) Operation Selection, Detection Level, Delay Time
An oS fault is triggered when the speed feedback exceeds the value set in F1-08 for longer than the time set in F1-09. Set
the stopping method for an oS fault in parameter F1-03.
176 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.6 F: Option Settings
F1-04, F1-10, F1-11: Operation at Speed Deviation (dEv), Detection Level, Delay Time
A speed deviation error (dEv) is triggered when the difference between the speed reference and the speed feedback
exceeds the value set in F1-10 for longer than the time set in F1-11. The stopping method when a speed deviation fault
occurs can be selected in parameter F1-04.
Example: To have a ratio of 1/32 between the speed feedback option card pulse input and output, set F1-06 = 032.
F1-06 PG1 Pulse Monitor Output Division Ratio 001 to 032, 102 to 132 (1 to 1 ) 1
Parameter Details
32
Note: A common cause for a dv3 fault is the incorrect setting of E5-11. Make sure the correct encoder offset has been entered to E5-11.
Note: A common cause for a dv4 fault is the incorrect setting of E5-11. Make sure the correct encoder offset is set to E5-11.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 177
5.6 F: Option Settings
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
F1-29: dEv Detection Condition Selection
Selects when dEv error detection is active.
Setting 0: After speed reference, SFS output and motor speed have matched once.
Setting 1: After speed reference, SFS output have matched once.
Setting 2: Always during Run.
Figure 5.15
Speed
Motor speed
A :Setting 2
B :Setting 1
C :Setting 0
Time
A
178 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.6 F: Option Settings
Selects the speed for serial communication between a PG-F3 option card and serial encoder.
Setting 0: Disabled
The R track is not used. The rotor magnet position is calculated from the C and D track signal only.
Setting 1: Enabled
The R track signals are used to determine the rotor magnet position.
F1-66 to F1-81: Encoder Adjust 1 to 16
Note: Available in drive software PRG: 7017 or later.
Sets encoder offsets 1 to 16 for the PG-E3 option card. These parameters are automatically set by the execution of Auto-
Tuning of PG-E3 encoder characteristics.
Parameter Details
Determines the type of input for digital option card DI-A3 when o1-03 is set to 0 or 1.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 179
5.6 F: Option Settings
Setting 0: 8 bit
Setting 1: 12 bit
Setting 2: 16 bit
180 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.6 F: Option Settings
Setting 0: 0 to 10 V
Setting 1: -10 to 10 V
Parameter Details
F6: Communication Option Card
These parameters configure communication option cards and communication fault detection methods.
F6-01: Operation Selection after Communications Error
5
Determines drive operation when a communication error occurs.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 181
5.6 F: Option Settings
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
F6-08: Reset Communication Parameters
Determines whether F6- communication-related parameters are reset after initialization.
Setting 0: Do not reset parameters F6- when the drive is initialized with A1-03
Setting 1: Reset F6- when the drive is initialized with A1-03
Note: F6-08 is not reset when the drive is initialized.
CANopen Parameters
Parameters F6-35 and F6-36 set up the drive to operate on a CANopen network.
Refer to the Yaskawa AC Drive Option CANopen Installation Manual and Technical Manual for details on parameter
settings.
182 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Parameter Details
20 to 2F External Fault 185 – – –
<1> Available in drive software PRG: 7017 or later.
0 Multi-speed references take priority, and the leveling speed in d1-26 is used for the Jog frequency.
1 Jog frequency cannot be used.
2 Jog frequency cannot be used.
3 Multi-speed references take priority, and the leveling speed in d1-26 is used for the Jog frequency.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 183
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Drive Operation
DIgital Input Function
Input Open Input Closed
Setting 8 (N.O.) Baseblock (Interrupt output) Normal operation
Setting 9 (N.C.) Normal operation Baseblock (Interrupt output)
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. When using a mechanical holding brake with the drive in a lifting application, close the brake
when the drive output is cut off by a baseblock command triggered by one of the input terminals. Failure to comply will result in a
slipping load from the motor suddenly coasting when the baseblock command is entered and may cause serious injury or death.
Up/Down/Stop
ON ON
Emergency Stop
H1- = 17
ON ON
Decelerates at C1-09
YEG
Output Speed TIME
NOTICE: Rapid deceleration can trigger an overvoltage fault. When faulted, the drive output shuts off, and the motor coasts. To avoid
this uncontrolled motor state and to ensure that the motor stops quickly and safely, set an appropriate Emergency Stop time to C1-09.
184 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Drive M Motor 1
common_
M Motor 2
TMonly
Figure 5.17 Motor Selection
When switching between motor 1 and motor 2, the parameters used to control those motors also change. Below,
Table 5.11 lists the parameters that correspond to each motor.
Table 5.11 Parameters for Switching Between Two Motors
No. Setting 16 Open (Motor 1) Setting 16 Closed (Motor 2)
C1-: Acceleration/Deceleration Time C1-01 to C1-04 C1-12 to C1-13
E1-, E3-: V/f Pattern
E1-, E3- E3-, E4-
E2-, E4-: Motor Parameters
Note: 1. The drive can switch from motor 2 to operate motor 1 in V/f Control based on the speed reference set for motor 2. Refer to Motor
Switch Selection on page 167 for details.
2. It is not possible to switch between motor 1 and motor 2 during run. Doing so will trigger the “rUn” alarm.
3. It is not possible to switch between motors when CLV/PM control mode is selected.
4. The motor 2 selection function is available only with OLV control mode (A1-02 = 0).
5. When switching from motor 1 to motor 2, check to make sure that motor 2 is operating.
If a digital output is programmed for “Motor 2 selection” (H1-01, H1-02, or H1-03 = 1C), motor will be selected when
the output is closed.
Setting 18: Timer function input
This setting configures a digital input terminal as the input for the timer function. Use this setting combination with the
timer function output (H2- = 12). Refer to b4: Delay Timers on page 152 for details.
Setting 1A: Accel/decel ramp selection 2
Used to select accel/decel ramps 1 to 4 in combination with the Accel/decel ramp selection 1 command. Refer to C1-01
to C1-08: Accel, Decel Ramps 1 to 4 on page 155 for details.
Parameter Details
Setting 20 to 2F: External fault
The External fault command stops the drive when problems occur with external devices.
To use the External fault command, set one of the multi-function digital inputs to any value between 20 to 2F. The digital
operator will display EF where is the number of the terminal to which the external fault signal is assigned.
For example, if an external fault signal is input to terminal “EF3” will be displayed., 5
Select the value to be set in H1- from a combination of any of the following three conditions:
• Signal input level from peripheral devices (N.O., N.C.)
• External fault detection method
• Operation after external fault detection
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 185
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
The following table shows the relationship between the conditions and the value set to H1-.
Terminal statuses, detection conditions, and stopping methods marked with an “ O ” are applicable to the corresponding
settings.
186 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Parameter Details
H2-05 Terminals P2-C2 Function Selection (photocoupler) 0 to 161 F: Through Mode
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 187
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Status Description
Open Drive is stopped.
Closed An Up/Down command is input or the drive is during deceleration or during DC injection.
Status Description
Open The operating speed is greater than the minimum output frequency (E1-09) or the zero speed level at stop (S1-01).
Closed The operating speed is less than or equal to the minimum output frequency (E1-09) or the zero speed level at stop (S1-01).
Note: When using CLV or CLV/PM control modes, the output terminal will close when the motor speed becomes less than or equal to
the zero speed level set for S1-01. In all other control modes, the output terminal will close when the output frequency becomes
less than or equal to the minimum output frequency set for E1-09.
Figure 5.18
Output speed
or
motor speed E1-09 (Max. Output Frequency) or
S1-01 (Zero Speed Level)
common_
OFF
Zero Speed
ON
TMonly
Figure 5.18 Zero-Speed Time Chart
Setting 2: Speed agree 1 (fref /fout Agree 1)
Closes whenever the actual output speed (CLV, CLV/PM) is within the Speed Agree Width (L4-02) of the current speed
reference regardless of the direction.
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed does not match the speed reference while the drive is running.
Closed Output speed or motor speed is within the range of speed reference ±L4-02.
Speed
reference
L4-02
Output speed
or motor speed
L4-02
188 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed and the speed reference are not both within the range of L4-01 ±L4-02.
Closed Output speed or motor speed and the speed reference are both within the range of L4-01 ±L4-02.
Note: Detection works in both forward and reverse. The value of L4-01 is used as the detection level for both directions.
Figure 5.20
L4-01
Speed
reference +/- L4-02
User Set
OFF ON OFF ON
Speed Agree 1
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed exceeded L4-01 + L4-02.
Closed Output speed or motor speed is below L4-01 or has not exceeded L4-01 + L4-02.
Note: Detection works in both forward and reverse. The value of L4-01 is used as the detection level for both directions.
Figure 5.21
Output speed
or motor speed L4-02
L4-01
Parameter Details
L4-01
L4-02
common_
Speed
detection 1<1> ON OFF TMonly
Figure 5.21 Speed Detection 1 Time Chart
5
<1> This is the time chart when L4-07 (Speed Agree Detection Selection) is set to 1 (detection always enabled). The default setting for L4-07 is 0
(no detection during baseblock). When L4-07 = 0, the terminal opens during baseblock.
Refer to L4-01, L4-02: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width on page 207 for more details.
Setting 5: Speed Detection 2
Output closes whenever the output speed or motor speed (CLV, CLV/PM) is above the detection level set in L4-01. The
terminal remains closed until the output speed or motor speed falls below L4-01 minus the setting of L4-02.
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed is below L4-01 minus L4-02 or has not exceeded L4-01.
Closed Output speed or motor speed exceeded L4-01.
Note: Detection works in both forward and reverse. The value of L4-01 is used as the detection level for both directions.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 189
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Figure 5.22
L4-01
L4-02
common_
Speed
Detection 2<1>
OFF ON TMonly
Figure 5.22 Speed Detection 2 Time Chart
<1> This is the timing chart when L4-07 (Speed Agree Detection Selection) is set to 1 (detection always enabled). The default setting for L4-07 is 0
(no detection during baseblock). When L4-07 = 0, the terminal opens during baseblock.
Refer to L4-01, L4-02: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width on page 207 for more details.
Setting 6: Drive ready (READY)
Output closes whenever the drive is ready to operate the motor. The terminal will not close under the conditions listed
below, and any Up/Down commands will be disregarded.
• When the power is shut off
• During a fault
• When the internal power supply of the drive has malfunctioned
• When a parameter setting error makes it impossible to run
• Although stopped, an overvoltage or undervoltage situation occurs
• While editing a parameter in the Programming Mode (when b1-08 = 0)
• When parameter L8-88 = 0 and at least one Safe Disable input is open
Setting 7: DC bus undervoltage
Output closes whenever the DC bus voltage or control circuit power supply drops below the trip level set in L2-05. A
fault in the DC bus circuit will also cause the terminal to set for “DC bus undervoltage” to close.
Status Description
Open DC bus voltage is above the level set to L2-05.
Closed DC bus voltage has fallen below the trip level set to L2-05.
Status Description
Open Drive is not in a baseblock state.
Closed Baseblock is being executed.
Status Description
Open Speed reference is provided from External reference 1 (b1-01).
Closed Speed reference is being sourced from the digital operator.
Status Description
Open Up/Down command is provided from External reference 1 (b1-02).
Closed Up/Down command is being sourced from the digital operator.
190 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Setting E: Fault
The output closes when the drive faults (excluding CPF00 and CPF01 faults).
Setting F: Not used (Through mode)
Select this setting when using the terminal in a pass-through mode. When set to F, an output does not trigger any function
in the drive. Setting F, however, still allows the output status to be read by a PLC via a communication option or
MEMOBUS/Modbus communications.
Setting 10: Minor fault
Output closes when a minor fault condition is present.
Setting 11: Fault reset command active
Output closes whenever there is an attempt to reset a fault situation from the control circuit terminals, via serial
communications, or using a communications option card.
Setting 12: Timer output
This setting configures a digital output terminal as output for the timer function. Refer to b4: Delay Timers on page 152
for details.
Setting 13: Speed agree 2 (fref /fout agree 2)
Closes whenever the actual output speed or motor speed (CLV, CLV/PM) is within the speed agree width (L4-04) of the
current speed reference, regardless of the direction.
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed does not match the speed reference while the drive is running.
Closed Output speed or motor speed is within the range of speed reference ±L4-04.
Parameter Details
Note: Detection works in both forward and reverse.
Figure 5.23
Speed
reference common_
L4-04
Output speed
TMonly
or motor speed
5
L4-04
OFF ON
Speed Agree 2
Figure 5.23 Speed Agree 2 Time Chart
Refer to L4-03, L4-04: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width (+/-) on page 207 for more details.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 191
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed and speed reference are both outside the range of L4-03 ±L4-04.
Closed Output speed or motor speed and the speed reference are both with in the range of L4-03 ±L4-04.
Figure 5.24
Output speed
or motor speed
Speed L4-03
reference Output speed
+/- L4-04
Speed
reference
common_
User Set OFF ON TMonly
Speed Agree 2
Figure 5.24 User Set Speed Agree 2 Example with a Positive L3-04 Value
Refer to L4-03, L4-04: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width (+/-) on page 207 for more details.
Setting 15: Speed detection 3
Output opens when the output speed or motor speed (CLV, CLV/PM) rises above the detection level set in L4-03 plus the
detection with set in L4-04. The terminal remains open until the output speed or motor speed falls below the level set in
L4-03. As the detection level L4-03 is a signed value, the detection works in the specified direction only.
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed exceeded L4-03 plus L4-04.
Closed Output speed or motor speed is below L4-03 or has not exceeded L4-03 plus L4-04 yet.
Figure 5.25
Output speed
or motor speed L4-04 common_
L4-03 TMonly
Speed ON OFF
detection 3<1>
Figure 5.25 Speed Detection 3 Example with a Positive L3-04 Value
<1> This is the timing chart when L4-07 (Speed Agree Detection Selection) is set to 1 (detection always enabled). The default setting for L4-07 is 0
(no detection during baseblock). When L4-07 = 0, the terminal opens during baseblock.
Refer to L4-03, L4-04: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width (+/-) on page 207 for more details.
192 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed is below L4-03 minus L4-04 or has not exceeded L4-03 yet.
Closed Output speed or motor speed exceeded L4-03.
Figure 5.26
Speed OFF ON
detection 4<1>
<1> This is the timing chart when L4-07 (Speed Agree Detection Selection) is set to 1 (detection always enabled). The default setting for L4-07 is 0
(no detection during baseblock). When L4-07 = 0, the terminal opens during baseblock.
Refer to L4-03, L4-04: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width (+/-) on page 207 for more details.
Setting 1A: During down direction
A digital output set for “During down direction” will close whenever the drive is running the elevator in the down
direction.
Status Description
Open Elevator is being driven in the up direction or stopped.
Closed Elevator is being driven in the down direction.
Figure 5.27
Output Speed
Up command
Parameter Details
Down command
Status Description
Open Baseblock is being executed.
Closed Drive is not in a baseblock state.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 193
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Status Description
Open Motor 1 is selected.
Closed Motor 2 is selected.
Status Description
Open No frequency output from drive when stopped with baseblock, stopped with DC injection braking during initial excitation, or stopped with short circuit braking.
Closed Drive is outputting frequency.
Figure 5.28
OFF ON
Up/Down command
Baseblock OFF ON
command
Output
frequency
OFF ON
During run
194 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Parameter Details
This terminal changes states when the internal cooling fan fault is detected.
Setting 61: Motor pole search status
This terminal changes states when the Initial Motor Pole Position Search is finished. Refer to Initial Rotor Pole Position
Search Settings on page 222 for details on Motor Pole Position Search.
Use this setting in applications where the motor speed feedback is supplied from a non-absolute encoder (e.g., 5
incremental) and where the drive brake sequence is not utilized.
Design the external brake sequence to interlock the brake as long as the Motor Pole Position Search has not finished. In
this case, the external brake sequence should be designed to interlock the brake during Motor Pole Position Search.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 195
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Setting 0: 0 to 10 Vdc
The input level is 0 to 10 Vdc. The minimum input level is limited to 0%, so that a negative input signal due to gain and
bias settings will be read as 0%.
Setting 1: -10 to 10 Vdc
The input level is -10 to 10 Vdc. If the resulting voltage is negative after being adjusted by gain and bias settings, then the
motor will rotate in reverse.
H3-02: Terminal A1 Function Selection
Selects the input signal level for analog input A1. Refer to Multi-Function Analog Input Terminal Settings on page 198
for instructions on how to adjust the signal level.
Setting Examples
• Gain H3-03 = 200%, bias H3-04 = 0, terminal A1 as speed reference input (H3-02 = 0):
A 10 Vdc input is equivalent to a 200% speed reference and 5 Vdc is equivalent to a 100% speed reference. Since the
drive output is limited by the maximum frequency parameter (E1-04), the speed reference will be equal to E1-04 above
5 Vdc.
Figure 5.29
H3-01 = 0 H3-01 = 1
common_TMonly
Gain = 200% Gain = 200%
Speed 100%
reference E1-04
-10 V -5 V
100% 0V 5V 10 V
E1-04
-100%
E1-04
196 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
• Gain H3-03 = 100%, bias H3-04 = -25%, terminal A1 as speed reference input:
An input of 0 Vdc will be equivalent to a -25% speed reference.
When parameter H3-01 = 0, the speed reference is 0% between 0 and 2 Vdc input.
When parameter H3-01 = 1, the motor will rotate in reverse between -10 and 2 Vdc input.
Figure 5.30
H3-01 = 0 H3-01 = 1
common_TMonly
100%
100%
Speed H3-01 = 0
reference -10 V -6.0 V
2.0 V 10 V
-25% Analog Input
Voltage
0
2.0 V 10 V
Analog Input -100%
-25% Voltage E1-04
H3-01 = 1 -150%
Figure 5.30 Speed Reference Setting by Analog Input with Negative Bias
Setting 0: 0 to 10 Vdc
The input level is 0 to 10 Vdc. Refer to Setting 0: 0 to 10 Vdc on page 196 for details.
Setting 1: -10 to 10 Vdc
The input level is -10 to 10 Vdc. Refer to Setting 1: -10 to 10 Vdc on page 196 for details.
H3-10: Terminal A2 Function Selection
Determines the function assigned to analog input terminal A2. Refer to Multi-Function Analog Input Terminal Settings
on page 198 for a list of functions and descriptions.
Parameter Details
Parameter H3-12 sets the level of the input value selected that is equal to 0 V at terminal A2.
Both can be used to adjust the characteristics of the analog input signal to terminal A2. The settings work in the same
way as parameters H3-03 and H3-04 for analog input A1.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 197
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
198 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
A setting of 031 or 000 applies no drive monitor to the analog output. With this setting, terminal functions as well as FM
and AM output levels can be set by a PLC via a communication option or MEMOBUS/Modbus (through mode).
H4-02, H4-03: Multi-Function Analog Output Terminal FM Gain and Bias
H4-05, H4-06: Terminal AM Gain and Bias
Parameters H4-02 and H4-05 set the terminal FM and AM output signal level equal to 100% of the monitor (gain).
Parameters H4-03 and H4-06 set the bias added to the monitor output for terminals FM and AM. Both are set as a
percentage, where 100% equals 10 Vdc analog output. The output voltage of both terminals is limited to 10 Vdc.
Select an output signal range between 0 to +10 Vdc or -10 to +10 Vdc using parameters H4-07 and H4-08. Figure 5.31
illustrates how gain and bias settings work.
Parameter Details
2. Adjust H4-02 viewing the monitor connected to the terminal FM.
3. View the value set to H4-03 on the digital operator, terminal FM will output a voltage equal to 0% of the
parameter being set in H4-01.
4. Adjust H4-03 viewing the output signal on the terminal FM.
Terminal AM
5
1. View the value set to H4-05 (Terminal AM Monitor Gain) on the digital operator. A voltage equal to 100% of the
parameter being set in H4-04 will be output from terminal AM.
2. Adjust H4-05 viewing the monitor connected to the terminal AM.
3. View the value set to H4-06 on the digital operator, terminal AM will output a voltage equal to 0% of the
parameter being set in H4-04.
4. Adjust H4-06 viewing the output signal on the terminal AM.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 199
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Example 1: Set H4-02 to 50% for an output signal of 5 V at terminal FM when the monitored value is at 100%.
Example 2: Set H4-02 to 150% for an output signal of 10 V at terminal FM when the monitored value is at 76.7%.
Figure 5.31
H4-07, 08 = 0 H4-07, 08 = 1
common_TMonly
15V
Gain = 150%
Output Voltage
Bias = 0%
10V
Gain = 100%
10 V Bias = 0%
Gain 150% 5V
Bias 0% Gain = 50%
Output Voltage Bias = 0%
-100%
Gain 100%
5V Bias 0% 100%
Monitor Value
-5 V
Gain 50%
Bias 0%
0V -10 V
0% Monitor Value 100%
-15 V
Figure 5.31 Analog Output Gain and Bias Setting Example 1 and 2
Example 3: Set H4-03 to 30% for an output signal of 3 V at terminal FM when the monitored value is at 0%.
Figure 5.32
Gain = 100%
YEG H4-07, 08 = 0 H4-07, 08 = 1
Bias = 30%
10V
Gain = 100%
10 V Output Voltage Bias = 0%
Bias 30% 3V
Output Voltage Gain 100% -100%
100%
Bias 0% Monitor Value
3V -4 V
Gain 100%
0V -10 V
0% Monitor Value 100%
Setting 0: 0 to 10 V
Setting 1: -10 V to 10 V
200 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Note: 1. When the motor protection function is enabled (L1-010), an oL1 alarm can be output through one of the multi-function outputs by
setting H2-01 to 1F. The output will close when the motor overload level reaches 90% of the oL1 detection level.
2. Set L1-01 to a value between 1 and 5 when running a single motor from the drive to select a method to protect the motor from
overheat. An external thermal relay is not necessary.
Setting 0: Disabled (motor overload protection is not provided)
Use this setting if no motor overheat protection is desired.
Setting 1: General-purpose motor (standard self-cooled)
Because the motor is self-cooled, the overload tolerance drops when the motor speed is lowered. The drive appropriately
adjusts the electrothermal trigger point according to the motor overload characteristics, protecting the motor from
overheat throughout the entire speed range.
100
90 Motor designed to operate from line power. Continuous operation at less than line power
Motor cooling is most effective when running at frequency with 100% load can trigger motor
rated base frequency (check the motor nameplate or overload protection (oL1). A fault is output and the
60 specifications). motor will coast to stop.
50 Continuous
A
B
C
05 33 100 120 167 200
Speed (%)
Parameter Details
Setting 2: Drive dedicated motor (speed range for constant torque: 1:10)
Use this setting when operating a drive duty motor that allows constant torque in a speed range of 1:10. The drive will
allow the motor to run with 100% load from 10% up to 100% speed. Running at slower speeds with full load can trigger
an overload fault.
5
Overload Tolerance Cooling Ability Overload Characteristics
150
Rated Speed=100% Speed
60 s
A: Max. speed for 200LJ and above
B: Max. speed for 160MJ to 180 LJ
Torque (%)
Motor is designed to effectively cool itself even at Continuous operation with 100% load from 5 Hz to
low speeds. 50 Hz.
55
50
Continuous A
B
C
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 201
5.8 L: Protection Functions
150
Rated Speed=100% Speed
60 s A: Max. speed for 200LJ and above
B: Max. speed for 160MJ to 180 LJ
100 C: Max. speed for 132MJ and below
Torque (%)
90
Motor is designed to effectively cool itself at ultra- Continuous operation with 100% load from 0.5 Hz to
low speeds. 50 Hz.
50 Continuous
A
B
C
0 1 100120 167 200
Speed (%)
125
Torque (%)
115
Continuous
100
83
77 Motor is designed to effectively cool itself at ultra- Continuous operation with 100% load from 0.2% to
67
low speeds (about 0.2% of base speed). 100% of base speed.
202 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Defaulted to operate with an allowance of 150% overload operation for one minute in a hot start; after continuous
operation at 100%.
Figure 5.33 shows an example of the electrothermal protection operation time using a general-purpose motor operating
at the value of E1-06, Motor Base Speed, with L1-02 set to one minute.
Motor overload protection operates in the area between a cold start and a hot start.
• Cold start: Characteristics of motor protection operation time in response to an overload situation that was suddenly
reached when starting a stationary motor.
• Hot start: Characteristics of motor protection operation time in response to an overload situation that occurred while
the motor was operating continuously at or below its rated current.
Figure 5.33
3
Cold start
(Characteristics when an overload occurs
1 at a complete stop)
0.4
Hot start
(Characteristics when an overload occurs
during continuous operation at 100%)
0.1
Motor current (%)
0 100 150 200
E2-01 = 100% motor current
Figure 5.33 Protection Operation Time for General Purpose Motors at the Rated Output Frequency
Parameter Details
overheat fault level, an oH4 fault will be triggered, a fault signal will be output, and the drive will stop the motor using
the stop method setting in L1-04.
Connect the PTC thermistor between terminals AC and A2 as shown in Figure 5.34. Set parameter H3-09 to 0 and
parameter H3-10 to E.
Figure 5.34
5
Multi-function digital input
Drive MA
Fault output
MB
+V
(+10.5 V, 20 mA) MC
Branch
resistor M1
M2
12 kΩ
A2 (0-10 V) Multi-function
M3
M4 digital outputs
PTC
thermistor
M5
AC M6
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 203
5.8 L: Protection Functions
The PTC thermistor must have the following characteristics for one motor phase. The drives motor overload detection
requires three PTC thermistors to be connected in series.
Figure 5.35
Class F Class H
Resistance (Ω) 150°C 180°C
1330 YEG
Temperature
Tr’
Sets the drive operation when the PTC thermistor input signal reaches the motor overheat alarm level (oH3).
Sets the drive operation when the PTC thermistor input signal reaches the motor overheat fault level (oH4).
204 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Applies a filter on the PTC thermistor input signal to prevent inadvertent motor overheat faults.
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
Note: Install an AC reactor option on the input side of the power supply when setting L2-05 below the default value to prevent damage
to drive circuitry.
Parameter Details
Stall Prevention during acceleration (L3-01) prevents tripping with overcurrent (oC), motor overload (oL1), or drive
overload (oL2) faults common when accelerating with heavy loads.
L3-01 determines the type of Stall Prevention the drive uses during acceleration.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 205
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Figure 5.36
Output current
common_TMonly
Stall Prevention Level
During Acceleration
L3-02
L3-02
-15%
Time
Output speed
<1> The upper limit and default value are determined by the carrier frequency reduction (L8-38).
• Lower L3-02 if stalling occurs when using a motor that is relatively small compared to the drive.
• Also set parameter L3-03 when operating the motor in the constant power range.
L3-05: Stall Prevention Selection during Run
Determines how Stall Prevention works during Run. Stall Prevention during run prevents the motor from stalling by
automatically reducing the speed when a transient overload occurs while the motor is running at constant speed.
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
L3-05 Stall Prevention Selection during Run 0 to 2 1
<1> The upper limit and default for this setting is determined by L8-38.
206 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
For details on setting 2, 3, 4, and 5, refer to H2-01 to H2-05: Terminals M1-M2, M3-M4, M5-M6, P1-C1, and P2-C2
Function Selection on page 187.
L4-03, L4-04: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width (+/-)
Parameter L4-03 sets the detection level for the digital output functions “Speed agree 2,” “User-set speed agree 2,”
“Speed detection 3,” and “Speed detection 4.”
Parameter L4-04 sets the hysteresis level for these functions.
For details on setting 13, 14, 15, and 16, refer to H2-01 to H2-05: Terminals M1-M2, M3-M4, M5-M6, P1-C1, and P2-
C2 Function Selection on page 187.
L4-05: Speed Reference Loss Detection Selection
The drive can detect a loss of an analog speed reference from input A1 and A2. Speed reference loss is detected when the
speed reference falls below 10% of the previous reference, or below 5% of the maximum output frequency within 400
ms.
Figure 5.37
Analog 100%
speed
reference 10%
common_TMonly
Parameter Details
400 ms
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 207
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Determines when speed detection is active using parameters L4-01 through L4-04.
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
L4-07 Speed Agree Detection Selection 0 or 1 0
Fault
common_
TMonly DC Injection/
Position Lock
DC Injection/
Position Lock
Output Speed
Up or Down command
Fault (H2- = E)
208 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Parameter Details
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Use the Torque Detection function of the drive to notify the PLC of potential overcurrent or overload
situations at the load prior to a drive overload fault. Failure to comply may cause the drive to fault with a coasting motor and potentially
damage equipment.
Note: When overtorque occurs in the application, the drive may stop due to overcurrent (oC) or overload (oL1). To prevent this, an
overload situation should be indicated to the controller before oC or oL1 occur in the drive. Use the torque detection for this
purpose.
H2-01 through H2-05 Setting Description
5
B Torque detection 1, N.O. (output closes when overload or underload is detected)
18 Torque detection 2, N.O. (output close when overload or underload is detected)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 209
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Figure 5.39 and Figure 5.40 show the function of overtorque and undertorque detection.
Figure 5.39
L6-03/06 L6-03/06
Torque detection 1 (NO)
or
Torque detection 2 (NO) ON ON
L6-03/06 L6-03/06
Torque detection 1 (NO)
or
Torque detection 2 (NO) ON ON
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: oL3, oL4 at speed agree (Alarm)
Overtorque detection is active only when the output speed is equal to the speed reference, i.e., no detection during
acceleration and deceleration. The operation continues after detection and an oL3/oL4 alarm is triggered.
Setting 2: oL3, oL4 at run (Alarm)
Overtorque detection works as long as the Up/Down command is active. The operation continues after detection and an
oL3 or oL4 alarm is triggered.
Setting 3: oL3, oL4 at speed agree (Fault)
Overtorque detection is active only when the output speed is equal to the speed reference, i.e., no detection during
acceleration and deceleration. The operation is stopped and an oL3 or oL4 fault is triggered.
Setting 4: oL3, oL4 at run (Fault)
Overtorque detection works as long as a Up/Down command is active. Operation stops and an oL3 or oL4 fault is
triggered.
Setting 5: UL3, UL4 at speed agree (Alarm)
Undertorque detection is active only when the output speed is equal to the speed reference, i.e., no detection during
acceleration and deceleration. The operation continues after detection and an oL3 or oL4 alarm is triggered.
Setting 6: UL3, UL4 at run (Alarm)
Undertorque detection works as long as the Up/Down command is active. The operation continues after detection and an
oL3 or oL4 alarm is triggered.
210 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Parameter Details
REV run regenerative FWD run motoring
Parameter L7-04 Parameter L7-01
quadrant 2 quadrant 1
REV motor rotation FWD motor rotation
quadrant 3 quadrant 4
5
Parameter L7-02 Parameter L7-03
REV run motoring FWD run regenerative
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 211
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Disabled
Toque limit is created at start without a delay time. Disable L7-16 to maximize response time when the application
requires sudden acceleration or deceleration at start.
Setting 1: Enabled
A time filter is added to allow the torque limit to build at start.
212 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
Setting 2: Enabled during operation
Setting 3: Enabled during constant speed
A phase loss on the power supply side is detected by measuring the voltage ripple in the DC bus and the drive input
voltage.
Input phase loss (PF) detection is typically triggered by single phase losses, voltage drop or phase imbalance.
Input phase loss detection is disabled when Rescue Operation is activated by one of the input terminals.
L8-06: Input Phase Loss Detection Level
Determines the level for input phase loss detection when a ripple is observed in the DC bus. Phase loss is detected when
the value set to L8-06 is greater than the difference between the peak value and the lowest value of the voltage ripple.
100% detection level = voltage (200 V or 400 V) 2
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
L8-06 Input Phase Loss Detection Level 0.0 to 50.0% Determined by o2-04
Setting 0: Ramp to stop. Decelerates to stop using the deceleration ramp in C1-02.
Setting 1: Coast to stop
Setting 2: Emergency stop. Decelerates to stop using the deceleration ramp in C1-09.
Setting 3: Alarm only. Drive continues operation.
L8-07: Output Phase Loss Protection
Parameter Details
Enables or disables the output phase loss detection, which is triggered when the output current falls below 5% of the
drive rated current.
Note: 1. Nuisance output phase loss detection may occur if the motor's rated current is significantly less than the drive rated current. Disable
this parameter in such cases.
2. Output phase loss detection is not possible when the drive is running a PM motor with light load.
3. Set parameters S1-02 and S1-04 as follows when setting L8-07 to 3. An incorrect setting may result in poor performance or nuisance
faults or alarms. 5
Set S1-02 (DC Injection Current at Start) to a value greater than 15%.
Set S1-04 (DC Injection/Position Lock Time at Start) to a value greater than 100 ms.
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Fault when one phase is lost
An output phase loss fault (LF) is triggered when one output phase is lost. The output shuts off and the motor coasts to
stop.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 213
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Disabled
Ground faults are not detected.
Setting 1: Enabled
A ground fault (GF) is triggered when high leakage current or a ground short circuit occurs in one or two output phases.
L8-10: Heatsink Cooling Fan Operation Selection
Selects the heatsink cooling fan operation.
214 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Disabled
No current unbalance protection is provided to the motor.
Setting 1: Enabled
The LF2 fault is triggered if an output current imbalance is detected. Drive output shuts off and the motor coasts to stop.
L8-35: Installation Selection
Selects the type of installation for the drive and changes the drive overload (oL2) limits accordingly.
Note: This parameter is not reset when the drive is initialized.
Parameter Details
Setting 0: IP20 enclosure
For an IP20 enclosure drive installed with at a minimum of 30 mm space to the next drive or a cabinet wall.
Setting 2: NEMA Type 1 enclosure
For drives compliant with NEMA Type 1 enclosure specifications.
5
L8-38: Automatic Torque Boost Function
When the output current reaches a certain level the drive automatically reduces the carrier frequency to the level set in
L8-39. Because lowering the carrier frequency increases the overload tolerance, the drive is capable of creating
considerably more torque. When the output current falls, the carrier frequency switches back to the value set in C6-03.
Note: 1. Automatically lowering the carrier frequency increases motor noise.
2. Confirm drive capacity so that the maximum output current is less than the current limit.
Setting 0: Disabled
The carrier frequency is not automatically reduced.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 215
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 3: Enabled
The torque capability is improved by reducing the carrier frequency when the output current exceeds a certain value.
L8-39: Reduced Carrier Frequency
Determines value the carrier frequency is reduced to by the torque boost function.
Setting 0: Disabled
Disable braking transistor protection when not using the internal braking transistor, including the following instances:
• When using a regen converter such as DC5.
• When using a regen unit such as RC5.
• When using external braking transistor options like CDBR units.
• When using the drive in common DC bus applications and the internal braking chopper is not installed.
Enabling L8-55 under such conditions can incorrectly trigger a braking transistor fault (rF).
Setting 1: Enabled
The following models come with a built-in braking transistor:
• CIMR-L20008 to 20115
• CIMR-L40005 to 40060
Enable L8-55 when connecting a braking resistor or a braking resistor unit to the drive built-in braking transistor.
Overload Tolerance for Internal Braking Transistor
Below, Figure 5.42 show the overload tolerance level for the drive’s built-in braking transistor.
Figure 5.42
50% 230
50
8
70% 90 500
30
16 160
100% 58 760
Usage
20
5 common_
(%ED) 130%
(%) 43 106 270 1200 TMonly
10
150%
380
21 67 150 600
5
80 170 420
3
29 1800
2
Figure 5.42 Overload Tolerance for Braking Transistor (CIMR-L20008 to 20115, CIMR-L40005 to 40060)
216 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Mode 0
Setting 1: Mode 1
When the Safe Disabled Input is triggered, the operator displays and alarm, and the corresponding output terminal will
react as follows.
Enables or disables the Current Monitoring function. When this parameter is set to 1 (Enabled), the current monitoring
level (L8-99) is added to the conditions required to turn off the Motor Contactor Feedback command at a stop.
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
L8-99: Current Monitoring Level
Note: Available in drive software PRG: 7017 or later.
Parameter Details
Sets the current monitoring level as a percentage of the drive’s rated current. When the output current is equal to or below
the set level, the Motor Contactor Feedback command turns off if the current monitoring selection is enabled (L8-89 =
1). This parameter is also used to activate the Motor Current Monitor (H2- = 5C).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 217
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
Setting 0: Method 1
Setting 1: Method 2
Although this parameter rarely needs to be changed, it may require adjustment in the following situations:
• If hunting occurs, increase the setting value in steps of 0.05 while checking the response.
• If response is low, decrease the setting value in steps of 0.05 while checking the response.
n2-02, n2-03: Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Time Constant 1, 2
Parameter n2-02 sets the time constant normally used by AFR.
Parameter n2-03 sets the time constant during regenerative operation.
Note: Setting parameter n2-02 higher than n2-03 will trigger an oPE08 error.
Although these parameters rarely need to be changed, they may require adjustment in the following situations:
• If hunting occurs, increase n2-02. If response is low, decrease it.
• Increase n2-03 if overvoltage occurs with high inertia loads at the end of acceleration or with sudden load changes.
• If setting n2-02 to a higher value, also increase C4-02 (Torque Compensation Delay Time Constant 1) proportionally.
218 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
750 750
0 0
0 0.5 1 0 0.5 1
Time (s) Time (s)
common_TMonly
Conventional Speed Control Inertia Compensation Control
Figure 5.43 Overshoot Suppression by Inertia Compensation
Figure 5.44
Parameter Details
Enables or disables the Inertia Compensation function.
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled 5
n5-02: Motor Acceleration Time
Sets the time required to accelerate the motor from a full stop up to the rated speed at the rated torque.
Calculation
The motor acceleration time can be calculated by,
Where:
π JMotor nrated • JMotor is the motor inertia in kgm2.
n5-02 =
30 Trated • nrated is the rated speed of the motor in r/min
• Trated is the rated torque of the motor in Nm.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 219
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
<1> Insert 0 kg for the load to calculate the lowest setting, insert the elevator rated load to calculate the maximum setting for
n5-03. Use the lower of calculated values for initial trials and increase n5-03 gradually until the desired performance is
achieved.
220 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
Figure 5.45 shows a block diagram for the Speed Feedback Compensation.
Figure 5.45
Torque U1-09
ASR Limit Torque
Reference
Operating + Kn (1+1/ST) q-Axis
Speed
C5-01, -02 Current
–
L7- Control
q-Axis Current
n5-07
=1
Speed Observer Gain (P)
Speed Feedback
Speed Observer
= 0, 2 =1 n5-08
output monitor = 0, 2 n5-07
=2
U6-56
common_TMonly
Figure 5.45 Speed Feedback Compensation Operation
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
Setting 2: Speed Feedback Compensation test mode
n5-08: Speed Feedback Compensation Gain (P)
Sets the proportional gain for the Speed Feedback Compensation.
Although this parameter rarely requires adjustment, increasing the gain can help improve responsiveness relative to the
load. Lower setting if oscillation occurs.
Parameter Details
Online Tuning compensates insufficient torque and diminished speed control accuracy due to fluctuating motor
temperature.
n6-01: Online Tuning Selection
Selects the type of motor data Online Tuning uses for Open Loop Vector Control. 5
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Line-to-line resistance tuning
This setting enables line-to-line resistance online tuning. This procedure is effective for speed values up to 6 Hz and
improves the overload capacity in the low speed range by adjusting the value set for the motor resistance.
Setting 2: Voltage correction
The drive adjusts the output voltage during run to improve overload tolerance and minimize the effects of high
temperatures on speed accuracy.
Note: This setting can only be selected if the Energy Saving function is disabled (b8-01 = 0).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 221
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
222 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
Setting 0: Disabled
After searching for the rotor pole position one time, the drive starts using the detected rotor position. If the detected
position is wrong, an error occurs when the drive attempts to run the motor. The initial pole search takes approximately
1.5 s.
Setting 1: Enabled
Parameter Details
The rotor pole position search is executed multiple times. The drive starts using the detected rotor position only if there is
no difference between the search results. Otherwise a dv8 error will be output. The initial pole search takes
approximately 1.5 to 5.0 s.
Other Settings
Parameters n8-29 to n8-33 can be used to adjust the current control loop. Adjustment is not normally required. 5
Parameter n8-62 sets a voltage limit in order to prevent voltage saturation.
n8-29: q-Axis Current Control Gain during Normal Operation
Sets the q-Axis proportional gain for the automatic current regulator.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 223
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
224 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Parameter Details
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
o1-03 Digital Operator Display Unit Selection 0 to 6 1
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 225
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Setting 0: Hz
Setting 1: r/min
Note: For motor 2, o1-04 can only be set to 0 for Hertz.
The digital operator display monitors shown directly below the active monitor are the next two sequential monitors. If
o1-06 (User Monitor Selection Mode) is set to “1: 3 Monitor Selectable”, those two monitors are locked as specified by
parameters o1-07 and o1-08 and will not change as the top parameter is scrolled with the Up/Down Arrow keys.
226 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Note: This parameter is displayed only when the drive is set to allow for user-set units (o1-03 = 3).
Parameter Details
default will be 15.70 inches.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 227
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Setting 0: Disabled
The LO/RE key is disabled.
Setting 1: Enabled
The LO/RE switches between LOCAL and REMOTE operation. Switching is possible during stop only. When LOCAL
is selected, the LED indicator on the LO/RE key will light up.
o2-02: STOP Key Function Selection
Determines if the STOP key on the digital operator can still be used to stop drive operation when the drive is being
controlled from a remote source (i.e., not from digital operator).
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
The STOP key will terminate drive operation even if the Up/Down command source is not assigned to the digital
operator. Cycle the Up/Down command to restart the drive if the drive has been stopped by pressing the STOP key.
o2-03: User Parameter Default Value
After completely setting up drive parameters, save the values as user-set defaults with parameter o2-03. After saving the
values, parameter A1-03 (Initialize Parameters) will offer the choice of “1110: User Initialize”. Selecting 1110 resets all
parameters to the user-set default values. Refer to A1-03: Initialize Parameters on page 145 for details on drive
initialization.
228 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
common_TMonly
Parameter Details
Determines whether the drive will stop when the digital operator is removed in LOCAL mode or when b1-02 is set to 0.
When the operator is reconnected, the display will indicate that it was disconnected.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 229
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
230 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Parameter Details
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
o4-11 U2, U3 Initialization 0 or 1 0
Setting 0: No action
The drive keeps the record already saved concerning fault trace and fault history.
Setting 1: Reset fault data
Resets the data for the U2- and U3- monitors. Once o4-11 is set to 1 and the ENTER key is pressed, fault data is 5
erased and the display returns to 0.
o4-12: kWh Monitor Initialization
Resets the kWh monitors U4-10 and U4-11. Initializing the drive or cycling the power does not reset these monitors.
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
o4-12 kWh Monitor Initialization 0 or 1 0
Setting 0: No Action
The kWh data are kept.
Setting 1: Reset kWh Data
Resets the kWh counter. The monitors U4-10 and U4-11 will display “0” after they are initialized. Once o4-12 is set to 1
and the ENTER key is pressed, kWh data is erased and the display returns to 0.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 231
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Setting 0: No Action
Keeps the number of travels counter.
Setting 1: Resets the Number of Travels
Resets the number of travels counter. The monitor U4-24/25 will show 0. Once o4-13 is set to 1 and the ENTER key is
pressed, the counter value is erased and the display returns to 0.
o4-15: Maintenance Alarm Snooze Period
After a maintenance alarm output has been triggered, o4-15 determines the level that will trigger the next alarm for the
same component. The same alarm will be triggered by the detection level that triggered the original alarm plus the level
set in o4-15.
232 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Parameter Details
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
S1-03 DC Injection Current at Stop 0 to 100% 50%
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 233
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Determines the state of the output contactor control command (H2- = 51) during Auto-Tuning. The contactor closes
as soon as the Enter key is pressed in the Auto-Tuning start menu.
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
Setting 2: Enabled during Auto-Tuning and HBB
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Use parameter S1-12 to enable/disable automatic switching of the Motor Contactor Control
output signal during Auto-Tuning. When using setting S1-12 = 1 or 2, ensure that the multi-function output terminals are properly wired
and in the correct state before setting parameter S1-12. Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive, serious injury or death.
234 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Sets the Emergency Stop Start Level as a percentage of the Maximum Output Frequency. This setting is available when
the control mode is set to Closed Loop Vector Control (A1-02 = 3) or Closed Loop Vector Control for PM Motors (A1-02
= 7) and the stopping method is set to Elevator Emergency Stop (b1-03 = 4).
The drive coasts to a stop after the Up/Down command is cleared and when the value of U1-05 (Speed Feedback) is
equal to or greater than the value of S1-26 (Emergency Stop Start Level).
The drive ramps to a stop after the Up/Down command is cleared and when the value of U1-05 (Speed Feedback) is
lower than the value of S1-26 (Emergency Stop Start Level).
Parameter Details
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
S2-05 Slip Compensation Torque Detection Delay Time 0 to 10000 ms 1000 ms
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 235
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Note: 1. Check the C5- parameters to make sure the speed control loop settings are correct before making any adjustments to the Position
Lock gain.
2. Sometimes a fault may occur with detecting the direction of motor rotation (dv4) when using Closed Loop Vector for PM motors. To
correct this, either increase the settings of S3-01 and S3-02, or increase the number of pulses needed to trigger dv4 (F1-19).
Note: 1. Check the C5- parameters to make sure the speed control loop settings are correct before making any adjustments to the Position
Lock gain.
2. Faults may occur when detecting the direction of motor rotation (dv4) when using CLV/PM. To correct this, either increase the
settings of S3-01 and S3-02, or increase the number of pulses required to trigger dv4 (F1-19).
236 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Run Command
ON
SFS output
C1-07
C2-01
S3-21
S3-20
Parameter Details
Figure 5.47 Dwell Speed Reference at Start
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 237
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
238 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Parameter Details
Enables and disables the Light Load Direction Search.
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled 5
Setting 2: Enabled for motor 1 only
S4-02: Light Load Direction Search Method
Determines the method used to perform Light Load Direction Search.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 239
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Setting 0: Battery
Setting 1: UPS (single-phase)
Setting 2: UPS (three-phase)
S4-07: UPS Power
Sets the capacity of the UPS.
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled until Light Load Direction Search is complete
Setting 2: Enabled until stop
S4-12: DC Bus Voltage during Rescue Operation
Sets the DC bus voltage during Rescue Operation.
240 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Setting 0: The setting of parameter d1-25 is used as speed reference for Rescue Operation
Setting 1: The speed selected by digital inputs is used as speed reference
Speed
Parameter Details
0 t
Figure 5.48 Speed During Normal Operation
<1> The drive will recognize the speed reference that is lower than the Leveling Speed Detection Level (d1-28) as the leveling speed if the
speed priority is set for multi-step speed reference (d1-18 = 0 or 3).
Advance Short Floor
Advanced Short Floor minimizes the operation time to arrive at a designated floor. It uses the leveling speed once the
5
leveling speed command is entered via one of the multi-function inputs (H1- = 53). Advance Short Floor calculates
optimal speed based on the Short Floor Minimum Constant Speed Time (S5-03) and the currently selected deceleration
rate.
Table 5.14 explains the Short Floor and Advance Short Floor functions.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 241
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Operating
speed d1-19
(Nominal Speed)
Constant speed
operation at
rated speed d1-26
(normal stop (Leveling Speed)
sequence) 0
Time
H1- = 53
(Leveling Speed) <1> ON(close)
During
acceleration
(The speed is optimal speed or less.)
(The speed is less than 40% of the nominal speed.)
Operating d1-19
Operating d1-19 speed (Nominal Speed)
speed (Nominal Speed) S5-03
Optimal Speed
40% of nominal
speed
d1-26
d1-26 (Leveling Speed)
(Leveling Speed) 0
0 Time
Time
H1- = 53 H1- = 53
ON(close)
(Leveling Speed) <1> ON(close) (Leveling Speed) <1>
Operating
speed d1-19
(Nominal Speed)
40% of nominal
speed
d1-26
(Leveling Speed)
0
Time
H1- = 53
Constant speed (Leveling Speed) <1> ON(close)
operation at
less than the Not Available.
rated speed (The speed is less than 40% of the nominal speed.)
Operating d1-19
speed (Nominal Speed)
40% of nominal
speed
d1-26
(Leveling Speed)
0
Time
H1- = 53
(Leveling Speed) <1> ON(close)
242 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled (Short Floor Operation)
Setting 2: Enabled (Advanced Short Floor Operation)
S5-02: Nominal Speed for Short Floor Calculation
Determines the rated speed used to calculate the distance for the Short Floor function when speed priority is set for
Multi-step Speed Reference (d1-18 = 0 or 3).
Parameter Details
Note: Setting S5-04 too low may trigger an overrun due to faster optimum speeds and shortened leveling times. Avoid setting this gain
less than 100%.
Note: Setting S5-05 too low may trigger an overrun due to faster optimum speeds and shortened leveling times. Avoid setting this gain
less than 100%.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 243
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Note: Leveling Distance Control should be used only for elevators with a constant stopping distance. Do not use Leveling Distance
Control in elevators where the stopping distance changes frequently.
The following functions are disabled when Leveling Distance Control is selected:
• Switching between deceleration times
• Droop Control (b7 parameters)
• Shoot Floor, Advanced Short Floor (S5-01 = 1, 2)
Leveling Distance Control is disabled when any one of the following functions are selected:
• Analog frequency reference
• Rescue Operation
• Inspection Operation
• During Motor 2 selection
Direct Landing
Direct Landing (S5-10 = 1) is activated at the start of deceleration, and brings the elevator car to the designated floor
without the use of the leveling speed.
Direct Landing disables Leveling Distance Control, and uses a speed reference calculated by multiplying E1-04 times
S5-13. If a Stop distance correction command (H1- = 5C) is triggered during Direct Landing, then the drive will
switch to the stop distance set in S5-12 for the remaining distance. Direct Landing will end once data from the encoder
indicates that the stopping distance is 0.
Figure 5.49 illustrates a Direct Landing Operation example.
Table 5.15 Conditions for Direct Landing
Speed Priority Direct Landing Start Conditions
Multi-step speed sequence
Speed reference E1-04 S5-13 and the Up/Down command is not active or the speed reference is 0.
(d1-18 = 0, 3)
High speed reference has priority
(d1-18 = 1) The Up/Down command is not active, the speed reference is 0, or the leveling speed reference has been selected by one of the
Leveling speed reference has priority multi-function input terminals (H1-).
(d1-18 = 2)
244 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Brake Close
Operation
Delay Time
Speed
(S1-07)
S2 Time
<1>
<1> Area S1 is the deceleration distance (S5-11) from the start of deceleration to stop. Area S2 is the stopping distance (S5-12) from the point
at which the stopping distance compensation signal is entered to when the car arrives at the designated floor.
Figure 5.49 Direct Landing Operation Example
Leveling Distance Control
Leveling Distance Control (S5-10 = 2) uses the leveling speed reference for the remaining distance to arrive at the
designated floor. Leveling Distance Control is activated when the conditions listed in Table 5.16 are met.
Table 5.16 Leveling Distance Control Operation
Speed Priority Selection Multi-Function Input Terminal Settings Leveling Distance Control Start Conditions
Multi-step speed sequence
– The Up/Down command is not active or the speed reference is 0.
(d1-18 = 0, 3)
Leveling speed reference is selected The Up/Down command is not active, or all input terminals set for
High speed reference has priority (H1- = 53). H1- = 50 to 53 are open.
(d1-18 = 1) Leveling speed reference is not selected
Up/Down command is not active.
(H1- 53).
Rated speed reference is selected The Up/Down command is not active, or all input terminals set for
Multi-step speed sequence (H1- = 50). H1- = 50 to 53 are open.
(d1-18 = 2) Rated speed reference is not selected
Up/Down command is not active.
(H1- 50).
Parameter Details
(Forward [Up] / Reverse [Down])
OFF ON OFF
H2- = 53 (Not Zero Speed)
H2- = 51 ON Output Contactor Open
(Output Contactor Control) Delay Time (S1-11)
H1- = 56 ON
(Motor Contactor Feedback) Run Command Delay Time (S1-10)
Brake Close
Delay Time
Operation (S1-07)
Speed
S Time
<1>
<1> Area S is the stopping distance (S5-12) from the point at which leveling operation is complete to when the car arrives at the designated
floor.
Figure 5.50 Operation Sequence Example for Leveling Distance Control
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 245
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Setting 0: Disable
Setting 1: Direct Landing
Setting 2: Leveling Distance Control
S5-11: Deceleration Distance
Sets the deceleration distance when Stop Distance Control is enabled. Refer to Direct Landing on page 244 for details.
<1> The setting range becomes 0.00 to 650.00 inches when the length units are set for inches (o1-12 = 1).
<1> The setting range becomes 0.00 to 393.00 inches when the length units are set for inches (o1-12 = 1).
246 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Sets the level of current applied to the motor when the Brake Control command is activated, as a percentage of the Motor
No-load Current (E2-03). A Starting Current Error (SE2) occurs when the drive’s output current is less than the value in
S6-03 after both the Brake Release Delay Time (S1-06) and the SE2 Detection Delay Time (S6-02) have passed after a
RUN command.
Parameter Details
S6-05: Brake Response Error (SE4) Detection Time
Sets a delay time for detecting a brake response error (SE4). SE4 is detected when an output terminal set for “Brake
release” (H2- = 50) and an input terminal set for “Brake feedback” (H1- = 79) do not match for the time set to
S6-05.
<1> Default setting is determined by parameter o1-03. If o1-03 is set to 0 through 5, the default is 1.5 m/s2. If o1-03 is set to 6, the default is 5.0 ft/
s2 (setting range: 0.0 to 50.0 ft/s2).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 247
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
S6-16: Restart after Baseblock Selection
Allows the drive to restart the motor after returning to normal operation from Baseblock state (H1- = 8/9) or from
Safe Torque-Off state (Safe Disable inputs H1 and H2 enabled) while the Up/Down command is still active.
T: Motor Tuning
Auto-Tuning automatically sets and tunes parameters required for optimal motor performance. Refer to Auto-Tuning on
page 99 for details on Auto-Tuning parameters.
248 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.12 U: Monitor Parameters
Parameter Details
• kWh data
• Highest peak current that has occurred and output speed at the time the peak current occurred
• Motor overload status information
• Detailed information about the present Up/Down command and speed reference source selection
Refer to U4: Maintenance Monitors on page 382 for a complete list of U4- monitors and descriptions.
5
U6: Control Monitors
Control monitors show:
• Reference data for the output voltage and vector control
• Data on PM motor rotor synchronization, forward phase compensation, and flux positioning
• Pulse data from the motor encoder
• Pulse data for Position Lock control
• Speed Loop and Inertia Compensation control monitors
Refer to Figure 5.10 on page 161 for details and an illustration showing where monitors are located in the speed
control loop block.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 249
5.12 U: Monitor Parameters
250 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6
Troubleshooting
This chapter provides descriptions of the drive faults, alarms, errors, related displays, and
guidance for troubleshooting.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 251
6.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Sudden Movement Hazard
Ensure there are no short circuits between the main circuit terminals (R/L1, S/L2, and T/L3) or between the
ground and main circuit terminals before restarting the drive.
Failure to comply may result in serious injury or death and will cause damage to equipment.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may illustrate drives without covers or safety shields to display details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Always ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting the motor case.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry, or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Do not remove covers or touch circuit boards while the power is on.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Fire Hazard
Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
Improperly tightened terminal screws can also cause erroneous equipment operation.
252 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Do not connect the AC power line to the output motor terminals of the drive. Failure to comply could result in
death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage application to output terminals.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage
application to output terminals.
• Do not connect AC line power to output terminals U, V, and W.
• Make sure that the power supply lines are connected to main circuit input terminals R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 (or R/L1 and S/
L2 for single-phase power).
NOTICE
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Never connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in damage to the drive.
Do not use unshielded cable for control wiring.
Failure to comply may cause electrical interference resulting in poor system performance. Use shielded twisted-pair
wires and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the product.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive or braking circuit.
Carefully review instruction manual TOBP C720600 0 when connecting a braking option to the drive.
Do not modify the drive circuitry.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive and will void warranty.
Yaskawa is not responsible for modification of the product made by the user.
Check all the wiring after installing the drive and connecting other devices to ensure that all connections are
correct.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive.
Equipment Hazard
Do not check or test control circuit signals while the drive is running.
Improper use of test equipment could result in damage to the drive circuitry by short circuit. Troubleshooting
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 253
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors
254 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors
boL Braking Transistor Overload 259 EF0 Option Card External Fault 262
to
bUS Option Communication Error 259 EF3 to EF8 External Fault (input terminal S3 to S8) 262
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication
CE 259 Err EEPROM Write Error 263
Error
, CPF07, ,
Terminal Board Connection Error 260 oFA05, oFA06 264
CPF08
to ,
oFA10, oFA11 264
, CPF11 to CPF14,
Control Circuit Error 260
CPF16 to CPF21 Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port
to
CN5-A
<1> to
oFA12 to oFA17 264
CPF22 Hybrid IC Failure 260
Troubleshooting
CPF24 Drive Unit Signal Fault 260
CPF25 Terminal Board not Connected 261 oFb00 Option Card Connection Error (CN5-B) 265
dv2 Z Pulse Noise Fault Detection 261 oFC00 Option Card Connection Error (CN5-C) 265
dv3 Inversion Detection 261 oFC01 Option Card Fault (CN5-C) 265
dv4 Inversion Prevention Detection 261 oFC02 Option Card Fault (CN5-C) 265
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 255
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors
oFC51 Encoder Option Analog Circuit Error 266 rF Braking Resistor Fault 269
oFC52 Encoder Communication Timeout 266 rr Dynamic Braking Transistor Fault 269
oFC53 Encoder Communication Data Error 266 SC IGBT Short Circuit 269
oFC54 Encoder Error 266 SCF <2> Safety Circuit Fault 269
oL2 Drive Overload 267 STo Motor Pull Out or Step Out Detection 270
PF Input Phase Loss 268 voF Output Voltage Detection Error 271
<1> Displayed as , when occurring at drive power up. When one of the faults occurs after successfully starting the drive, the display
will show ,
<2> Displayed only for models in compliance with IEC/EN 61508 SIL3 Safety Integrity Level 3.
256 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors
dEv Speed Deviation (for Control Mode with Encoder) YES 273
L8-88 = 0: YES
Hbb Safe Disable Circuit Fault Signal (H1-HC, H2-HC) Release 274
L8-88 = 1: No (default)
L8-88 = 0: YES
HbbF Safe Disable Circuit Fault Signal (H1-HC, H2-HC) Release 274
L8-88 = 1: No (default)
LT-3 Soft Charge Bypass Relay Maintenance Time No output <1> 274
PGo Encoder Disconnected (for Control Mode with Encoder) YES 276
Troubleshooting
voF Output Voltage Detection Error YES 276
Operation Errors
Table 6.5 Operation Error Displays
Digital Operator Display Digital Operator Display 6
Name Page Name Page
LED Operator LCD Operator LED Operator LCD Operator
oPE01 Drive Capacity Setting Error 277 oPE08 Parameter Selection Error 278
oPE02 Parameter Setting Range Error 277 oPE10 V/f Pattern Setting Error 278
oPE05 Reference Source Selection Error 277 oPE20 PG-F3 Setting Error 278
oPE06 Control Mode Selection Error 277 oPE21 Elevator Parameter Setting Fault 278
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 257
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors
Auto-Tuning Errors
Table 6.6 Auto-Tuning Error Displays
Digital Operator Display Digital Operator Display
Name Page Name Page
LED Operator LCD Operator LED Operator LCD Operator
End1 Excessive V/f Setting 279 Er-05 No-Load Current Error 280
End3 Rated Current Setting Alarm 279 Er-09 Acceleration Error 281
End4 Adjusted Slip Calculation Error 279 Er-10 Motor Direction Error 281
End5 Resistance Tuning Error 279 Er-11 Motor Speed Error 281
End6 Leakage Inductance Alarm 279 Er-12 Current Detection Error 281
End7 No-Load Current Alarm 279 Er-13 Leakage Inductance Error 281
End8 Rescue Operation Speed Warning 280 Er-18 Induction Voltage Error 281
Er-01 Motor Data Error 280 Er-21 Z Pulse Correction Error 282
Er-02 Alarm 280 Er-22 Initial Rotor Pole Search Error 282
258 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
Troubleshooting
Current Offset Fault
CoF The current sensor is damaged or there was residual induction current in the motor (e.g., during sudden deceleration or when
coasting) when the drive attempted to start the motor.
Cause Possible Solution
Due to residual induction current in the motor when the • Create a motor restart sequence that allows enough time for the residual induction voltage to dissipate.
drive attempted to start the motor, the drive attempted to • Enable Speed Search at start (b3-01 = 1). Use the multi-function terminals to execute External Speed Search 1 and 2 (H1- =
adjust the current offset value beyond the allowable 61 or 62).
range. Note: When using a PM motor, both External Speed Search 1 and 2 perform the same operation.
Hardware is damaged. Replace the drive. Replace the drive. 6
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
or CPF00 or CPF01 Control Circuit Error
<1>
Cause Possible Solution
• Cycle power to the drive.
There is a self diagnostic error in control circuit.
• Set the frequency to the minimum value and interrupt the Run command when the drive finishes decelerating.
Connector on the operator is damaged. Replace the operator.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 259
6.3 Fault Detection
to ,
CPF11 to CPF14,
Control Circuit Error
to CPF16 to CPF21
<1>
Cause Possible Solution
• Cycle power to the drive.
Hardware is damaged. • If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
instructions on replacing the control board.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
CPF22 Hybrid IC Failure
Cause Possible Solution
• Cycle power to the drive. Refer to Diagnosing and Resetting Faults on page 285.
Hybrid IC failure on the power board • If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
instructions on replacing the control board.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Control Board Connection Error
CPF23
Connection error between the control board and the drive
Cause Possible Solution
• Turn the power off and check the connection between the control board and the drive.
Hardware is damaged. • If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
instructions on replacing the control board.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Drive Unit Signal Fault
CPF24
The drive capacity cannot be detected correctly (drive capacity is checked when the drive is powered up).
Cause Possible Solution
If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
Hardware is damaged.
instructions on replacing the control board.
260 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
Troubleshooting
An external force on the load side has caused the motor • Make sure the motor is rotating in the right direction.
to move. • Look for any problems on the load side that might cause the motor to rotate in the opposite direction.
Noise interference along the encoder cable is disturbing
the encoder signals.
Properly rewire the PG encoder and connect all lines including shielded line.
Encoder is disconnected, not wired properly, or the PG
option card or the encoder itself is damaged.
Rotational direction for the encoder set to F1-05 is the
opposite of the order of the motor lines.
Properly connect the motor lines for each phase (U/T1, V/T2, W/T3).
6
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Inversion Prevention Detection
Pulses indicate that the motor is rotating in the opposite direction of the speed reference. Set the number of pulses to trigger
dv4 inverse detection to F1-19.
Note: Set F1-19 to 0 to disable inverse detection in applications where the motor may rotate in the opposite direction of the speed
reference.
Cause Possible Solution
• Set the encoder offset to E5-11 as specified on the motor nameplate.
The encoder offset is not set properly to E5-11. • If the problem continues after cycling power, then replace either the PG option card or the encoder itself. Replacing the encoder
or changing the motor/encoder rotation direction requires readjustment of the encoder offset.
Noise interference along the encoder cable is disturbing • Make sure the motor is rotating in the correct direction.
the encoder signals. • Look for any problems on the load side that might be causing the motor to rotate in the opposite direction.
Encoder is disconnected, not wired properly, or the PG • Rewire the encoder and make sure all lines including shielded line are properly connected.
option card or the encoder itself is damaged. • If the problem continues after cycling power, replace the PG option card or the encoder.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 261
6.3 Fault Detection
262 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
• Press .
Noise has corrupted data while writing to the EEPROM. • Correct the parameter setting.
• Cycle power to the drive. Refer to Diagnosing and Resetting Faults on page 285.
• If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
instructions on replacing the control board.
If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
Hardware problem.
instructions on replacing the control board.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Speed Reference Missing
FrL Parameter d1-18 is set to 3, leveling speed detection is not assigned to a digital input (H1- 53) and no speed was selected
while an Up or Down command was entered.
Cause Possible Solution
• Make sure the selected speed selection method matches the elevator controller sequence. Check parameter d1-18 and H1-
Parameter d1-18 is set to 1, H1- is not set to 53 and settings.
no speed was selected at start. • Make sure the elevator controller is connected properly.
• Make sure the elevator controller selects the speed properly.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Ground Fault
GF
A current short to ground exceeded 50% of rated current on the output side of the drive.
Cause Possible Solution
• Check the insulation resistance of the motor.
Motor insulation is damaged.
• Replace the motor.
• Check the motor cable.
• Remove the short circuit and turn the power back on.
A damaged motor cable is creating a short circuit.
• Check the resistance between the cable and the ground terminal .
• Replace the cable.
• Reduce the carrier frequency.
The leakage current at the drive output is too high.
• Reduce the amount of stray capacitance.
The drive started to run during a current offset fault or The value set exceeds the allowable setting range while the drive automatically adjusts the current offset (this happens only when
while coasting to a stop. attempting to restart a PM motor that is coasting to stop).
If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
Hardware problem.
instructions on replacing the control board.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Output Phase Loss
LF • Phase loss on the output side of the drive.
• Setting L8-07 to 1 or 2 enables Phase Loss Detection.
Cause Possible Solution
• Check for wiring errors and properly connect the output cable.
The output cable is disconnected.
• Correct the wiring.
• Check the resistance between motor lines.
The motor winding is damaged.
• Replace the motor if the winding is damaged.
The output terminal is loose. Apply the tightening torque specified in this manual to fasten the terminals. Refer to Wire Size on page 69.
The rated current of the motor being used is less than 5%
Check the drive and motor capacities.
of the drive rated current.
If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
An output transistor is damaged.
instructions on replacing the control board.
A single-phase motor is being used. The drive cannot operate a single phase motor.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Troubleshooting
Output Current Imbalance (detected when L8-29 = 1)
LF2
One or more of the phases in the output current is lost.
Cause Possible Solution
• Check for faulty wiring or poor connections on the output side of the drive.
Phase loss has occurred on the output side of the drive.
• Correct the wiring.
Terminal wires on the output side of the drive are loose. Apply the tightening torque specified in this manual to fasten the terminals. Refer to Wire Size on page 69.
If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
The output circuit is damaged.
instructions on replacing the control board. 6
• Measure the line-to-line resistance for each motor phase. Ensure all values are the same.
Motor impedance or motor phases are uneven.
• Replace the motor.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 263
6.3 Fault Detection
, oFA10, oFA11
Option card error occurred at option port CN5-A
to oFA12 to oFA17
to oFA30 to oFA43
Cause Possible Solution
• Cycle power to the drive.
Option card or hardware is damaged. • If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
instructions on replacing the control board.
264 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
to oFb03 to oFb11
Option card error occurred at Option Port CN5-B
to oFb12 to oFb17
Cause Possible Solution
• Cycle power to the drive.
Option card or hardware is damaged. • If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
instructions on replacing the control board.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Option Card Connection Error at Option Port CN5-C
oFC00
Option compatibility error
Cause Possible Solution
The option card installed into port CN5-C is
Confirm that the drive supports the option card to be installed. Contact Yaskawa for assistance.
incompatible with the drive.
A communication option card has been installed in
Communication option cards are only supported by option port CN5-A. It is not possible to install more than one comm. option.
option port CN5-C.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-C
oFC01
Option not properly connected
Cause Possible Solution
• Turn the power off and reconnect the option card.
• Check if the option card is properly plugged into the option port. Make sure the card is fixed properly.
The option board connection to port CN5-C is faulty.
• Try to use the card in another option port (in case of a PG option use port CN5-B). If the option card works in a different port,
replace the drive because port CN5-C is damaged. If the error persists (oFA01 or oFb01 occur), replace the option board.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-C
oFC02
A maximum of two PG option boards can be used simultaneously. Remove the PG option board installed into option port CN5-A.
Cause Possible Solution
Troubleshooting
An option card of the same type is already installed in
Except for PG options, each option card type can only be installed once. Make sure only one type of option card is connected.
option port CN5-A or CN5-B.
An input option card is already installed in option port Make sure that a comm. option, a digital input option, or an analog input option is installed. The same type of card cannot be
CN5-A or CN5-B. installed twice.
Three PG option boards are installed. A maximum of two PG option boards can be used simultaneously. Remove the PG option board installed into option port CN5-A.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
oFC03 to oFC11
to
Option card error occurred at option port CN5-C 6
to oFC12 to oFC17
Cause Possible Solution
• Cycle power to the drive.
Option card or hardware is damaged. • If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
instructions on replacing the control board.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Encoder Option AD Conversion Error
oFC50
Error with the A/D conversion level (VCC level), or A/D conversion timed out.
Cause Possible Solution
The PG option card is damaged. Replace the PG option card.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 265
6.3 Fault Detection
266 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
Troubleshooting
• Lower the carrier frequency (C6-03).
Excessive torque compensation. Reduce the torque compensation gain (C4-01) until there is no speed loss but less current.
Output current fluctuation due to input phase loss Check the power supply for phase loss.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Overtorque Detection 1
oL3
The current has exceeded the value set for torque detection (L6-02) for longer than the allowable time (L6-03).
Cause Possible Solution
Parameter settings are not appropriate for the load. Check the settings of parameters L6-02 and L6-03. 6
Fault on the machine side (e.g., machine is locked up). Check the status of the load. Remove the cause of the fault.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Overtorque Detection 2
oL4
The current has exceeded the value set for Overtorque Detection 2 (L6-05) for longer than the allowable time (L6-06).
Cause Possible Solution
Parameter settings are not appropriate for the load. Check the settings of parameters L6-05 and L6-06.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 267
6.3 Fault Detection
268 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
Troubleshooting
Motor contactor does not respond within the time set to S1-10 (Run Command Delay Time).
Cause Possible Solution
There is a problem with the motor contactor or auxiliary
Check the motor contactor, auxiliary switches and the wiring of the contactor feedback signal.
switch.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Starting Current Error
SE2
The output current was lower than 25% of the motor no-load current at start.
Cause Possible Solution 6
The motor contactor is open. Check the contactor for any problems.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Output Current Error
SE3
The output current was lower than 25% of the motor no-load current during operation.
Cause Possible Solution
The motor contactor opened. Check the contactor for any problems.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Brake Feedback Error
SE4 The input terminal set for “Brake feedback” (H1- = 79) or “Brake feedback 2” (H1- = 5B) did not respond within the
SE4 error time set to S6-05 after an output terminal set for “Brake release” (H2- = 50) closed.
Cause Possible Solution
The feedback contact on the brake is defective or the
Check the brake feedback contact and the wiring.
wiring is incorrect.
The brake control circuit does not work properly. Ensure the motor brake operates properly with a brake control command from the drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 269
6.3 Fault Detection
270 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
<1> Displayed as or when occurring at drive power up. When one of the faults occurs after successfully starting the drive, the display
will show or .
<2> Displayed only for models in compliance with IEC/EN 61508 SIL3 Safety Integrity Level 3.
Troubleshooting
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 271
6.4 Alarm Detection
272 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.4 Alarm Detection
Troubleshooting
External fault (input terminal S4)
EF4
External fault at multi-function input terminal S4.
External fault (input terminal S5)
EF5
External fault at multi-function input terminal S5.
External fault (input terminal S6)
EF6
External fault at multi-function input terminal S6. 6
External fault (input terminal S7)
EF7
External fault at multi-function input terminal S7.
External fault (input terminal S8)
EF8
External fault at multi-function input terminal S8.
Cause Possible Solutions
An external device has tripped an alarm function. Remove the cause of the external fault and reset the multi-function input value.
• Ensure the signal lines have been connected properly to the terminals assigned for external fault detection (H1- = 2C to 2F).
Wiring is incorrect.
• Reconnect the signal line.
• Check if the unused terminals have been set for H1- = 2C to 2F (External Fault).
Multi-function contact inputs are set incorrectly.
• Change the terminal settings.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 273
6.4 Alarm Detection
274 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.4 Alarm Detection
Troubleshooting
Inappropriate parameter settings. Check the setting for the overspeed detection level and the overspeed detection time (F1-08 and F1-09).
Digital Operator Display Minor Fault Name
DC Bus Overvoltage
ov The DC bus voltage exceeded the trip point.
For 200 V class: approximately 410 V
For 400 V class: approximately 820 V
Cause Possible Solutions 6
• Install a DC reactor or an AC reactor.
Surge voltage present in the drive input power. • Voltage surge can result from a thyristor convertor and a phase advancing capacitor operating on the same drive input power
system.
The motor is short-circuited.
• Check the motor power cable, relay terminals and motor terminal box for short circuits.
Ground current has over-charged the main circuit • Correct grounding shorts and turn the power back on.
capacitors via the drive input power.
• Review possible solutions for handling noise interference.
Noise interference causes the drive to operate • Review section on handling noise interference and check control circuit lines, main circuit lines and ground wiring.
incorrectly. • If the magnetic contactor is identified as a source of noise, install a surge protector to the MC coil.
Set number of fault reset (L5-01) to a value other than 0.
Encoder cable is disconnected. Reconnect the cable.
Encoder cable wiring is wrong. Correct the wiring.
Noise interference along encoder wiring. Separate encoder wiring from the source of the noise (often output wiring from the drive).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 275
6.4 Alarm Detection
276 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.5 Operator Programming Errors
Troubleshooting
not connected to the drive.
Although the digital card input is set for BCD special for a 5 digit input (F3-01 = 6), the data
Set the input data for 16 bit (F3-03 = 2).
length is set for 8 bit or 12 bit (F3-03 = 0, 1).
Digital Operator Display Error Name
Control Mode Selection Error
oPE06
Correct the setting for the control method.
Cause Possible Solutions 6
A control mode has been selected that requires a PG option card to be installed, but no option • Connect a PG option card.
card is installed (A1-02 = 3 or 7). • Correct the value set to A1-02.
Digital Operator Display Error Name
Multi-function Analog Input Selection Error
oPE07
A contradictory setting is assigned to multi-function analog inputs H3-02 and H3-10.
Cause Possible Solutions
Change the settings to H3-02 and H3-10 so that functions no longer conflict.
At least two analog input terminals are set to the same function (i.e., parameters H3-02 and
Note: Both 0 (speed reference bias) and F (not used) can be set to H3-02 and H3-10 at the
H3-10 have the same setting).
same time.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 277
6.5 Operator Programming Errors
278 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.6 Auto-Tuning Fault Detection
End1 Excessive V/f Setting (detected only during Rotational Auto-Tuning, and displayed after Auto-Tuning is complete)
End2 Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient (detected only during Rotational Auto-Tuning and displayed after Auto-Tuning is complete)
Troubleshooting
Cause Possible Solutions
The resistance value that was calculated is outside • Double-check the data that was entered for the Auto-Tuning process.
the allowable range. • Check the motor and motor cable connection for faults.
Digital Operator Display Error Name
End6 Leakage Inductance Alarm
Cause Possible Solutions
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 279
6.6 Auto-Tuning Fault Detection
Er-02 Alarm
280 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.6 Auto-Tuning Fault Detection
Troubleshooting
Double-check the data entered to the T2- parameters, and perform Auto-Tuning again.
value outside the allowable setting range.
Digital Operator Display Error Name
Er-19 Inductance Error
Cause Possible Solutions
The induced voltage constant attempted to set a
Double-check the data entered to the T2- parameters, and perform Auto-Tuning again.
value to E5-08 or E5-09 outside the allowable range.
Digital Operator Display Error Name 6
Er-20 Stator Resistance Error
Cause Possible Solutions
Stator resistance tuning attempted to set a value to
Double-check the data entered to the T2- parameters, and perform Auto-Tuning again.
E5-06 that is outside the allowable setting range.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 281
6.6 Auto-Tuning Fault Detection
282 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.7 Copy Function Related Displays
Troubleshooting
Cause Possible Solutions
Attempted to read data from the encoder during undervoltage. Make sure there is no undervoltage fault or alarm, then try reading the data again.
Digital Operator Display Task
ECS Checksum Error
Cause Possible Solutions
Checksum error occurred when attempting to read data from
the encoder.
Try copying the data again.
6
Digital Operator Display Task
EdE Write Impossible
Cause Possible Solutions
Drive settings do not permit writing to the encoder (F1-51 =
0), or there was a CPF24 while attempting to write to the Set the drive to allow encoder to be written to (F1-51 = 1) and try writing the data again.
encoder.
Digital Operator Display Task
EiF Write Data Error
Cause Possible Solutions
Communication error occurred while attempting to write to the
Make sure communications are normal and try writing to the encoder again.
encoder.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 283
6.7 Copy Function Related Displays
284 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.8 Diagnosing and Resetting Faults
Troubleshooting
- MONITR - DRV Rdy
Last Fault
U2-02= oC
4. Press and to scroll to monitor U2-02. The fault code shown in U2-02 is the fault that occurred last. U2-03= 0.00% RSEQ
U2-04= 0.00% LREF
FWD FWD/REV
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 285
6.8 Diagnosing and Resetting Faults
displayed. ESC
LO
RE
RESET ENTER
RUN STOP
Drive
Close then open the fault signal digital input via terminal S4. Fault Reset Switch
Resetting via Fault Reset Digital Input S4 S4 Fault Reset Digital Input
S4 is set for “Fault Reset” as default (H1-04 = 14).
SC Digital Input Common
2 ON
If the above methods do not reset the fault, turn off the drive main power supply. Reapply power after the digital
operator display is out.
1 OFF
Note: If the Up/Down command is present, the drive will disregard any attempts to reset the fault. Remove the Up/Down command
before attempting to clear a fault situation.
286 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7
Periodic Inspection & Maintenance
This chapter describes the periodic inspection and maintenance of the drive to ensure that it
receives the proper care to maintain overall performance.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 287
7.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Ensuring Safety during Auto-Tuning
When using a PM motor for the first time, or when replacing the drive or PM motor, always make sure that
motor parameter have been set properly and the speed detection function accurately prior to operation. Using a
PM motor requires that the encoder offset be set correctly in addition to entering motor data to corresponding
parameters. If the motor, encoder, or drive is ever replaced, be sure to perform Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning.
Insufficient torque can cause the elevator car to move in the direction of the load, or cause the motor to behave
erratically (reverse operation, stand still, sudden accelerations, etc.).
For more information, refer to the instruction manual included with the motor.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not connect or disconnect wiring to the drive or motor while the power is on. Failure to comply will result in
death or serious injury.
Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment. The internal capacitor remains charged even after the power
supply is turned off. The charge indicator LED will extinguish when the DC bus voltage is below 50 Vdc. To prevent
electric shock, wait at least five minutes after all indicators are OFF and measure the DC bus voltage level to confirm
safe level.
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Do not attempt to modify or alter the drive in any way not explained in this manual. Yaskawa is not responsible
damage caused by modification of the product made by the user. Failure to comply could result in death or serious
injury from operation of damaged equipment.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting ungrounded electrical
equipment.
Always ground the ground terminal. (200 V Class: Ground to 100 or less, 400 V Class: Ground to 10 or less)
Verify motor wiring bare wire ends do not contact the drive chassis or enclosure when wiring drive terminals U/
T1, V/T2, W/T3.
Failure to comply may result in serious injury or death due to electrical shock.
288 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing, and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
Switch off and lock power supply and lock the switch before wiring terminals.
Failure to comply could result in serious injury or death.
Fire Hazard
Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
Do not use an improper voltage source.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire.
Verify that the rated voltage of the drive matches the voltage of the incoming power supply before applying power.
Do not use improper combustible materials in drive installation, repair or maintenance.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire. Attach the drive or braking resistors to metal or other
noncombustible material.
CAUTION
Burn Hazard
Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury.
Shut off the power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and make sure
heatsink has cooled down.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 289
7.1 Section Safety
NOTICE
Follow cooling fan replacement instructions. The cooling fan cannot operate properly when it is installed
incorrectly and could seriously damage the drive.
Follow the instructions in this manual to replace the cooling fan, making sure that the label is on top before inserting
the cooling fan into the drive. To ensure maximum useful product life, replace both cooling fans when performing
maintenance.
Do not connect the AC power line to the output motor terminals of the drive.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage
application to output terminals. could result in death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line
voltage application to output terminals.
Do not use unshielded cable for control wiring.
Failure to comply may cause electrical interference resulting in poor system performance. Use shielded, twisted-pair
wires and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
Do not modify the drive circuitry.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive and will void warranty.
Yaskawa is not responsible for any modification of the product made by the user. This product must not be modified.
Check all the wiring to ensure that all connections are correct after installing the drive and connecting any other
devices.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive.
Make sure wiring to motor terminals U, V, and W connect the corresponding U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 output
terminals on the drive.
Wiring to the wrong terminals will reverse the phase order, causing the motor to operate in reverse. This could cause
the elevator car to fall when attempting to go up.
Never use a magnet contactor on the input side of the drive.
Refrain from switching an input contactor more often than once every 30 minutes. Normally the drive I/O should be
used to stop and start the motor.
Do not operate damaged equipment.
Failure to comply could result in further damage to the equipment.
Do not connect or operate any equipment with visible damage or missing parts.
290 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.2 Inspection
7.2 Inspection
Power electronics have limited life and may exhibit changes in characteristics or performance deterioration after years of
use under normal conditions. To help avoid such problems, it is important to perform preventive maintenance and
periodic inspection on the drive.
Drives contain a variety of power electronics such as power transistors, semiconductors, capacitors, resistors, fans, and
relays. The electronics in the drive serve a critical role in maintaining proper motor control.
Follow the inspection lists provided in this chapter as a part of a regular maintenance program.
Note: The drive will require more frequent inspection if it is placed in harsh environments, such as:
• High ambient temperatures
• Frequent starting and stopping
• Fluctuations in the AC supply or load
• Excessive vibrations or shock loading
• Dust, metal dust, salt, sulfuric acid, chlorine atmospheres
• Poor storage conditions.
Perform the first equipment inspection one to two years after installation.
Maintenance
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 291
7.2 Inspection
292 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.3 Periodic Maintenance
Replacement Parts
Table 7.3 contains the estimated performance life of components that require replacement during the life of the drive.
Only use Yaskawa replacement parts for the appropriate drive model and revision.
Table 7.3 Estimated Performance Life
Component Estimated Performance Life
Cooling Fan, Circulation Fan 10 years
Electrolytic Capacitors 10 years <1>
<1> The drive has few serviceable parts and may require complete drive replacement.
NOTICE: Estimated performance life based on specific usage conditions. These conditions are provided for the purpose of replacing
parts to maintain performance. Some parts may require more frequent replacement due to poor environments or rigorous use. Usage
conditions for estimated performance life:
Ambient temperature: Yearly average of 40C (IP00 enclosure)
Load factor: 80% maximum
Operation time: 24 hours a day
Maintenance
U4-06 Inrush (pre-charge) Relay Displays the number of times the drive is powered up as a percentage of the performance life of the inrush circuit.
U4-07 IGBT Displays the percentage of the maintenance period reached by the IGBTs.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 293
7.3 Periodic Maintenance
<1> LT-1 The cooling fans have reached 90% of their designated lifetime. Replace the cooling fan.
The DC bus capacitors have reached 90% of their designated
<1> LT-2 Replace the drive.
lifetime.
The DC bus charge circuit has reached 90% of its designated
<1> LT-3 Replace the drive.
lifetime.
<1> LT-4 The IGBTs have reached 50% of their designated lifetime. Check the load, carrier frequency, and output frequency.
<2> TrPC The IGBTs have reached 90% of their designated lifetime. Replace the drive.
<1> This alarm message will be output only if the Maintenance Monitor function is assigned to one of the digital outputs (H2- = 2F). The alarm
will also trigger a digital output that is programmed for alarm indication (H2- = 10).
<2> This alarm message will always be output, even if the Maintenance Monitor function is not assigned to any of the digital outputs (H2- =
2F). The alarm will also trigger a digital output that is programmed for alarm indication (H2- = 10).
294 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
Contact your Yaskawa representative or the nearest Yaskawa sales office to order replacement cooling fans as required.
For drives with multiple cooling fans, replace all the fans when performing maintenance to ensure maximum product
performance life.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 295
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the
power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and ensure the heatsink has cooled
down.
NOTICE: Follow cooling fan and circulation fan replacement instructions. Improper fan replacement may cause damage to equipment.
When installing the replacement fan into the drive, make sure the fan is facing upwards. Replace all fans when performing
maintenance to help ensure maximum useful product life.
Figure 7.1
YEG
296 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the
power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and ensure the heatsink has cooled
down.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Follow cooling fan replacement instructions. The cooling fan cannot operate properly when it is installed
incorrectly and could seriously damage the drive. Follow the instructions in this manual to replace the cooling fan, making sure that the
label is on top before inserting the cooling fan into the drive. To ensure maximum useful product life, replace both cooling fans when
performing maintenance.
YEG
Figure 7.2 Removing the Fan Cover: 20018 to 20075, 40006 to 40039
2. Remove the cooling fan cartridge. Disconnect the pluggable connector and remove the fan.
Figure 7.3
YEG
Figure 7.3 Removing the Cooling Fan: 20018 to 20075, 40006 to 40039
7
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 297
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
YEG
A
YEG
A – Back B – Front
Figure 7.5 Cooling Fan Power Supply Connectors: 20018 to 20075, 40006 to 40039
3. While pressing in on the hooks on the left and right sides of the fan finger guard, guide the fan finger guard until
it clicks back into place.
Figure 7.6
YEG
Figure 7.6 Reattach the Fan Cover: 20018 to 20075, 40006 to 40039
4. Turn the power supply back on and reset the cooling fan operation time for the Maintenance Monitor by setting
o4-03 to 0.
298 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the
power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and ensure the heatsink has cooled
down.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Follow cooling fan replacement instructions. The cooling fan cannot operate properly when it is installed
incorrectly and could seriously damage the drive. Follow the instructions in this manual to replace the cooling fan, making sure that the
label is on top before inserting the cooling fan into the drive. To ensure maximum useful product life, replace both cooling fans when
performing maintenance.
YEG
Figure 7.7 Removing the Cooling Fan Cover: 20085, 20115, 40045, and 40060
2. Lift out the back end of the fan finger guard first. Unplug the replay connector and free the fan finger guard from
the drive.
Figure 7.8
YEG
Maintenance
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 299
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
YEG A
A – Back B – Front
Figure 7.9 Cooling Fan Power Supply Connectors: 20085, 20115, 40045, and 40060
3. Install the replacement fan into the drive.
Figure 7.10
Figure 7.10 Installing the Cooling Fan: 20085, 20115, 40045, and 40060
4. Tilt up the back end of the fan finger guard and slide the fan finger guard into the opening near the front of the
drive, then guide the fan finger guard into place.
Figure 7.11
Insertion area
Hook Hook
Front of drive
Figure 7.11 Reattach the Fan Cover: 20085, 20115, 40045, and 40060
300 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
5. While pressing in on the hooks located on the left and right sides of the fan cover, free the fan cover by lifting the
back end first.
Figure 7.12
YEG
Figure 7.12 Reattach the Fan Cover: 20085, 20115, 40045, and 40060
6. Turn the power supply back on and reset the cooling fan operation time for the Maintenance Monitor by setting
o4-03 to 0.
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the
power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and ensure the heatsink has cooled
down.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Follow cooling fan replacement instructions. The cooling fan cannot operate properly when it is installed
incorrectly and could seriously damage the drive. Follow the instructions in this manual to replace the cooling fan, making sure that the
label is on top before inserting the cooling fan into the drive. To ensure maximum useful product life, replace both cooling fans when
performing maintenance.
YEG
YEG
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 301
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
YEG
A
YEG
A – Back B – Front
Figure 7.16 Cooling Fan Power Supply Connectors: 40075 and 40091
3. Angle the fan cover as shown in Figure 7.15 and insert the connector tabs into the corresponding holes on the
drive.
Figure 7.17
YEG
Hook Hook
Front of Drive
Figure 7.17 Reattach the Fan Cover: 40075 and 40091
302 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
4. While pressing in on the hooks of the left and right sides of the fan cover, guide the fan finger guard until it clicks
back into place.
Figure 7.18
YEG
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the
power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and ensure the heatsink has cooled
down.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Follow cooling fan replacement instructions. The cooling fan cannot operate properly when it is installed
incorrectly and could seriously damage the drive. Follow the instructions in this manual to replace the cooling fan, making sure that the
label is on top before inserting the cooling fan into the drive. To ensure maximum useful product life, replace both cooling fans when
performing maintenance.
A C A A
B
B D
Maintenance
B
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 303
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
3. Remove the screws holding the fan unit in place and slide the fan unit out of the drive.
Figure 7.20
YEG
Figure 7.20 Removing the Fan Unit: 20145 to 20415, and 40112 to 40216
4. Remove the fan guard and replace the cooling fans.
Note: Do not pinch the fan cable between parts when reassembling the fan unit.
Figure 7.21
A A
20145 to 20283
40112 to 40180
A B B
C C
YEG
D
304 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
2. Place the fan connector covered by the tube as shown in Figure 7.22.
Figure 7.22
Fan B1 Fan B2
YEG
Figure 7.22 Cooling Fan Wiring for Models 20145, 20180, 40112 and 40150
3. Make sure that the protective tube does not stick out beyond the fan guard.
4. Double-check the relay connector to ensure that it is properly connected.
Cooling Fan Wiring: CIMR-L20215, 20283, and 40180
1. Position the protective tube so that the fan connector sits in the center of the protective tube.
Protective tube
COMMON
TMonly
2. Insert the connector for fan B2 and guide the lead wire for fan B2 so the cable hook holds it in place. Insert the
connector for fan B1.
Figure 7.23
Cable hook
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 305
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
Fan B3
Fan B1 Fan B2
YEG
Figure 7.25 Installing the Cooling Fan Unit: 20145 to 20415, and 40216
2. Reattach the covers and digital operator.
3. Turn the power supply back on and reset the cooling fan operation time for the Maintenance Monitor by setting
o4-03 to 0.
306 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.5 Drive Replacement
Terminal Board
CAUTION! Crush Hazard. Carrying the drive by the front cover may cause the main body of the drive to fall, resulting in minor or
moderate injury. Always hold the case when carrying the drive.
NOTICE: Correctly set parameter o2-04 when replacing the control terminal board. Failure to comply may result in drive damage due
to lack of protective functions and poor drive performance.
The drive has a modular I/O terminal block that facilitates quick drive replacement. The terminal board contains on-
board memory that stores all drive parameter settings and allows the parameters to be saved and transferred to the
replacement drive. To transfer the terminal board, disconnect the terminal board from the damaged drive then reconnect
it to the replacement drive. Once transferred, there is no need to manually reprogram the replacement drive.
Note: If the damaged drive and the new replacement drive are have different capacities, the data stored in the control terminal board
cannot be transferred to the new drive and an oPE01 error will appear on the display. The control terminal board can still be used,
but parameter setting from the old drive cannot be transferred. The replacement drive must be initialized and manually
programmed.
Figure 7.26
YEG
E
C D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 307
7.5 Drive Replacement
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not allow unqualified personnel to perform work on the drive. Failure to comply could result in
serious injury. Installation, maintenance, inspection and servicing must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit
boards. Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
The following procedure explains how to replace a drive. This section provides instructions for drive replacement only.
To install option cards or other types of options, refer to the specific manuals for those options.
NOTICE: When transferring a braking transistor, braking resistor, or other type of option from a damaged drive to a new replacement
drive, make sure they are working properly before reconnecting them to the new drive. Replace broken options to prevent immediate
break down of the replacement drive.
1. Remove the terminal cover. Refer to Terminal Cover on page 55 for details.
Note: The shape of the terminal covers and the numbers of the screws differ depending on the drive models. Refer to Component
Names on page 29 for details.
Figure 7.27
YEG
YEG
308 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.5 Drive Replacement
3. Slide the terminal board as illustrated by the arrows to remove it from the drive along with the bottom cover.
Figure 7.29
YEG
YEG
YEG
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 309
7.5 Drive Replacement
310 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8
Peripheral Devices & Options
This chapter explains the installation of peripheral devices and options available for the drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 311
8.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Do not change wiring, remove covers, connectors or options cards, or attempt to service the drive with power
applied to the drive.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all power to the drive and check for unsafe
voltages before servicing.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting the motor case.
Always properly ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
Fire Hazard
Always use braking resistors that are equipped with a thermal overload relay contact, and utilize this contact to
switch off the drive in case of braking resistor overheat.
When connecting the braking resistors to the drive internal braking transistor, make sure the braking transistor will not
be overloaded with the required duty cycle and the selected resistance value. Failure to comply could result in death or
serious injury by fire from overheating resistors.
Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
Applications using a braking option should wire a thermal relay so that the output contactor opens when the
thermal relay trips.
Inadequate braking circuit protection could result in death or serious injury by fire from overheating resistors.
312 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Confirm an actual motor overload condition is not present prior to increasing the thermal oL trip detection
setting.
Check local electrical codes before making adjustments to motor thermal overload settings.
Sudden Movement Hazard
Install a properly controlled contactor on the input-side of the drive for applications where power should be
removed from the drive during a fault condition.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in death or serious injury.
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Never connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in damage to the drive.
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Do not connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in damage to the drive.
Insulate shields with heat shrink tubing or tape to prevent contact with other signal lines and equipment.
Improper wiring practices could result in drive or equipment malfunction due to short circuit.
Use a class 2 power supply (UL standard) when connecting to the control terminals.
Improper application of peripheral devices could result in drive performance degradation due to improper power
supply.
Only connect recommended devices to the drives braking transistor terminals.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive or braking circuit.
Carefully review instruction manual TOBP C720600 0 when connecting a braking option to the drive.
Never use a magnet contactor on the input side of the drive frequently to start and stop the motor.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive.
Properly integrate auxiliary contacts into the control logic circuit to avoid unnecessary fault displays caused by
contactors or output switches placed between drive and motor.
Peripheral Devices &
Improper installation of input and output contactors could result in damage to the drive.
Improper application of devices on drive output circuits can damage the drive
Options
Do not connect unapproved LC or RC interference suppression filters, capacitors, ground fault circuits, or overvoltage
protection devices to the drive.
Improper application of peripheral devices could result in malfunction of drive due to electrical interference. 8
Follow manufacturer recommendations when installing electrical devices near the drive and take precautions to shield
the drive from electrical interference.
Properly integrate auxiliary contacts into the control logic circuit to avoid unnecessary fault displays caused by
contactors or output switches placed between drive and motor.
Improper installation of input and output contactors could result in damage to the drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 313
8.2 Drive Options and Peripheral Devices
314 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.3 Connecting Peripheral Devices
YASKAWA
USB Copy Unit
ERR
Supply
COM
JVOP-181
LOCK
USB Cable
py rify ad
Co Ve Re
Magnetic
Contactor
(MC)
+2
+1
DC Reactor
<1>
AC Reactor Thermal Relay
Zero-phase
Reactor
Fuse
Ground
Magnetic Zero-phase
Contactor Reactor
(switches to
YEG
line power)
Ground
<1> Terminals +1 and +2 for connecting a DC choke are available only in units CIMR-L20008 to 20075 and
CIMR-L40005 to 40039. Drives above have built in DC chokes.
<2> Terminals B1 and B2 for connecting a braking resistor are available only in units CIMR-L20008 to 20115 and
CIMR-L40005 to 40060.
<3> When using an external braking chopper in drives from CIMR-L20008 to 20115 and CIMR-L40005 to
40060 connect the chopper to drive terminals B1 and -. When using larger drives connect the chopper to terminals
+3 and -.
<4> To obtain the driver and software of USB Copy Unit, CopyUnitManager and DriveWizardPlus, access the following
site:
Europe: http://www.yaskawa.eu.com Peripheral Devices &
Options
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 315
8.4 Option Card Installation
<1> If two PG option cards are connected, use both CN5-B and CN5-C. If only one PG option card is connected to the drive, use the CN5-C
connector.
<2> These option cards are not available for the application with Motor 2 Selection.
<3> When DI-A3 is to be used as monitors, the card can be connected to any of CN5-A, CN5-B or CN5-C. The input status of DI-A3 can
then be viewed using U1-17.
Figure 8.2 shows an exploded view of the drive with the option and related components for reference.
Figure 8.2
L
A
K B
C
J
D
I
E
F
H
G
YEG
316 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.4 Option Card Installation
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not allow unqualified personnel to perform work on the drive. Failure to comply could result in
death or serious injury. Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar
with installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives and Option Cards.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the option, drive, and
circuit boards. Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to circuitry.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque. Failure to comply may cause the
application to operate incorrectly or damage the drive.
1. Shut off power to the drive, wait the appropriate amount of time for voltage to dissipate, then remove the digital
operator (E) and front covers (D, F). Refer to Digital Operator and Front Cover on page 57.
Figure 8.3
YEG
2. Insert the option card (B) into the CN5-A (J), CN5-B (K) or CN5-C (L) connectors located on the drive and fasten
it into place using one of the included screws (C).
Figure 8.4
YEG
A
B
C
L
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 317
8.4 Option Card Installation
3. Connect one end of the ground wire (H) to the ground terminal (I) using one of the remaining screws (C).
Connect the other end of the ground wire (H) to the remaining ground terminal and installation hole on the option
(B) using the last remaining provided screw (C).
Figure 8.5
YEG
B
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Tighten all terminal screws according to the specified tightening torque. Loose electrical connections could
result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating electrical connections. Tightening screws beyond the specified tightening
torque may result in erroneous operation, damage to the terminal block, or cause a fire.
NOTICE: Heat shrink tubing or electrical tape may be required to ensure that cable shielding does not contact other wiring. Insufficient
insulation may cause a short circuit and damage the option or drive.
Figure 8.6
Shield Insulation
Ground Terminal
FE/SD Shield sheath
B3 (Insulate with electrical tape
or shrink tubing)
Figure 8.6 Preparing Ends of Shielded Cable
Figure 8.7
318 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.4 Option Card Installation
5. For the PG-B3 and PG-X3 Option, wire the motor PG encoder to the terminal block. Refer to Figure 8.8 and
Figure 8.12 for wiring instructions.
Refer to Terminal Functions on page 320 for a detailed description of the option terminal functions.
R/L1 U/T1
S/L2 V/T2 M
T/L3 W/T3
YASKAWA TB1
Drive PGB3 3
A+
Option 4
A
5
B+
6 PG
B
Z+
Z
SD
NC
FE E
TB2
1
IP
IG 2
CN5 AO
IG A pulse monitor signal
Peripheral Devices &
BO
B pulse monitor signal
IG
ZO Z pulse monitor signal
FE IG
Options
Ground wire
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 319
8.4 Option Card Installation
Take the following steps to prevent erroneous operation caused by noise interference:
• Use shielded wire for the PG encoder signal lines.
• Limit the length of all motor output power cables to less than 100 m. Limit the length of open-collector output lines to
less than 50 m.
• Use separate conduit or cable tray dividers to separate option control wiring, main circuit input power wiring, and
motor output power cables.
Interface Circuit
• Complementary Output
Figure 8.8
AO,BO,ZO
Monitor Signals
IG
PGB3 IP Vcc
12 V PG Encoder
330 Ω A+,B+,Z+
470 Ω A,B,Z
A,B,Z
330 Ω
IG 0V
AO,BO,ZO
Monitor Signals
IG
• Signal level
B– B– pulse signal input
IP IG
TB1 H level: 8 to 12 V
Z+ Z+ pulse signal input L level: 2.0 V or less
Z– Z– pulse signal input
SD NC pin (open) For use when cables shields should not be grounded
AO IG BO IG ZO IG
<1> A separate UL-Listed class 2 power supply is necessary when the PG requires more than 200 mA to operate.
320 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.4 Option Card Installation
Crimp Terminals
Yaskawa recommends using CRIMPFOX 6 by Phoenix Contact or equivalent crimp terminals with the specifications
listed in Table 8.5 for wiring to ensure proper connections.
Note: Properly trim wire ends so loose wire ends do not extend from the crimp terminals.
Table 8.5 Crimp Terminal Sizes
Wire Gauge L d1 d2
mm2 Phoenix Contact Model mm mm mm
0.25 (24 AWG) AI 0.25 - 6YE 10.5 0.8 2
0.34 (22 AWG) AI 0.34 - 6TQ 10.5 0.8 2
d1 6 mm d2
L 0.5 (20 AWG) AI 0.5 - 6WH 14 1.1 2.5
TB1 TB2
A+ A- B+ B- Z+ Z- SD FE IP IG AO IG BO IG ZO IG
3 4 5 6 E 1 2
TA1 A G
B H F
PG encoder side
C E B3
D
L
(Pin)
IP 1 Blue C
IG 2 White H
A+ 3 Yellow B
A– 4 White G 8
B+ 5 Green A
B– 6 White F
FE E N/A (shield) D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 321
8.4 Option Card Installation
R/L1 U/T1
S/L2 V/T2 M
T/L3 W/T3
TB1
YASKAWA
Drive PGX3 A+
Option A
B+
PG
B
Z+
Z
SD
NC
FE
CN3
IP12 TB2
IP5 IP
IG IG
SG
CN5-B a+
A pulse monitor signal
or a
CN5-C b+
B pulse monitor signal
b
z+
Z pulse monitor signal
FE z
Ground wire
twisted-pair shielded line X3
main circuit terminal control circuit terminal
<1> Ground the shield on the PG side and the drive side. If noise problems arise in the PG signal, remove the shield ground from one end of the
signal line or remove the shield ground connection on both ends.
Figure 8.12 PG-X3 Option and PG Encoder Connection Diagram
Note: The PG-X3 Option reads a maximum input frequency from the PG of 300 kHz. Be sure to select a PG with an output pulse
frequency of maximum 300 kHz when operating at maximum speed.
322 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.4 Option Card Installation
Take the following steps to prevent erroneous operation caused by noise interference:
• Use shielded wire for the PG encoder signal lines.
• Use separate conduit or cable tray dividers to separate option control wiring, main circuit input power wiring, and
motor output power cables.
Interface Circuit
Figure 8.11
PGX3 PG Encoder
A+,B+,Z+ A,B,Z
600 Ω
A,B,Z
26LS32 level A,B,Z 26LS31 level
a+,b+,z+
a,b,z
Monitor Signals
26LS31 level SG
<1> A separate UL-Listed class 2 power supply is necessary when the PG requires more than 200 mA to operate.
Setting the PG Encoder Power Supply Voltage
For the PG-X3 Option, set the voltage for the PG encoder power supply using jumper CN3 located on the option.
NOTICE: The positioning of jumper CN3 selects the PG encoder power supply voltage (5.5 V or 12 V). Select the voltage level for the
PG encoder connected to the option and motor. If the wrong voltage is selected, the PG encoder may not operate properly or may
become damaged as a result.
Table 8.9 Setting the PG Encoder Power Supply Voltage (IP) with Jumper CN3
Voltage Level 5.5 V ± 5% (default) 12.0 V ± 5%
5.5 V 12 V 5.5 V 12 V
Peripheral Devices &
CN3 CN3
Jumper CN3
Options
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 323
8.4 Option Card Installation
Crimp Terminals
Yaskawa recommends using CRIMPFOX 6 by Phoenix Contact or equivalent crimp terminals with the specifications
listed in Table 8.11 for wiring to ensure proper connections.
Note: Properly trim wire ends so loose wire ends do not extend from the crimp terminals.
Table 8.11 Crimp Terminal Sizes
Wire Gauge L d1 d2
mm2 Phoenix Contact Model mm mm mm
0.25 (24 AWG) AI 0.25 - 6YE 10.5 0.8 2
0.34 (22 AWG) AI 0.34 - 6TQ 10.5 0.8 2
d1 6 mm d2
L 0.5 (20 AWG) AI 0.5 - 6WH 14 1.1 2.5
A – Route wires through the openings B – Use the open space provided
provided on the left side of the inside the drive to route option
front cover. <1> wiring.
(CIMR-L20008 through 20033 (CIMR-L20047 through 20415
and 40005 through 40018) and 40024 through 40216)
<1> The drive will not meet NEMA Type 1 requirements if wiring is exposed outside the enclosure.
Figure 8.14 Wire Routing Examples
324 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.4 Option Card Installation
7. Replace and secure the front covers of the drive (D, F) and replace the digital operator (E).
Figure 8.13
YEG
D
8. For the PG-B3 and PG-X3 Option, set drive parameters A1-02: Control Method Selection on page 145 and
F1: PG Speed Control Card on page 355 for proper motor rotation.
With a two-pulse or three-pulse PG encoder, the leading pulse determines the motor rotation direction. A PG
encoder signal with leading A pulse is considered to be rotating forward (counter-clockwise when viewing
rotation from motor load side).
Figure 8.14
A pulse
B pulse
Time →
Figure 8.16 Displacement of A and B Pulses
After connecting the PG encoder outputs to the option, apply power to the drive and manually rotate the motor
and check the rotation direction by viewing monitor U1-05 on the digital operator.
Reverse motor rotation is indicated by a negative value for U1-05; forward motor rotation is indicated by a
positive value.
If monitor U1-05 indicates that the forward direction is opposite of what is intended, set F1-05 to 1, or reverse the
two A pulse wires with the two B pulse wires on option terminal TB1 as shown in Figure 8.17.
Figure 8.15
B3
A+ A- B+ B- Z+ Z- A+ A- B+ B- Z+ Z-
factory default and the parameter will need to be adjusted again to switch the direction.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 325
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
Note: The braking circuit must be sized properly in order to dissipate the power required to decelerate the load in the desired time.
Ensure that the braking circuit can dissipate the energy for the set deceleration time prior to running the drive.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. The braking resistor connection terminals are B1 and B2. Do not connect a braking resistor directly to any
other terminals. Improper wiring connections could result in death or serious injury by fire. Failure to comply may result in damage to
the braking circuit or drive.
NOTICE: Connect braking circuits to the drive as shown in the I/O wiring examples. Improperly wiring braking circuits could result in
damage to the drive or equipment.
Always use braking resistors equipped with a thermal overload relay contact, and utilize this contact to switch off the
drive in case of braking resistor overheat. When connecting the braking resistors to the drive internal braking transistor,
make sure the braking transistor will not be overloaded with the required duty cycle and the selected resistance value.
? Installing a Braking Unit: CDBR Type
When using a CDBR braking unit or any other external braking transistor or a regenerative converter, disable the internal
braking transistor protection function by setting parameter L8-55 to 0.
To install a CDBR type braking unit, connect either the B1 terminal of the drive (CIMR-L20008 through 20115
and 40005 through 40060) or +3 terminal of the drive (units CIMR-L20008 through 20145 and 20415 and
40075 to 40260) to the positive terminal on the braking unit. Then, wire the negative terminals on the drive and
braking unit together. Terminal +2 is not used.
Connect the braking resistor to CDBR terminals +0 and -0.
Wire the thermal overload relay contact of the CDBR and the braking resistor in series, and connect this signal to a drive
digital input. Use this input to trigger a fault in the drive in case a CDBR or braking resistor overload occurs.
Disable dynamic braking transistor protection by setting L8-55 = 0.
Note: To install a CDBR type braking unit to the drive with built-in dynamic braking transistor (CIMR-L20008 through 20115
and 40005 through 40060), connect the drive’s B1 terminal to the positive terminal on the braking unit. Next wire the
negative terminals on the drive and braking unit together. Terminal B2 is not used.
326 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
Figure 8.16
Braking Unit
(CDBR type) Braking Resistor
+3 + +0
Thermal Overload
Drive Trip Contact
− − −0
3 4
YEG
Thermal
Trip Contact
Figure 8.18 Connecting a Braking Unit (CDBR type) and Braking Resistor Unit
(CIMR-L20145 to 20415 and L40075 to 40216)
+3 −
Braking Braking Braking
Resistor Resistor Resistor
− + +0 −0 − + +0 −0 − + +0 −0
MASTER MASTER
Level Detector
MASTER
Drive
SLAVE
+15 SLAVE SLAVE
1 5 1 5 1 5
6 2 6 2 6
2
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 327
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
A MCCB MC
R/L1
S/L2
T/L3 Common_
MC
MB TMonly
C MC
MC
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Switch off and lock power supply and lock the switch before wiring terminals. Failure to comply
could result in serious injury or death.
? Installing a Residual Current Device (RCD) or a Residual Current Monitoring Device (RCM)
Residual currents occurring in drive installations can contain AC, DC, and high frequency components that may prevent
a normal RCD/RCM from operating as desired. If an RCD/RCM is required in the installation, always use an all-current-
sensitive device (Type B according to IEC/EN 60755) to ensure proper ground fault interruption.
Leakage currents generated by the drive during normal operation may trip an RCD or RCM even if a ground fault is not
present.
Factors that influence the leakage current are:
• Size of the AC drive
• AC drive carrier frequency
• Motor cable type and length
• EMI/RFI filter
If the RCD/RCM trips spuriously consider changing these items or use an RCD/RCM with a higher trip level.
Note: Choose a RCD/RCM designed specifically for an AC drive. The operation time should be at least 0.1 s with sensitivity amperage
of at least 200 mA per drive. The output waveform of the drive may cause an increase in leakage current. This may in turn cause
the leakage breaker to malfunction. Increase the sensitivity amperage or lower the carrier frequency to correct the problem.
328 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
NOTICE: Install an MC on the input side of the drive when the drive should not automatically restart after power loss. To get the full
performance life out of the electrolytic capacitors and circuit relays, refrain from switching the drive power supply off and on more than
once every 30 minutes. Frequent use can damage the drive. Use the drive to stop and start the motor.
NOTICE: Use a magnetic contactor (MC) to ensure that power to the drive can be completely shut off when necessary. The MC should
be wired so that it opens when a fault output terminal is triggered.
Note: 1. Install an MC to the drive input side to prevent the drive from restarting automatically when power is restored after momentary
power loss.
2. Set up a delay that prevents the MC from opening prematurely to continue operating the drive through a momentary power loss.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Confirm an actual motor overload condition is not present prior to increasing the thermal oL trip detection
setting. Check local electrical codes before making adjustments to motor thermal overload settings. Failure to comply can result in
death or serious injury by fire.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 329
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
Connecting an AC or DC Reactor
? Reactor Placement
When connecting to a power supply transformer with greater than 600 kVA capacity, or when switching a phase advance
capacitor, large peak current can flow through the input power supply circuit and damage converter components in the
drive.
As a preventive measure, install an AC or DC reactor to the input side of the drive. Installing an AC or DC reactor will
also help improve the power factor.
Install an AC or DC reactor if a DC drive or another type of thyristor converter is running from the same power system,
regardless of the power supply conditions shown in Figure 8.21.
Note: A DC reactor is built in to the drive models CIMR-L20085 to 20415 and 40045 to 40216.
Figure 8.19
4000
0 60 400
Drive Capacity (kVA)
Figure 8.21 Installing a Reactor
? Connecting an AC Reactor
Figure 8.20
C D
A B
U X R/L1
V
W
Y
Z
S/L2
T/L3
Common_
TMonly
? Connecting a DC Reactor
A DC reactor can be installed to drive models CIMR-L20008 to 20075 and 40005 to 40039. When installing a
DC reactor, remove the jumper between terminals +1 and +2 (terminals are jumpered for shipment). The jumper must be
installed if not using a DC reactor. Refer to Figure 8.23 for an example of DC reactor wiring.
Figure 8.21
C
A B
R/L1
S/L2
T/L3
+1 +2
Common_
TMonly
D
330 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
A
C D E
B MCCB F G
R/L1 U/T1
S/L2 V/T2 M
T/L3 W/T3
H
I
YEG
J
A – Metal enclosure F – Shielded motor cable
B – Power supply G – Motor
C – Input noise filter H – Separate at least 30 cm
D – Drive I – Control signal lines
E – Output noise filter J – Controller
Figure 8.24 Reducing Radio Frequency Noise
B C
MCCB
A
Peripheral Devices &
R U R/L1
S/L2
S V
T/L3
T W
E
Options
MCCB
8
YEG
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 331
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
B C
A MCCB D
R/L1 U/T1 1 4
S/L2 V/T2 2 5 M
T/L3 W/T3 3 6
YEG
332 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 333
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
334 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Appendix: A
Specifications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 335
A.1 Three-Phase 200 V Class Drives
<1> The motor capacity (kW) refers to a Yaskawa 4-pole motor. The rated output current of the drive output amps should be equal to or greater than
the motor rated current. Select the appropriate capacity drive if operating the motor continuously above motor nameplate current.
<2> Assumes operation at the rated output current. Input current rating varies depending on the power supply transformer, input reactor, wiring
connections, and power supply impedance.
<3> DC is not available for UL standards.
<4> Rated motor capacity is calculated with a rated output voltage of 220 V.
<5> Carrier frequency can be set up to 8 kHz while keeping this current rating. Higher carrier frequency settings require derating.
<6> Carrier frequency can be set up to 5 kHz while keeping this current rating. Higher carrier frequency settings require derating.
336 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
A.2 Three-Phase 400 V Class Drives
<1> The motor capacity (kW) refers to a Yaskawa 4-pole motor. The rated output current of the drive output amps should be equal to or greater than
the motor rated current. Select the appropriate capacity drive if operating the motor continuously above motor nameplate current.
<2> Assumes operation at the rated output current. Input current rating varies depending on the power supply transformer, input reactor, wiring
conditions, and power supply impedance.
<3> DC is not available for UL standards.
<4> Rated motor capacity is calculated with a rated output voltage of 440 V.
<5> Carrier frequency can be set up to 8 kHz while keeping this current rating. Higher carrier frequency settings require derating.
<6> Carrier frequency can be set up to 5 kHz while keeping this current rating. Higher carrier frequency settings require derating.
Specifications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 337
A.3 Drive Specifications
Item Specification
The following control methods can be set using drive parameters:
• V/f Control (V/f)
Control Method • Open Loop Vector Control (OLV)
• Closed Loop Vector Control (CLV)
• Closed Loop Vector Control for PM (CLV/PM)
Frequency Control Range 0.01 to 200 Hz
Frequency Accuracy Digital input: within ±0.01% of the max output speed (-10 to +40°C)
(Temperature Fluctuation) Analog input: within ±0.1% of the max output speed (25 ±10°C)
Digital inputs: 0.01 Hz
Frequency Setting Resolution
Analog inputs: 1/2048 of the maximum output speed setting (11 bit plus sign)
Output Speed Resolution 0.001 Hz
Frequency Setting Signal Main speed frequency reference: DC -10 to +10 V (20 k), DC 0 to +10 V (20 k), 4 to 20 mA (250 ), 0 to 20 mA (250 )
V/f: 150% at 3 Hz
Starting Torque <1> OLV: 200% at 0.3 Hz
CLV, CLV/PM: 200% at 0 r/min
V/f: 1:40
Control Speed Control Range <1> OLV: 1:200
Characteristics CLV, CLV/PM: 1:1500
OLV: 0.2% (25 ±10°C)
Speed Control Accuracy <1>
CLV: 0.02% (25 ±10°C)
OLV: 10 Hz (25 ±10°C)
Speed Response <1> CLV: 100 Hz <2>
CLV/PM: 100 Hz <2>
Torque Limit Parameters setting allow separate limits in four quadrants (available in OLV, CLV, CLV/PM)
0.0 to 6000.0 s (4 selectable combinations of independent acceleration and deceleration settings, unit changeable to m/s2 or
Accel/Decel Ramp
ft/s2)
Braking Transistor Models CIMR-L20008 to 20115, 40005 to 40060 have a built-in braking transistor.
V/f Characteristics Freely programmable
Inertia Compensation, Position Lock at Start and Stop/Anti-Rollback Function, Overtorque/Undertorque Detection, Torque
Limit, Speed Reference, Accel/decel Switch, 5 Zone Jerk Settings, Auto-Tuning (Stationary and Rotational Motor/Encoder
Offset Tuning), Dwell, Cooling Fan on/off Switch, Slip Compensation, Torque Compensation, DC Injection Braking at Start and
Main Control Functions
Stop, MEMOBUS/Modbus Comm. (RS-422/485 max, 115.2 kbps), Fault Reset, Removable Terminal Block with Parameter
Backup Function, Online Tuning, High Frequency Injection, Short Floor, Rescue Operation (Light Load Direction Search
Function), Inspection Run, Brake Sequence, Speed related parameters with elevator units display, etc.
Motor Protection Electronic thermal overload relay
Momentary Overcurrent Protection Drive stops when output current exceeds 200% of rated output current
Overload Protection Drive stops after 60 s at 150% of rated output current <3>
200 V class: Stops when DC bus voltage exceeds approx. 410 V
Overvoltage Protection
400 V class: Stops when DC bus voltage exceeds approx. 820 V
Protection
200 V class: Stops when DC bus voltage falls below approx. 190 V
Functions Undervoltage Protection
400 V class: Stops when DC bus voltage falls below approx. 380 V
Heatsink Overheat Protection Thermistor
Stall Prevention Stall Prevention is available during acceleration, and during run.
Ground Protection Electronic circuit protection <4>
DC Bus Charge LED Remains lit until DC bus voltage falls below 50 V
Area of Use Indoors
Ambient Temperature IP20 enclosure: -10 to +50C
Humidity 95 RH% or less (no condensation)
<1> The accuracy of these values depends on motor characteristics, ambient conditions, and drive settings. Specifications may vary with different
motors and with changing motor temperature. Contact Yaskawa for consultation.
<2> For drives with B or earlier as the design revision order, 50 Hz is required. The design revision order and software version are printed on the
nameplate affixed to the side of the drive. Refer to Model Number on page 28 for details.
<3> Overload protection may be triggered when operating with 150% of the rated output current if the output speed is less than 6 Hz.
<4> Ground protection cannot be provided when the impedance of the ground fault path is too low, or when the drive is powered up while a ground
fault is present at the output.
338 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
A.4 Drive Watt Loss Data
<1> These values assume the carrier frequency is set to 8 kHz or less.
<2> These values assume the carrier frequency is set to 5 kHz or less.
<1> These values assume the carrier frequency is set to 8 kHz or less.
<2> These values assume the carrier frequency is set to 5 kHz or less.
Specifications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 339
A.5 Drive Derating Data
340 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
A.5 Drive Derating Data
20008 to 20060
Common_
TMonly
0 8 kHz 15 kHz
20145 to 20415
Drive Rated
YEG
0 5 kHz 10 kHz
Common_
TMonly
0 8 kHz 15 kHz
40112 to 40216
Drive Rated
Specifications
YEG
A
0 5 kHz 10 kHz
Figure A.4 Carrier Frequency Derating (CIMR-L40112 to 40216)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 341
A.5 Drive Derating Data
Temperature Derating
To ensure the maximum performance life, the drives output current must be derated when the drive is installed in areas
with high ambient temperature. In order to ensure reliable drive overload protection, the parameters L8-12 and L8-35
must also be set according to the installation conditions.
Parameter Settings
IP20 Enclosure
Drive operation between -10C and 50C allows 100% continuous current without derating.
Altitude Derating
The drive standard ratings are valid for an installation altitude up to 1000 m. If the altitude exceeds 1000 m both the drive
rated voltage and the rated output current must be derated for 1% per 100 m. The maximum altitude is 3000 m.
342 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Appendix: B
Parameter List
This appendix contains a full listing of all parameters and settings available in the drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 343
B.1 Understanding the Parameter Table
V/f Parameter is available when operating the drive with V/f Control.
OLV Parameter is available when operating the drive with Open Loop Vector.
CLV Parameter is available when operating the drive with Closed Loop Vector.
CLV/PM Parameter is available when operating the drive with Closed Loop Vector for PM motors.
Motor 2 Refers to a second motor when the drive is operating two motors. Switch between these motors using the multi-function input terminals.
Note: If a parameter is not available in a certain control mode, the symbol for that control mode is grayed out.
344 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.2 Parameter Groups
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 345
B.3 Parameter Table
0: English
1: Japanese
2: German
3: French
4: Italian
A1-00 5: Spanish
(100H) 6: Portuguese Default: 0
Language Selection 7: Chinese Min: 0 144
8: Czech Max: 12
<1> 9: Russian
10: Turkish
11: Polish
12: Greek
Note: 1. Language selection settings 8 to 12 can be selected from an LCD operator with version
(REV) F or later. The version number of the LCD operator's PRG software is shown on
the back of the digital operator.
2. Language selection settings 8 to 12 are available in drive software PRG: 7017 or later.
common_
A1-01 All Modes TMonly Default: 2
(101H)
Access Level Selection 0: View and set A1-01 and A1-04. U- parameters can also be viewed. Min: 0 144
1: User Parameters (access to a set of parameters selected by the user, A2-01 to A2-32) Max: 2
2: Advanced Access (access to view and set all parameters)
common_
All Modes TMonly
A1-02 Default: 0
0: V/f Control
(102H) Control Method Selection Min: 0 145
2: Open Loop Vector Control
<1> Max: 7
3: Closed Loop Vector Control
7: Closed Loop Vector Control for PM Motors
common_
All Modes TMonly
Default: 0
A1-03 0: No initialization
Initialize Parameters Min: 0 145
(103H) 1110: User Initialize (parameter values must be stored using parameter o2-03)
Max: 5550
2220: 2-wire initialization
5550: oPE04 error reset
A1-04
Password common_
Default: 0000
(104H) All Modes TMonly
Min: 0000 146
A1-05 When the value set into A1-04 does not match the value set into A1-05, parameters A1-01
Password Setting Max: 9999
(105H) through A1-03, and A2-01 through A2-33 cannot be changed.
<1> Parameter setting value is not reset to the default value when the drive is initialized.
346 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
b: Application
Application parameters configure the source of the Up/Down command, timer functions, the Dwell function, the Droop
Control function, Energy Savings, and a variety of other application-related settings.
b1: Operation Mode Selection
common_
(1B7H) All Modes TMonly Max: 10.0 s
Parameters b6-01 and b6-02 set the speed to hold and the time to maintain that speed at start. Default: 0.0%
b6-03 Parameters b6-03 and b6-04 set the speed to hold and the time to maintain that speed at stop.
Dwell Speed at Stop Min: 0.0% 153
(1B8H)
Max: 100.0%
Default: 0.0 s
b6-04
Dwell Time at Stop Min: 0.0 s 153
(1B9H)
Max: 10.0 s
B
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 347
B.3 Parameter Table
C: Tuning
C parameters are used to adjust the acceleration and deceleration ramps, jerk settings, slip compensation, torque
compensation, and carrier frequency selections.
C1: Acceleration and Deceleration Ramps
C1-02
common_
(201H) All Modes TMonly
Deceleration Ramp 1 155
Sets the ramp to decelerate from maximum speed to 0.
C1-03
common_
(202H) All Modes TMonly
Acceleration Ramp 2 155
Sets the ramp to accelerate from 0 to maximum speed.
C1-04
common_
(203H) All Modes TMonly
Deceleration Ramp 2 155
Sets the ramp to decelerate from maximum speed to 0.
C1-06
common_
(205H) Deceleration Ramp 3 (Motor 2 All Modes TMonly 155
Decel Time 1)
Sets the ramp to decelerate from maximum speed to 0.
C1-07
common_
(206H) Acceleration Ramp 4 (Motor 2 All Modes TMonly 155
Accel Time 2)
Sets the ramp to accelerate from 0 to maximum speed.
C1-08
common_
(207H) Deceleration Ramp 4 (Motor 2 All Modes TMonly 155
Decel Time 2)
Sets the ramp to decelerate from maximum speed to 0.
common_
C1-09 All Modes TMonly
Emergency Stop Ramp 156
(208H)
Sets the ramp for the Emergency Stop function.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
C1-10
Accel/Decel Setting Resolution Min: 0 157
(209H) 0: 0.01 s unit
Max: 1
1: 0.1 s unit
common_ Default: 0.0%
C1-11 All Modes TMonly
Accel/Decel Switching Speed Min: 0.0% 156
(20AH)
Sets the speed to switch between accel/decel ramp settings. Max: 100.0%
348 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
<6> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03.
Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection (o1-03) on page 389.
<8> Setting range value is dependent on parameter C1-10, Accel/Decel Setting Resolution. When C1-10 = 0 (units of 0.01 seconds), the setting
range becomes 0.00 to 600.00 seconds.
<6> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03.
Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection (o1-03) on page 389.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 200%
C3-03
Slip Compensation Limit Min: 0% 158
(211H) Sets an upper limit for the slip compensation function as a percentage of motor rated slip for
Max: 250%
motor 1 (E2-02).
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Default: 0
C3-04 Slip Compensation Selection
0: Disabled. Min: 0 158
(212H) during Regeneration
1: Enabled above 6 Hz. Max: 2
2: Enabled whenever slip compensation is possible.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Default: <5>
C3-05 Output Voltage Limit Operation 0: Disabled.
Min: 0 159
(213H) Selection 1: Enabled. Automatically decreases motor flux when output voltage saturation is reached.
Max: 1
Note: Available control modes for parameter C3-05 vary by drive model: Models CIMR-
L20008 to 20415, 40005 to 40216: Available when A1-02 = 2, 3
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 349
B.3 Parameter Table
C5-02
common_ Default: <5>
(21CH) Speed Control Loop Integral Time V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0.000 s 162
1
Sets the integral time 1 of the speed control loop. Max: 10.000 s
C5-03
common_ Default: <5>
(21DH) Speed Control Loop Proportional V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0.00 162
Gain 2
Sets the proportional gain 2 of the speed control loop. Max: 300.00
C5-04
common_ Default: 0.500 s
(21EH) Speed Control Loop Integral Time V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0.000 s 162
2
Sets the integral time 2 of the speed control loop. Max: 10.000 s
C5-14
common_ Default: <5>
(273H) Speed Control Loop Integral Time V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0.000 s 162
3
Sets the integral time 3 of the speed control loop. Max: 10.000 s
C5-20
common_ Default:0.100 s
(275H) Speed Control Loop Integral Time V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Min: 0.000 s 163
during Position Lock
Sets the Speed Control Loop Integral time used during Position Lock. Max: 10.000 s
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
C5-50 Sets the mechanical vibration filter frequency in units of 1 Hz. Default: 0 Hz
(B14H) Set Vibrational Frequency Filter Note: Set C5-50 to 0 (Hz) to disable the filter. The frequencies from 1 to 19 Hz cannot be set. Min: 20 Hz 163
<45> Test equipment may be required to determine the mechanical resonance frequency. Setting C5- Max: 1000 Hz
50 to an improper frequency will result in ineffective filtering of the effects of mechanical
resonance.
350 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
d: Speed References
Speed Reference parameters are used to set the various speed reference values during operation.
d1: Speed Reference
d1-02
(281H)
Speed Reference 2 165
d1-03
(282H)
Speed Reference 3 165
d1-04
(283H)
Speed Reference 4 165
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.00% <6>
Min: 0.00%
d1-05 Sets the Speed reference for the drive when d1-18 is set to 0 or 3. Setting units are determined
Max: 100.00% <6>
(284H) by parameter o1-03.
Speed Reference 5 165
d1-06
(285H)
Speed Reference 6 165
d1-07
(286H)
Parameter List
d1-08
(287H)
Speed Reference 8 165
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 351
B.3 Parameter Table
d1-20
common_ Default: 0.00% <6>
(2C2H) All Modes TMonly
Intermediate Speed 1 Min: 0.00% 166
Sets intermediate speed reference 1 when d1-18 = 1 or 2. Max: 100.00% <6>
d1-21
common_ Default: 0.00% <6>
(2C3H) All Modes TMonly
Intermediate Speed 2 Min: 0.00% 166
Sets intermediate speed reference 2 when d1-18 = 1 or 2. Max: 100.00% <6>
d1-22
common_ Default: 0.00% <6>
(2C4H) All Modes TMonly
Intermediate Speed 3 Min: 0.00% 166
Sets intermediate speed reference 3 when d1-18 = 1 or 3. Max: 100.00% <6>
d1-23
common_ Default: 0.00% <6>
(2C5H) All Modes TMonly
Releveling Speed Min: 0.00% 166
Sets speed reference for releveling when d1-18 = 1 or 2. Max: 100.00% <6>
d1-24
common_ Default: 50.00% <6>
(2C6H) All Modes TMonly
Inspection Operation Speed Min: 0.00% 166
Sets speed reference when inspection operation is enabled. Max: 100.00% <6>
d1-25
common_ Default: 10.00% <6>
(2C7H) All Modes TMonly
Rescue Operation Speed Min: 0.00% 166
Sets the speed reference during inspection operation. Max: 100.00% <6>
d1-26
common_ Default: 8.00% <6>
(2C8H) All Modes TMonly
Leveling Speed Min: 0.00% 166
Sets leveling speed reference when d1-18 = 1 or 2. Max: 100.00% <6>
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Default: 0.00 Hz
d1-27 Sets the speed reference for motor 2.
Motor 2 Speed Reference Min: 0.00 Hz 167
(2C9H) Note: 1. If set to 0.00, the drive will control motor 1 instead.
Max: 200.00 Hz
2. When using motor 2, be sure that the accel/decel times are set in parameters C1-12
and C1-13.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.0%
d1-28
Leveling Speed Detection Level Min: 0.0% 167
(2CAH) Used when d1-18 = 0 or 3. If the speed reference selected is lower than d1-28, then the drive
Max: 100.0%
uses the leveling speed as the speed reference.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.0%
d1-29
Inspection Speed Detection Level Min: 0.0% 167
(2CBH) Used when d1-18 = 0 or 3. If the speed reference selected is higher than d1-28 but lower or
Max: 100.0%
equal to d1-29, then the drive uses inspection speed as the speed reference.
<6> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03.
Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection (o1-03) on page 389.
352 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
E: Motor Parameters
E1: V/f Pattern
<2> Default setting is dependent on the control mode (A1-02) and the drive model (o2-04).
<5> Default setting is determined by the control mode (A1-02).
<9> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. Double the value when using a 400 V class drive.
<11> Parameter is ignored when E1-11 and E1-12 are set to 0.0.
<13> When E1-13 (Base Voltage) is set to 0.0, output voltage is controlled with E1-05 (Maximum Voltage) = E1-13. When Auto-Tuning is
performed, E1-05 and E1-13 are automatically set to the same value.
<23> Setting range depends on the type of motor being used. CLV allows a setting range of 10.0 to 200.0 Hz, while CLV/PM allows a setting range
of 4.0 to 200.0 Hz.
common_ Default: 4
E2-04 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Number of Motor Poles Min: 2 170
(311H)
Sets the number of motor poles. Automatically set during Auto-Tuning. Max: 48
common_ Default: <4>
E2-05 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM
Motor Line-to-Line Resistance TMonly
Min: 0.000 170
(312H)
Sets the phase-to-phase motor resistance. Automatically set during Auto-Tuning. Max: 65.000
E2-06
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM
common_
TMonly Default: <4> B
Motor Leakage Inductance Min: 0.0% 170
(313H) Sets the voltage drop due to motor leakage inductance as a percentage of motor rated voltage.
Max: 40.0%
Automatically set during Auto-Tuning.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 353
B.3 Parameter Table
354 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Default: <4>
E5-03 common_ Min: 10% of drive rated
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
(32BH) Motor Rated Current current 174
<1> Sets the motor rated current. Max: 200% of drive
rated current <10>
<1> Parameter setting value is not reset to the default value when the drive is initialized.
<4> Default setting value is determined by the drive model (o2-04).
<10> The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L20008 to 20033 and 40005 to 40018
display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L20047 to 20415 and 40024 to 40216 display values in 0.1 A units.
<43> When PG-E3 option connected: Max setting = 48
F: Option Settings
F parameters are used to program the drive for Encoder and PG feedback from the motor and to function with option
cards.
F1: PG Speed Control Card
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 355
B.3 Parameter Table
F1-52 Selects the communication speed between the PG-F3 option and serial encoder. Default: 0
Communication Speed of Serial
(3D4H) 0: 1M bps/9600 bps Min: 0 179
Encoder Selection
<39> 1: 500k bps/19200 bps Max: 3
2: 1M bps/38400 bps
3: 1M bps/38400 bps
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 0
F1-63
PG-E3 R Track Selection Min: 0 179
(2DFH) 0: Disabled
Max: 1
1: Enabled
F1-66 to common_
F1-81 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 0
(B9AH to Encoder Adjust 1 to 16 Min: 0 179
Sets encoder offsets 1 to 16 for the PG-E3 option card. These parameters are automatically set
BA9H) Max: FFFF
by the execution of Auto-Tuning of PG-E3 encoder characteristics.
<44>
356 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
0: BCD, 1% units
1: BCD, 0.1% units
2: BCD, 0.01% units
3: BCD, 1 Hz units
4: BCD, 0.1 Hz units
Default: 0
F3-01 5: BCD, 0.01 Hz units
DI-A3 Option Card Input Selection Min: 0 179
(390H) 6: BCD customized setting (5 digit), 0.02 Hz units
Max: 7
7: Binary input
The unit and the setting range are determined by F3-03.
F3-03 = 0: 255/100% (-255 to +255)
F3-03 = 1: 40961/100% (-4095 to +4095)
F3-03 = 2: 30000/100% (-33000 to +33000)
When the digital operator units are set to be displayed in Hertz or user-set units (o1-03 = 2 or 3),
the units for F3-01 are determined by parameter o1-03.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 2
F3-03 DI-A3 Option Card Data Length
0: 8 bit Min: 0 180
(3B9H) Selection
1: 12 bit Max: 2
2: 16 bit
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 103
F4-03
Terminal V2 Function Selection Min: 000 180
(393H) Sets the monitor signal for output from terminal V2. Set this parameter to the last three digits of
Max: 999
the desired U- monitor. Some U parameters are available only in certain control modes.
F4-04
common_ Default: 50.0%
(394H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal V2 Gain Min: -999.9% 180
Sets the gain for voltage output via terminal V2. Max: 999.9%
F4-05
common_ Default: 0.0%
(395H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal V1 Bias Min: -999.9% 180
Sets the amount of bias added to the voltage output via terminal V1. Max: 999.9%
F4-06
common_ Default: 0.0%
(396H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal V2 Bias Min: -999.9% 180
Sets the amount of bias added to the voltage output via terminal V2. Max: 999.9%
Default: 1
F4-07 Terminal V1 Signal Level
common_ Min: 0 181
(397H) Selection All Modes TMonly Max: 1
0: 0 to 10 V Default: 1
F4-08 Terminal V2 Signal Level 1: -10 to 10 V Min: 0 181
(398H) Selection
Max: 1
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 357
B.3 Parameter Table
0: Auto-detection
1: 10 kbps
2: 20 kbps Default: 6
F6-36
CANopen Communication Speed 3: 50 kbps Min: 0 –
(3D1H)
4: 125 kbps Max: 8
5: 250 kbps
6: 500 kbps
7: 800 kbps
8: 1 Mbps
<1> Parameter setting value is not reset to the default value when the drive is initialized.
358 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
H: Multi-Function Terminals
H parameters assign functions to the multi-function input and output terminals.
H1: Multi-Function Digital Inputs
<19> With the speed reference priority d1-18 is set to 0 or 3, the default settings for parameters H1-03 to H1-07 governing input terminals S3 to S7
are: 24, 14, 3, 4, and 5 respectively. When d1-18 is set to 1 or 2, the default settings for H1-03 to H1-07 become 50, 54, 51, 53, and F
respectively.
6 Jog reference selection Closed: Jog frequency reference (d1-17) selected. 183
The Jog frequency can be used when the speed reference selection is not assigned to input terminals (b1-01 1)
and the speed reference priority is set to use the multi-step speed reference (d1-18 = 0 or 3).
common_
All Modes TMonly
7 Accel/decel Ramp Selection 1 Used to switch between accel/decel ramp 1 (set in C1-01, C1-02) and accel/decel ramp 2 (set in C1-03, C1-04). 184
When combined with another input terminal set for "Accel/Decel ramp 2" (H1- = 1A), the drive can also
switch between accel/decel ramp 3 (set in C1-05, C1-06) and accel/decel ramp 4 (set in C1-07, C1-08).
common_
All Modes TMonly
8 Baseblock Command (N.O.) 184
Closed: No drive output
common_
All Modes TMonly
9 Baseblock Command (N.C.) 184
Open: No drive output
common_
All Modes TMonly
F Not Used (Through Mode) 184
Select this setting when the terminal is not used or when using the terminal in the pass-through mode. The terminal
does not trigger a drive function but can be used as digital input for the controller the drive is connected to.
common_
All Modes TMonly
14 Fault Reset 184
Closed: Resets faults if the cause is cleared and the Up/Down command is removed.
common_
All Modes TMonly
15 Emergency Stop (N.O.) 184
Closed: Decelerates to stop at the Emergency Stop ramp set to C1-09.
common_
All Modes TMonly
16 Motor 2 Selection 185
Open: Motor 1(E1-, E3-)
Closed: Motor 2 (E2-, E4-)
Parameter List
common_
All Modes TMonly
17 Emergency Stop (N.C.) 184
Open: Decelerates to stop at the Emergency Stop ramp set to C1-09.
common_
All Modes TMonly
18 Timer Function Input 185
Triggers the timer set up by parameters b4-01 and b4-02. Must be set in conjunction with the timer function output
(H2- = 12).
common_
B
All Modes TMonly
1A Accel/decel Ramp Selection 2 185
Used in conjunction with an input terminal set for “Accel/decel ramp selection 1” (H1- = 7), and allows the
drive to switch between accel/decel ramp 3 and 4.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 359
B.3 Parameter Table
360 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Open: Output speed is greater than the value of E1-09 (Minimum Output Frequency) or S1-01 (Zero Speed Level at
1 Zero Speed 188
Stop).
Closed: Output frequency is less than or equal to the value of E1-09 (Minimum Output Frequency) or S1-01 (Zero
Speed Level at Stop).
common_
All Modes TMonly
2 Speed Agree 1 188
Closed: Output speed equals the speed reference (plus or minus the hysteresis set to L4-02).
common_
All Modes TMonly
3 User-set Speed Agree 1 189
Closed: Output speed and speed reference equal L4-01 (plus or minus the hysteresis set to L4-02).
common_
All Modes TMonly
4 Speed Detection 1 189
Closed: Output speed is less than or equal to the value in L4-01 with hysteresis determined by L4-02.
common_
All Modes TMonly
5 Speed Detection 2 189
Closed: Output speed is greater than or equal to the value in L4-01 with hysteresis determined by L4-02.
common_
All Modes TMonly
6 Drive Ready (READY) 190
Closed: Power up is complete and the drive is ready to accept an Up/Down command.
common_
All Modes TMonly
7 DC Bus Undervoltage 190
Closed: DC bus voltage is below the Uv trip level set in L2-05.
common_
All Modes TMonly
8 During Baseblock (N.O.) 190
Closed: Drive has entered the baseblock state (no output voltage).
common_
All Modes TMonly
9 Speed Reference Source 190
Open: The speed reference is supplied by an external reference (set in b1-01).
Closed: Digital operator supplies the speed reference.
common_
All Modes TMonly
A Up/Down Command Source 190
Open: The Up/Down command is supplied by an external reference (set in b1-02).
Closed: Digital operator supplies the Up/Down command.
common_
B Torque Detection 1 All Modes TMonly 191
Closed: An overtorque or undertorque situation has been detected.
common_
All Modes TMonly
E Fault 191
Closed: Fault occurred. (excluding CPF00 and CPF01)
common_
All Modes TMonly
F Not used (Through Mode) 191
Parameter List
Set this value when the terminal is not used or when using the terminal in the pass-through mode.
common_
All Modes TMonly
10 Minor Fault 191
Closed: An alarm has been triggered, or the IGBTs have reached 90% of their expected life span.
common_
All Modes TMonly
11 Fault Reset Command Active 191
Closed: The drive has received a reset command from the multi-function input terminals or from serial network, or the
digital operator’s RESET key has been pressed. B
common_
All Modes TMonly
12 Timer Output 191
Closed: Timer output.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 361
B.3 Parameter Table
362 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
H3-04
common_ Default: 0.0%
(412H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal A1 Bias Setting Min: -999.9% 196
Sets the level of the input value selected in H3-02 when 0 V is input at terminal A1. Max: 999.9%
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
H3-09 Terminal A2 Signal Level
0: 0 to 10 V Min: 0 197
(417H) Selection
1: -10 to 10 V Max: 0
Note: Use DIP switch S1 to set input terminal A2 for a current or a voltage input signal.
common_ Default: 0
H3-10 All Modes TMonly
Terminal A2 Function Selection Min: 0 197
(418H)
Sets the function of terminal A2. Max: 1F
H3-11
common_ Default: 100.0%
(419H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal A2 Gain Setting Min: -999.9% 197
Sets the level of the input value selected in H3-10 when 10 V is input at terminal A2. Max: 999.9%
H3-12
common_ Default: 0.0%
(41AH) All Modes TMonly
Terminal A2 Bias Setting Min: -999.9% 197
Sets the level of the input value selected in H3-10 when 0 V is input at terminal A2. Max: 999.9%
(2F1H)
Applies an offset to analog input A2. Can be used for zero adjustment of the analog input. Max: 500
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 363
B.3 Parameter Table
H4-03
common_ Default: 0.0%
(41FH) All Modes TMonly
Terminal FM Bias Min: -999.9% 199
Sets the signal level at terminal FM that is equal to 0% of the selected monitor value. Max: 999.9%
common_
All Modes TMonly
Default: 103
H4-04
Terminal AM Monitor Selection Selects the data to be output through multi-function analog output terminal AM. Min: 000 199
(420H)
Set the desired monitor parameter to the digits available in U-. For example, enter “103” Max: 999
for U1-03.
H4-05
common_ Default: 50.0%
(421H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal AM Gain Min: -999.9% 199
Sets the signal level at terminal AM that is equal to 100% of the selected monitor value. Max: 999.9%
H4-06
common_ Default: 0.0%
(422H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal AM Bias Min: -999.9% 199
Sets the signal level at terminal AM that is equal to 0% of the selected monitor value. Max: 999.9%
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
H4-07 Terminal FM Signal Level
Min: 0 200
(423H) Selection 0: 0 to 10 V
Max: 1
1: -10 to 10 V
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
H4-08 Terminal AM Signal Level
Min: 0 200
(424H) Selection 0: 0 to 10 V
Max: 1
1: -10 to 10 V
0: 1200 bps
1: 2400 bps
2: 4800 bps
Default: 3
H5-02 3: 9600 bps
Communication Speed Selection Min: 0 396
(426H) 4: 19200 bps
Max: 8
5: 38400 bps
6: 57600 bps
7: 76800 bps
8: 115200 bps
Cycle power for the setting to take effect.
364 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
<14> If this parameter is set to 0, the drive will be unable to respond to MEMOBUS/Modbus commands.
L: Protection Functions
L parameters provide protection to the drive and motor, including control during momentary power loss, Stall
Prevention, frequency detection, fault reset, overtorque detection, torque limits, and other types of hardware protection.
L1: Motor Protection
Sets operation when the motor temperature analog input (H3-02 or H3-10 = E) exceeds the oH3
L1-03 Default: 3
Motor Overheat Alarm Operation alarm level.
(482H) Min: 0 204
Selection (PTC thermistor input) 0: Ramp to stop
<44> Max: 3
1: Coast to stop
2: Emergency Stop (Fast Stop) (decelerate to stop using the deceleration time in C1-09)
3: Alarm only (“oH3” will flash)
common_
All Modes TMonly
L1-04 Sets stopping method when the motor temperature analog input (H3-02 or H3-10 = E) exceeds Default: 1
Motor Overheat Fault Operation
(483H) the oH4 fault level. Min: 0 204
Selection (PTC thermistor input)
<44> 0: Ramp to stop Max: 2
Parameter List
1: Coast to stop
2: Emergency Stop (Fast Stop) (decelerate to stop using the deceleration time in C1-09)
L1-05 common_ Default: 0.20 s
Motor Temperature Input Filter All Modes TMonly
(484H) Min: 0.00 s 205
Time (PTC thermistor input)
<44> Adjusts the filter for the motor temperature analog input (H3-02 or H3-10 = E). Max: 10.00 s
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 1
L1-13
(46DH)
Continuous Electrothermal
Operation Selection 0: Disabled
Min: 0
Max: 1
205 B
1: Enabled
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 365
B.3 Parameter Table
<9> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. Double the value when using a 400 V class drive.
<15> Default setting value is dependent on the setting for the input voltage (E1-01).
<16> The setting value is dependent on the setting for the carrier frequency reduction (L8-38).
Default: 0.0%
L4-03 Speed Agreement Detection Level
Min: -100.0% 207
(49BH) (+/-) common_
All Modes TMonly
Max: 100.0%
L4-03 sets the speed detection level for digital output functions H2- = 13, 14, 15, 16.
Default: 4.0%
L4-04 Speed Agreement Detection Width L4-04 sets the hysteresis or allowable margin for speed detection.
Min: 0.0% 207
(49CH) (+/-)
Max: 40.0%
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
L4-05 Speed Reference Loss Detection
Min: 0 207
(49DH) Selection 0: Stop. Drive stops when the speed reference is lost.
Max: 1
1: Run. Drive runs at a reduced speed when the speed reference is lost.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 80%
L4-06
Speed Reference at Reference Loss Min: 0.0% 207
(4C2H) Sets the percentage of the speed reference that the drive should run with when the speed
Max: 100.0%
reference is lost.
common_
L4-07 All Modes TMonly Default: 0
(470H) Speed Agree Detection Selection Min: 0 208
0: No detection during baseblock.
<44> Max: 1
1: Detection always enabled.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.0%
L4-13
Door Zone Level Min: 0.0% 208
(4F6H) Sets the door zone speed level. The "door zone" multi-function digital output is closed when the
Max: 100.0%
speed falls below this level.
<44> Available in drive software versions PRG: 7017 or later.
366 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
0: Disabled
1: oL4 detection only active during speed agree, operation continues after detection
2: oL4 detection always active during run, operation continues after detection Default: 0
L6-04
Torque Detection Selection 2 3: oL4 detection only active during speed agree, output shuts down on an oL4 fault Min: 0 210
(4A4H)
4: oL4 detection always active during run, output shuts down on an oL4 fault Max: 8
5: UL4 detection only active during speed agree, operation continues after detection
6: UL4 detection always active during run, operation continues after detection
7: UL4 detection only active during speed agree, output shuts down on an oL4 fault
8: UL4 detection always active during run, output shuts down on an oL4 fault
common_ Default: 150%
L6-05 All Modes TMonly
Torque Detection Level 2 Min: 0% 211
(4A5H)
Sets the overtorque and undertorque detection level. Max: 300%
common_ Default: 0.1 s
L6-06 All Modes TMonly
Torque Detection Time 2 Min: 0.0 s 211
(4A6H)
Sets the time an overtorque or undertorque condition must exist to trigger torque detection 2. Max: 10.0 s
L7-03
L7-02 Default: 300%
L7-04 Reverse Regenerative Torque Negative Torque Min: 0% 212
(4AAH) Limit
Max: 300%
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 1
L7-16
Torque Limit Process at Start Min: 0 212
(44DH) 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Max: 1 B
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 367
B.3 Parameter Table
L8-06 When ripple is observed in the DC bus, expansion of the input bias is calculated and becomes Default: <4>
Input Phase Loss Detection Level the input phase if the difference between the max and minimum values of the ripple are greater Min: 0.0% 213
(4B2H)
than L8-06. Max: 50.0%
Detection Level = 100% = Voltage class 2 (determines standards for setting values)
common_
All Modes TMonly
0: Disabled
1: Enabled (triggered by a single phase loss) Default: 0
L8-07 Output Phase Loss Protection
2: Enabled (triggered when two phases are lost) Min: 0 213
(4B3H) Selection
3: Fault at phase loss at start or when two phases lost mid-operation Max: 3
Note: Setting 3 is available in the control mode V/f or OLV for drives with software versions
PRG: 7200 or later.
common_
All Modes Default: 1
L8-09 Output Ground Fault Detection TMonly
0: Disabled Min: 0 214
(4B5H) Selection
1: Enabled Max: 1
common_
All Modes TMonly
0: Run with timer (Fan operates only during run and for L8-11 seconds after stop.) Default: 0
L8-10 Heatsink Cooling Fan Operation
1: Run always (Cooling fan operates whenever the drive is powered up.) Min: 0 214
(4B6H) Selection
2: Temperature controlled (Cooling fan operated depending on the temperature of the drives Max: 2
heatsink.)
common_
All Modes Default: 60 s
L8-11 Heatsink Cooling Fan Off Delay TMonly
(4B7H) Time Sets a delay time to shut off the cooling fan after the Up/Down command is removed when L8- Min: 0 s 214
10 = 0. Max: 300 s
common_
L8-35 All Modes TMonly
Default: <4>
(4ECH) Installation Selection 0: IP20 enclosure drive Min: 0 215
<1>
2: NEMA Type 1 enclosure drive Max: 2
common_
All Modes TMonly
L8-38 Torque Boost increases the output current limit while decreasing the carrier frequency when the Default: 0
Automatic Torque Boost Selection output current exceeds a certain value. Min: 0 215
(4EFH)
0: Disabled Max: 3
3: Enabled
common_ Default: 3.0 kHz
L8-39 All Modes
Reduced Carrier Frequency TMonly Min: 1.0 kHz 216
(4F0H) Sets the reduced carrier frequency used by the Torque Boost function. Max: 15.0 kHz
common_
All Modes Default: 1
L8-55 Internal Braking Transistor TMonly
(45FH) Protection 0: Disabled. L8-55 should be disabled when using a regen converter or an optional braking unit. Min: 0 216
1: Protection enabled. Max: 1
368 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
common_
All Modes Default: 1
L8-88 TMonly
Safe Disable Operation Mode 0: Mode 0 Min: 0 217
(2F5H)
1: Mode 1 Max: 1
common_
L8-89 All Modes TMonly Default: 0
(B97H) Current Monitoring Selection Enables or disables the Current Monitoring function. Min: 0 217
<44> 0: Disabled Max: 1
1: Enabled
common_
L8-99 All Modes TMonly
Default: 10.0%
(B98H) Current Monitoring Level Sets the current monitoring level as a percentage of the drive’s rated current. Sets the level of Min: 0.0% 217
<44>
current used for L8-89 and H2- = 5C. Max: 50.0%
<1> Parameter setting value is not reset to the default value when the drive is initialized.
<4> Default setting is determined by the drive model (o2-04).
<44> Available in drive software versions PRG: 7017 or later.
<47> The default is 2 for models CIMR-LF that are in compliance with IEC/EN 61508 SIL3 Safety Integrity Level 3.
Motor Acceleration Time V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Min: 0.001 s 219
(5B1H) Sets the time required to accelerate the motor at 100% torque from 0 to the nominal speed. Max: 10.000 s
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM Default: 1.00
n5-03 TMonly
Inertia Compensation Gain Sets the ratio between motor and load inertia. Lower this setting if overshoot occurs at the end Min: 0.00 220
(5B2H)
of acceleration. Max: 100.00
common_
B
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 1
n5-07 Speed Feedback Compensation 0: Disabled Min: 0 221
(170H) Selection 1: Enabled Max: 2
2: Test Mode
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 369
B.3 Parameter Table
<9> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. Double the value when using a 400 V class drive.
370 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Sets the units the drive should use to display the frequency reference and motor speed monitors.
0: 0.01 Hz
Default: 1
o1-03 Digital Operator Display Unit 1: 0.01% (100% = E1-04)
Min: 0 225
(502H) Selection 2: r/min (calculated using the number of motor poles setting in E2-04, E4-04, or E5-04)
Max: 6 <21>
3: User-selected units (set by o1-10 and o1-11)
4: Elevator units 1 (speed in m/s, accel/decel rate and jerk in s)
5: Elevator units 2 (speed in m/s, accel/decel rate in m/s2, jerk in m/s3)
6: Elevator units 3 (speed in ft/min, accel/decel rate in ft/s2, jerk in ft/s3)
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM Default: <5>
o1-04 TMonly
V/f Pattern Setting Units 0: Hz Min: 0 226
(503H)
1: r/min Max: 1
o1-05
common_ Default: 3
(504H) All Modes TMonly
LCD Contrast Control Min: 0 226
Sets the brightness of the LCD operator (option). Max: 5
common_
o1-06 All Modes TMonly Default: 0
(517H) User Monitor Selection Mode Min: 0 226
0: 3 Monitor Sequential (Displays the next 2 sequential monitors)
<44> Max: 1
1: 3 Monitor Selectable (o1-07 and o1-08 selected monitor is displayed)
o1-07 common_ Default: 102
All Modes TMonly
(518H) Second Line Monitor Selection Min: 101 226
<44> Selects the monitor displayed on the second line. Max: 699
o1-08 common_ Default: 103
All Modes TMonly
(519H) Third Line Monitor Selection Min: 101 226
<44> Selects the monitor displayed on the third line. Max: 699
Default: <20>
o1-10 User-Set Display Units Maximum
All Modes
common_ Min: 1 227
(520H) Value TMonly
Max: 60000
These settings define the display values when o1-03 is set to 3.
o1-10 sets the display value that is equal to the maximum output frequency. Default: <20>
o1-11 User-Set Display Units Decimal
o1-11 sets the position of the decimal position. Min: 0 227
(521H) Display
Max: 3
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 0
o1-12
Length Units Min: 0 227
(739H) 0: Millimeter unit
Max: 1
1: Inch unit
common_ Default: 400 mm <38>
o1-20 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Traction Sheave Diameter Min: 100 mm 227
(575H)
Sets the traction sheave diameter for display unit calculations. Max: 2000 mm <38>
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
3: 1:3
4: 1:4
common_ Default: <5>
o1-22 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Mechanical Gear Ratio Min: 0.10 227
(577H)
Sets the ratio of the gear installed for display unit calculations. Max: <46>
common_
All Modes TMonly
o1-23 Default: 0
(174H) HBB Non Display Select Shows or hides the HBB command on the digital operator while the safety signal is being input. Min: 0 228 B
<45> 0: Shows HBB Max: 1
1: Hide HBB
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 371
B.3 Parameter Table
<20> This parameter appears when the drive displays user-set units (o1-03 = 3).
<21> The control mode determines the selections available. In V/f Control, only settings 1 through 3 are permitted.
<38> Default setting and setting range changes when inches are selected for the length units (o1-12 = 1). The setting range becomes 3.70 to 78.00
inches, and the default becomes 15.70 inches.
<44> Available in drive software versions PRG: 7017 or later.
<45> Available in drive software versions PRG: 7200 or later.
<46> The setting range changes depending on drive software versions.
PRG: 7017 or earlier: 0.10 to 50.00
PRG: 7200 or later: 0.10 to 100.00
<1> Parameter setting value is not reset to the default value when the drive is initialized.
0: Copy select
Default: 0
o3-01 1: INV OP READ (Read parameters from the drive, saving them onto the digital operator.)
Copy Function Selection Min: 0 230
(515H) 2: OP INV WRITE (Copy parameters from the digital operator, writing them to the drive.)
Max: 3
3: OP INV VERIFY (Verify parameter settings on the drive to check if they match the data
saved on the operator.)
To read the drive’s parameter settings into the digital operator, set o3-02 to 1 (to allow reading).
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
o3-02
Copy Allowed Selection Selects whether the read operation (o3-01 = 1) is enabled or disabled. Min: 0 230
(516H)
0: Read operation prohibited Max: 1
1: Read operation allowed
372 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
<1> Parameter setting value is not reset to the default value during drive initialization (A1-03).
S: Elevator Parameters
This section describes various functions and faults needed to operate an elevator application: braking sequence, slip
compensation for elevators, start/stop optimization, Rescue Operation, and elevator-related faults.
S1: Brake Sequence
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.20s
S1-06
Brake Release Delay Time Min: 0.00 s 234
(685H) Determines the delay time between the start of DC injection/Position Lock and setting the brake
Max: 10.00 s
control command (H2- = 50) in order to release the brake at the beginning of the ride.
common_
All Modes TMonlyDefault: 0.10s
S1-07
Brake Close Delay Time Min: 0.00 s 234
(686H) Determines the delay time between reaching Zero Speed (S1-01) and resetting the brake control
command (H2- = 50) in order to apply the brake at the end of the ride.
Max: [S1-05]
B
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.10s
S1-10
Run Command Delay Time Min: 0.00 s 234
(687H) Sets the time that must pass after the Up/Down command is entered until the drive internal Run
Max: 1.00 s
command is set and the ride is started.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 373
B.3 Parameter Table
Determines the state of the output contactor control command (H2- = 51) during Auto-
S1-12 Tuning. Default: 0
Motor Contactor Control During
(6E0H) 0: Disabled Min: 0 234
Auto-Tuning
<39> 1: Enabled Max: 2
2: Enabled during Auto-Tuning and HBB
Note: Setting 2 is available in the control mode CLV or CLV/PM for drives with software
versions PRG: 7017 or later. The setting is 0 or 1 for software version PRG: 7016.
S1-26 common_ Default: 10.0%
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
(6D7H) Emergency Stop Start Level Min: 0.0% 235
<44> Sets the Emergency Stop Start Level as a percentage of the Maximum Output Frequency. Max: 100.0%
S2-03 Slip compensation for leveling speed can be set separately for motoring and regenerative states.
This can help improve the accuracy of leveling. Default: 1.0
(691H) Slip Compensation Gain in
Min: 0.0 235
Regenerative Mode
Max: 5.0
S3-02 Sets gain levels 1 and 2 for the Position Lock function. Position Lock at start attempts to keep
the car position when opening the brake in order to avoid roll back. Default: 0.00
(698H) Position Lock Gain at Start 2
Min: 0.00 236
(Anti Rollback Gain)
Max: 100.00
S3-03 common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 5
(699H)
Position Lock Gain at Stop Min: 0 236
Sets the Position Lock gain at stop. Position Lock at stop keeps the car in position until the
Max: 100
brake has been applied entirely.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 10
S3-04
Position Lock Bandwidth Min: 0 236
(69AH) Determines the bandwidth around the stop position in which a digital output programmed for
Max: 16383
"Within Position Lock Bandwidth" (H2- = 33) is closed.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 500 ms
S3-10 Starting Torque Compensation
Min: 0 ms 236
(69BH) Increase Time Sets a time constant for the torque reference to reach 300%. Enabled by setting an analog input
Max: 5000 ms
terminal for torque compensation (H3- = 14).
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 0
S3-12 Starting Torque Compensation
Min: -40.0% 236
(69DH) Bias in Down Direction Adds a bias to torque compensation value from the load cell when moving in the down
Max: 40.0%
direction.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Default: 0.0%
S3-14 Torque Compensation Diminish
Sets the speed level for torque compensation to diminish during the time determined by S3-15. Min: 0.0% 237
(69FH) Speed
Sets as a percentage of the maximum output frequency (E1-04). A setting of 0.0% disables this Max: 200.0%
function.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 1000 ms
S3-15 Torque Compensation Diminish
Min: 0 ms 237
(6A0H) Time Sets the time for torque compensation to diminish once motor speed reaches the level set in S3-
Max: 5000 ms
14.
374 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Determines the reduction rate used bring the internal torque reference value down to zero after Default: 100 ms
S3-16
Torque Limit Reduction Time Position Lock at Stop has finished. Min: 0 ms 237
(6A1H)
Max: 10000 ms
Rate = Torque 300%
S3-16
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.00%
S3-20
Dwell 2 Speed Reference Min: 0.00% 237
(6A2H) Sets the speed reference for the Dwell 2 function.
Max: 100.00%
Note: A setting of 0.00 essentially disables the Dwell 2 function.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.00%
S3-21
Dwell 2 End Speed The Dwell 2 function will end when the drive reaches this speed. Min: 0.00% 237
(6A5H)
Note: A setting of 0.00 will disable the acceleration rate switch that occurs at the end of Dwell Max: 100.00%
2.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 100%
S3-25 DC Injection Gain in Regenerative
(6A3H) Operation Sets the gain level applied to the DC injection current at stop (S1-03) for when the load is 100% Min: 0% 237
Max: 400%
regenerative. The current applied during DC Injection at stop is determined as S1-03S3-25.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 20%
S3-26 DC Injection Gain in Motoring
(6A4H) Operation Sets the gain level applied to the DC injection current at stop (S1-03) for when the load is 100% Min: 0% 238
Max: 400%
motoring. The current applied during DC Injection at stop is determined as S1-03 S3-26.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: -50%
S3-27 Torque Compensation Value with
Min: -100% 238
(6BDH) Load Condition 1 Used for starting torque compensation utilizing a load cell signal. Sets the torque compensation
Max: 100%
value for load condition 1.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 50%
S3-28 Torque Compensation Value with
Min: -100% 238
(6BEH) Load Condition 2 Used for starting torque compensation utilizing a load cell signal. Sets the torque compensation
Max: 100%
value for load condition 2.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 0.0%
S3-29 Analog Input from Load Cell with
Min: -100% 238
(6BFH) Load Condition 1 Used for starting torque compensation utilizing a load cell signal. Sets the analog signal level
Max: 100%
from the load cell for load condition 1.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 100.0%
S3-30 Analog Input from Load Cell with
Min: -100.0% 238
(6C0H) Load Condition 2 Used for starting torque compensation utilizing a load cell signal. Sets the analog signal level
Max: 100%
from the load cell for load condition 2.
common_ Default: 0.0%
S3-34 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Anti-Rollback Torque Bias 1 Min: 0.0% 238
(6C4H)
Sets the Anti-Rollback Bias applied at small position deviations during Position Lock at start. Max: 100.0%
common_ Default: 0.0%
S3-35 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Anti-Rollback Torque Bias 2 Min: 0.0% 238
(6C5H)
Sets the Anti-Rollback Bias applied at large position deviations during Position Lock at start. Max: 100.0%
common_ Default: 0
S3-37 Position Deviation Level to Apply V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Min: 0 238
(6C7H) ARB Torque Bias 1
Sets the position deviation level to active at Anti-Rollback Torque Bias 1 (S3-34). Max: 32767
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 0
S3-38 Position Deviation Level to Apply
Min: 0 239
(6C8H) ARB Torque Bias 2 Determines the position deviation level for when the drive should switch from the torque bias
Max: 32767
set in S3-34 to the torque bias set in S3-35.
common_ Default: 0.00
S3-39 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Anti-Rollback Integral Gain Min: -30.00 239
(6C9H)
Determines the drive’s responsiveness for Anti-Rollback during Position Lock. Max: 30.00
common_ Default: 1 pulse
S3-40 Anti-Rollback Movement V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0 pulse 239
(6CAH) Detection
Sets the amount of pulses for movement detection during Anti-Rollback. Max: 100 pulses
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 0.50
S3-41 Position Lock Gain at Start 2
Min: 0.00 239
(6CBH) Reduction Sets a reduction factor for the Position Lock Gain at Start 2 (Anti-Rollback Gain) set in
Max: 1.00
parameter S3-02.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 375
B.3 Parameter Table
Determines how a speed limit should be applied to the Rescue Operation speed (S4-15) when Default: 2
S4-08 UPS Operation Speed Limit
operating from a UPS. Min: 0 240
(6CEH) Selection
0: Disabled Max: 2
1: Enabled until Light Load Direction Search is complete
2: Enabled until stop
common_ Default: 0 V
S4-12 DC Bus Voltage during Rescue All Modes TMonly Min: 0 V 240
(6D2H) Operation
Sets the DC bus voltage during Rescue Operation. Max: 1150 V
common_ Default: 80%
S4-13 Rescue Operation Power Supply All Modes TMonly Min: 10% 241
(6D3H) Deterioration Detection Level
Determines at which level of backup power supply deterioration a PF5 fault is triggered. Max: 100%
S4-15 common_ Default: 0
Speed Reference Selection for All Modes TMonly
(6DAH) Min: 0 241
Rescue Operation
<39> Selects the speed reference used for Rescue Operation. Max: 1
<36> When the length units are set for inches (o1-12 = 1), the setting range becomes 0.00 to 650.00 inches.
<37> When the length units are set for inches (o1-12 = 1), the setting range becomes 0.00 to 393.00 inches.
376 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
<7> Default setting value is determined by the digital operator display unit selection (o1-03). The default is normally 1.5 m/s2, but when o1-03 = 6,
the default becomes 5.0 ft/s2 (Setting Range: 0.0 to 50.0 ft/s2).
<44> Available in drive software versions PRG: 7017 or later.
T: Motor Tuning
Enter data into the following parameters to tune the motor and drive for optimal performance.
T1: Induction Motor Auto-Tuning
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 377
B.3 Parameter Table
378 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
U: Monitors
Monitor parameters allow the user to view drive status, fault information, and other data concerning drive operation.
U1: Operation Status Monitors
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
common_
U1-01 All Modes TMonly 10 V: Max frequency 0.01%
Speed Reference –
(40H) (-10 to +10 V) <29>
Monitors the speed reference.
common_
U1-02 All Modes TMonly 10 V: Max frequency 0.01%
Output Speed –
(41H) (-10 to +10 V) <29>
Displays the output speed.
common_
U1-03 All Modes TMonly 10 V: Drive rated
Output Current <10> <40> –
(42H) current
Displays the output current.
common_
All Modes TMonly
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 379
B.3 Parameter Table
U1 - 10=00000000
1 Digital input 1
(terminal S1 enabled)
1 Digital input 2
(terminal S2 enabled)
1 Digital input 3
U1-10 (terminal S3 enabled) No signal output
(49H)
Input Terminal Status YEG available
– –
1 Digital input 4
(terminal S4 enabled)
1 Digital input 5
(terminal S5 enabled)
1 Digital input 6
(terminal S6 enabled)
1 Digital input 7
(terminal S7 enabled)
1 Digital input 8
(terminal S8 enabled)
common_
All Modes TMonly
Displays the output terminal status.
U1 - 11=00000000
1 Multi-Function
Digital Output
(terminal M1-M2)
1 Multi-Function
Digital Output
YEG (terminal M3-M4)
U1-11 1 Multi-Function No signal output
Output Terminal Status – –
(4AH) Digital Output available
(terminal M5-M6)
1 Multi-Function
Digital Output
(terminal P1-C1)
1 Multi-Function
Digital Output
(terminal P2-C2)
Not Used
1Fault Relay
(terminal MA-MC closed
MA-MC open)
common_
All Modes TMonly
Displays the drive operation status.
U1 - 12= 00000000
1 During run
1 During zero-speed
U1-12
Drive Status YEG 1 During down direction No signal output
– –
(4BH) available
1 During fault reset
signal input
1 During speed agree
1 Drive ready
1 During alarm
detection
1 During fault detection
common_
U1-13 All Modes TMonly 10 V: 100%
Terminal A1 Input Voltage 0.1% –
(4EH) (-10 to +10 V)
Displays the voltage input to terminal A1.
common_
U1-14 All Modes TMonly 10 V: 100%
Terminal A2 Input Voltage 0.1% –
(4FH) (-10 to +10 V)
Displays the voltage input to terminal A2.
common_
U1-16 All Modes TMonly 10 V: Max frequency 0.01%
Output Speed after Soft Start –
(53H) (-10 to +10 V) <29>
Displays output speed with ramp time and jerk settings. Units determined by o1-03.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U1-17 DI-A3 Option Card Input No signal output
Displays the reference value input from the DI-A3 option card. – –
(58H) Status available
Display will appear in hexadecimal as determined by the digital card input selection in F3-01.
3FFFF: Set (1 bit) + sign (1 bit) + 16 bit
common_
U1-18 All Modes TMonly No signal output
oPE Fault Parameter – –
(61H) available
Displays the parameter number that caused the oPE02 or oPE08 (Operation error).
380 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Level Unit Page
common_
All Modes TMonly
Displays the contents of a MEMOBUS/Modbus error.
U1 - 19=00000000
1 CRC Error
U1-19 MEMOBUS/Modbus Error 1 Data Length Error No signal output
– –
(66H) Code YEG 0 Not Used available
1 Parity Error
1 Overrun Error
1 Framing Error
1 Timed Out
0 Not Used
common_
U1-25 All Modes TMonly No signal output
Software Number (Flash) – –
(4DH) available
FLASH ID
common_
U1-26 All Modes TMonly No signal output
Software No. (ROM) – –
(5BH) ROM ID available
<9> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. Double the value when using a 400 V class drive.
<10> The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L20008 to 20033 and 40005 to 40018
display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L20047 to 20415 and 40024 to 40216 display values in 0.1 A units.
<12> The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L20008 to 20033 and 40005 to 40018
display values in 0.01 kW units, while models CIMR-L20047 to 20415 and 40024 to 40216 display values in 0.1 kW units.
<29> Setting units are determined by the digital operator display unit selection (o1-03). When o1-03 = 0, the value is set in Hertz. When o1-03 = 4
or 5, the value is displayed in m/s. When o1-03 = 6, the value is displayed in ft/min.
<40> When checking the values of U1-03, U2-05 and U4-13 with the digital operator they are displayed in units of amperes, but when they are
checked using MEMOBUS communications, the monitor value in MEMOBUS communications is: displayed numeric value / 8192 drive’s
rated current (A), from the condition “8192 (maximum value) = drive’s rated current (A)”.
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
common_
U2-01 All Modes TMonly No signal output
Current Fault – –
(80H) available
Displays the current fault.
common_
U2-02 All Modes TMonly No signal output
Previous Fault – –
(81H) available
Displays the previous fault.
common_
U2-03 Speed Reference at Previous All Modes TMonly No signal output 0.01%
–
(82H) Fault available <29>
Displays the speed reference at the previous fault.
common_
U2-04 All Modes TMonly No signal output 0.01%
Output Speed at Previous Fault –
(83H) available <29>
Displays the output speed at the previous fault.
common_
U2-05 Output Current at Previous All Modes TMonly No signal output
<10> <40> –
(84H) Fault available
Displays the output current at the previous fault.
common_
U2-06 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly No signal output 0.01%
Motor Speed at Previous Fault –
(85H) available <29>
Displays the motor speed at the previous fault.
common_
U2-07 Output Voltage at Previous All Modes TMonly No signal output
0.1 Vac –
(86H) Fault available
Displays the output voltage at the previous fault.
common_
U2-08 DC Bus Voltage at Previous All Modes TMonly No signal output
1 Vdc –
(87H) Fault available
Displays the DC bus voltage at the previous fault.
common_
U2-09 Output Power at Previous All Modes TMonly No signal output
0.1 kW –
(88H) Fault available
Displays the output power at the previous fault.
common_
U2-10 Torque Reference at Previous V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly No signal output
0.1% –
(89H) Fault available
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 381
B.3 Parameter Table
<10> The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L20008 to 20033 and 40005 to 40018
display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L20047 to 20415 and 40024 to 40216 display values in 0.1 A units.
<29> Setting units are determined by the digital operator display unit selection (o1-03). When o1-03 = 0, the value is set in Hertz. When o1-03 = 4
or 5, the value is displayed in m/s. When o1-03 = 6, the value is displayed in ft/min.
<40> When checking the values of U1-03, U2-05 and U4-13 with the digital operator they are displayed in units of amperes, but when they are
checked using MEMOBUS communications, the monitor value in MEMOBUS communications is: displayed numeric value / 8192 drive’s
rated current (A), from the condition “8192 (maximum value) = drive’s rated current (A)”.
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-01
(4CH, 98H, Displays the cumulative operation time of the drive. The value for the cumulative operation No signal output
Cumulative Operation Time 1h –
99H) time counter can be reset in parameter o4-01. Use parameter o4-02 to determine if the operation available
<41> time should start as soon as the power is switched on or only while the Up/Down command is
present. The maximum number displayed is 99999, after which the value is reset to 0.
common_
U4-03 All Modes TMonly
(67H, 94H, Displays the cumulative operation time of the cooling fan. The default value for the fan No signal output
Cooling Fan Operation Time 1h –
9BH) operation time is reset in parameter o4-03. This value will reset to 0 and start counting again available
<42>
after reaching 99999.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-04 No signal output
Cooling Fan Maintenance Displays main cooling fan usage time in as a percentage of its expected performance life. 1% –
(7EH) available
Parameter o4-03 can be used to reset this monitor. The fan should be replaced when this
monitor reaches 90%.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-05 No signal output
Capacitor Maintenance Displays main circuit capacitor usage time in as a percentage of their expected performance life. 1% –
(7CH) available
The capacitors should be replaced when this monitor reaches 90%. Parameter o4-05 can be used
to reset this monitor.
382 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Level Unit Page
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-06 Soft Charge Bypass Relay No signal output
Displays the soft charge bypass relay maintenance time as a percentage of its estimated 1% –
(7D6H) Maintenance available
performance life. The soft charge relay should be replaced when this monitor reaches 90%.
Parameter o4-07 can be used to reset this monitor.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-07 No signal output
IGBT Maintenance 1% –
(7D7H) Displays IGBT usage time as a percentage of the expected performance life. The IGBTs should available
be replaced when this monitor reaches 90%. Parameter o4-09 can be used to reset this monitor.
common_
U4-08 All Modes TMonly
Heatsink Temperature 10 V: 100C 1C –
(68H)
Displays the heatsink temperature.
common_
U4-09 All Modes TMonly No signal output
LED Check – –
(5EH) available
Lights all segments of the LED to verify that the display is working properly.
common_
U4-10 All Modes TMonly No signal output
kWh, Lower 4 Digits 1 kWh –
(5CH) available
Monitors the drive output power. The value is shown as a 9 digit number displayed across two
monitor parameters, U4-10 and U4-11.
Example:
12345678.9 kWh is displayed as:
U4-11 No signal output
kWh, Upper 5 Digits U4-10: 678.9 kWh 1 MWh –
(5DH) available
U4-11: 12345 MWh
common_
U4-13 All Modes TMonly No signal output 0.01 A
Peak Hold Current –
(7CFH) available <40>
Displays the highest current value that occurred during a ride.
common_
U4-14 All Modes TMonly No signal output
Peak Hold Output Frequency 0.01 Hz –
(7D0H) available
Displays the output frequency when the current value shown in U4-13 occurred.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-16 Motor Overload Estimate
10 V: 100% 0.1% –
(7D8H) (oL1) Shows the value of the motor overload detection accumulator. 100% is equal to the oL1
detection level.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-17 Drive Overload Calculations
10 V = 100% 0.1% –
(7D9H) (oL2) Displays the level of the drive overload detection (oL2). A value of 100% is equal to the oL2
detection level.
common_
All Modes TMonly
Displays the source for the speed reference as XY-nn.
X: indicates which reference is used:
1 = Reference 1 (b1-01)
U4-18 Speed Reference Selection Y-nn: indicates the reference source No signal output
– –
(7DAH) Results 0-01 = Digital operator available
1-01 = Analog (terminal A1)
1-02 = Analog (terminal A2)
2-02 to 8 = Digital Inputs (d1-02 to 8)
3-01 = MEMOBUS/Modbus communications
4-01 = Communication option card
common_
U4-19 Speed Reference from All Modes TMonly No signal output 0.01%
–
(7DBH) MEMOBUS/Modbus Comm. available <29>
Displays the speed reference provided by MEMOBUS/Modbus (decimal).
common_
U4-20 Speed Reference From Option All Modes TMonly No signal output 0.01%
–
(7DCH) Card available <29>
Displays the speed reference input by an option card (decimal).
common_
All Modes TMonly
Displays the source for the Up/Down command as XY-nn.
X: Indicates which Up/Down command source is used:
1 = Reference 1 (b1-02)
Y: Input power supply data
0 = Digital operator
1 = External terminals
3 = MEMOBUS/Modbus communications
U4-21 Up/Down Command Source 4 = Communication option card No signal output
– –
(7DDH) Selection nn: Up/Down command limit status data available
00: No limit status.
01: Up/Down command was left on when stopped in the PRG mode
02: Up/Down command was left on when switching from LOCAL to REMOTE operation
03: Waiting for soft charge bypass contactor after power up (Uv or Uv1 flashes after 10 s)
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 383
B.3 Parameter Table
<29> Setting units are determined by the digital operator display unit selection (o1-03). When o1-03 = 0, the value is set in Hertz. When o1-03 = 4
or 5, the value is displayed in m/s. When o1-03 = 6, the value is displayed in ft/min.
<35> o1-12 (Length Units) determines the units. When o1-12 is set to 0, the unit is millimeters. When o1-12 is set to 1, the unit is inch.
<40> When checking the values of U1-03, U2-05 and U4-13 with the digital operator they are displayed in units of amperes, but when they are
checked using MEMOBUS communications, the monitor value in MEMOBUS communications is: displayed numeric value / 8192 drive’s
rated current (A), from the condition “8192 (maximum value) = drive’s rated current (A)”.
<41> The MEMOBUS communications data is in 10 h units. If data in 1 h units are also required, refer to register number 0099H.
<42> The MEMOBUS communications data is in 10 h units. If data in 1 h units are also required, refer to register number 009BH.
Note: Fault trace (i.e., the fault history) is not maintained when CPF00, CPF01, CPF06, CPF24, oFA00, oFb00, oFC00, Uv1, Uv2, or Uv3
occur.
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
10 V: Motor
common_
U6-01 All Modes TMonlysecondary rated
Motor Secondary Current (Iq) 0.1% –
(51H) current
Displays the value of the motor secondary current (Iq). Motor rated secondary current is 100%.
(-10 to +10 V)
common_ 10 V: Motor
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
U6-02 secondary rated
Motor Excitation Current (Id) 0.1% –
(52H) Displays the value calculated for the motor excitation current (Id). Motor rated secondary current
current is 100%. (-10 to +10 V)
U6-03 10 V: Max frequency
Speed Control Loop Input
(54H) (-10 to +10 V)
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: Motor 0.01% –
U6-04 Displays the input and output values of the speed control loop. secondary rated
Speed Control Loop Output
(55H) current
(-10 to +10 V)
common_
U6-05 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: 200 Vrms <9>
Output Voltage Reference (Vq) 0.1 Vac –
(59H) (-10 to +10 V)
Output voltage reference (Vq) for the q-axis.
common_
U6-06 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: 200 Vrms <9>
Output Voltage Reference (Vd) 0.1 Vac –
(5AH) (-10 to +10 V)
Output voltage reference (Vd) for the d-axis.
common_
U6-07 q-Axis Current Controller V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: 200 Vrms <9>
0.1% –
(5FH) Output (-10 to +10 V)
Displays the output value for current control relative to motor secondary current (q-axis).
384 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Level Unit Page
common_
U6-08 d-Axis Current Controller V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: 200 Vrms <9>
0.1% –
(60H) Output (-10 to +10 V)
Displays the output value for current control relative to motor secondary current (d-axis).
common_
U6-13 Flux Position Detection V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: 180 deg
0.1 deg –
(7CAH) (sensor) -10 V: -180 deg
Monitors the value of the flux position detection (sensor).
common_
U6-18 All Modes
Speed Detection PG1 Counter TMonly 10 V: 65536 1 pulse –
(7CDH)
Monitors the number of pulses for speed detection (PG1).
common_ 10 V: No. of pulses
U6-22 Position Lock Deviation V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly per revolution 1 pulse –
(62H) Counter
Displays how far the rotor has moved from its last position in PG pulses (multiplied by 4). (-10 to +10 V)
common_
10 V: Motor
U6-25 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly secondary rated
Feedback Control Output 0.01% –
(6BH) current
Output monitor for the speed control loop.
(-10 to +10 V)
10 V: Motor
common_
U6-26 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly secondary rated
Inertia Compensation Output 0.01% –
(6CH) current
Output monitor for Inertia Compensation.
(-10 to +10 V)
common_
U6-56 Speed Feedback V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: Max output
0.01% –
(7C3H) Compensation Output frequency
Displays observed speed when n5-07=1 or 2.
U6-80
common_
to U6-99 All Modes No signal output
Option Monitor 1 to 20 TMonly – –
(7B0 to 7B9, available
Monitors reserved to display data from option cards.
7F0 to 7F9H)
<9> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. Double the value when using a 400 V class drive.
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 385
B.4 Control Mode Dependent Parameter Default Values
<3> For models CIMR-L20008 and 40005, the default setting is 20.0 for E1-08, and 12.5 for E1-10.
For models CIMR-L20011 to 20180, 40006 to 40091, the default setting is 18.6 for E1-08, and 9.7 for E1-10.
For models CIMR-L20215 to 20415, 40112 to 40216, the default setting is 16.0 for E1-08, and 8.3 for E1-10.
<9> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. Double the value when using a 400 V class drive.
<22> Default setting value varies by drive model (o2-04).The default setting for models CIMR-L20115 to 20415, CIMR-L40112 to
40216 is 1000 ms when using V/f control.
<23> Setting range depends on the type of motor being used. An induction motor has a setting range of 10.0 to 200.0 Hz, while a PM motor has a
setting range of 4.0 to 200.0 Hz.
386 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.5 Defaults by Drive Model Selection (o2-04)
Table B.4 200 V Class Drives Default Settings by Drive Model Selection
No. Name Unit Default Settings
– Model CIMR-L – 20008 20011 20018 20025 20033 20047 20060 20075
o2-04 Drive Model Selection Hex. 65 66 68 6A 6B 6D 6E 6F
E2-11 Motor Rated Output kW 1.5 2.2 4.0 5.5 7.5 11 15 18.5
C5-17 Motor Inertia kgm2 0.0068 0.0088 0.0158 0.026 0.037 0.053 0.076 0.138
C6-03 Carrier Frequency kHz 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8
E2-01
Motor Rated Current A 6.2 8.5 14 19.6 26.6 39.7 53 65.8
(E4-01)
E2-02
Motor Rated Slip Hz 2.6 2.9 2.73 1.5 1.3 1.7 1.6 1.67
(E4-02)
E2-03
Motor No-Load Current A 2.8 3 4.5 5.1 8 11.2 15.2 15.7
(E4-03)
E2-05
Motor Line-to-Line Resistance 1.997 1.601 0.771 0.399 0.288 0.23 0.138 0.101
(E4-05)
E2-06
Motor Leakage Inductance % 18.5 18.4 19.6 18.2 15.5 19.5 17.2 20.1
(E4-06)
E2-10 Motor Iron Loss for Torque Compensation W 53 77 112 172 262 245 272 505
E3-08 Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency Voltage V 20.0 18.6 18.6 18.6 18.6 18.6 18.6 18.6
E3-10 Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency Voltage V 12.5 9.7 9.7 9.7 9.7 9.7 9.7 9.7
E5-02 Motor Rated Power kW 1.5 2.2 4.0 5.5 7.5 11 15 18.5
E5-03 Motor Rated Current A 8 11 14.6 20 29.3 37.9 53.2 65
E5-05 Motor Stator Resistance 1.048 0.645 0.331 0.37 0.223 0.153 0.095 0.069
E5-06 Motor d-Axis Inductance mH 6.96 7.03 4.78 5.39 3.58 3.46 2.46 1.99
E5-07 Motor q-Axis Inductance mH 10.58 9.71 6.52 7.36 4.89 4.96 3.7 2.99
E5-09 Motor Induction Voltage Constant 1 mV/(rad/sec) 220.8 235.3 239.3 254.3 237 270 254.3 256.7
L8-02 Overheat Alarm Level C 115 125 110 120 125 120 120 125
L8-06 Input Phase Loss Detection Level % 15.0 16.0 14.0 18.0 20.0 22.0 20.0 21.0
L8-35 Installation Method Selection – 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
n5-02 Motor Acceleration Time s 0.166 0.145 0.154 0.168 0.175 0.265 0.244 0.317
n9-60 A/D Conversion Start Delay sec 14.0 14.0 14.0 14.0 14.0 14.0 14.0 14.0
E5-03 Motor Rated Current A 76.4 103.5 133.1 149.4 181.6 181.6 181.6 181.6
E5-05 Motor Stator Resistance 0.054 0.041 0.027 0.022 0.016 0.016 0.016 0.016
E5-06 Motor d-Axis Inductance mH 1.7 1.29 0.91 0.9 0.72 0.72 0.72 0.72
E5-07 Motor q-Axis Inductance mH 2.55 2 1.41 1.39 1.11 1.11 1.11 1.11
E5-09 Motor Induction Voltage Constant 1 mV/(rad/sec) 261.1 260.4 245.1 276 0.317 0.533 0.592 0.646
L8-02
L8-06
Overheat Alarm Level
Input Phase Loss Detection Level
C
%
130
21.0
130
17.0
130
27.0
125
28.0
115
17
120
16
120
24
120
22
B
L8-35 Installation Method Selection – 2 2 2 2 0 0 0 0
n5-02 Motor Acceleration Time s 0.355 0.323 0.32 0.387 0.317 0.533 0.592 0.646
n9-60 A/D Conversion Start Delay sec 14.0 14.0 14.0 14.0 14.0 14.0 14.0 14.0
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 387
B.5 Defaults by Drive Model Selection (o2-04)
388 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.6 Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection (o1-03)
<1> Automatically calculated according to the values set to o1-20, o1-21, o1-22, and E2-/E5- parameters.
<2> Automatically calculated according to the values set to the E2-/E5- parameters.
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 389
B.6 Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection (o1-03)
390 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Appendix: C
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 391
C.1 MEMOBUS/Modbus Configuration
Slave (Drive)
YEG
392 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.2 Communication Specifications
Item Specifications
Interface RS-422, RS-485
Communications Cycle Asynchronous (Start-stop synchronization)
Communication Speeds Available 1.2; 2.4; 4.8; 9.6; 19.2; 38.4; 57.6; 76.8; 115.2 kbps
Data length 8 bit (fixed)
Communication Parameters
Parity Select even, odd, or none
Stop bit 1 bit (fixed)
Protocol MEMOBUS/Modbus (using RTU mode only)
Max Number of Slaves 255 drives (RS-485)
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 393
C.3 Connecting to a Network
IG R+ R- S+ S-
YEG
S– Send (–)
S+ Send (+)
P M R– Receive (–)
R+ Receive (+)
IG Shield Ground
394 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.3 Connecting to a Network
R– S– Drive
R+ S+
PLC S– R– S2
S+ R+
IG IG OFF
S– Drive
S+
R– S2
R+
IG OFF
S– Drive
S+
R–
common_
S2
R+ ON
IG
TMonly
Figure C.3 RS-485 Interface
Note: 1. Turn on the DIP switch on the drive that is located at the end of the network. All other slave devices must have this DIP switch set to
the OFF position.
2. Set H5-07 to 1 when using the RS-485 interface.
RS-422 Interface
Figure C.4
R– S– Drive
R+ S+
PLC S– R– S2
S+ R+
IG IG OFF
S– Drive
S+
R– S2
R+
IG OFF
S– Drive
S+
R–
R+
IG
S2
ON common_
TMonly
Network Termination
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
The two ends of the MEMOBUS/Modbus network line have to be terminated. The drive has a built in termination
resistor that can be enabled or disabled using DIP switch S2. If a drive is located at the end of a network line, enable the
termination resistor by setting DIP switch S2 to the ON position. Disable the termination resistor on all slaves that are not
located at the network line end.
Refer to MEMOBUS/Modbus Termination on page 74 for details on setting S2. C
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 395
C.4 MEMOBUS/Modbus Setup Parameters
Each slave drive must be assigned a unique slave address for serial communications to work. Setting H5-01 to any value
besides 0 assigns the drive its address in the network. Slave addresses do not need to be assigned in sequential order, but
no two drives may share the same address.
H5-02: Communication Speed Selection
Sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus communications speed.
Note: Cycle the power after changing this parameter to enable the new setting.
Setting 0: No parity
Setting 1: Even parity
Setting 2: Odd parity
H5-04: Stopping Method after Communication Error
Selects the stopping method after a communications error (CE) has occurred.
396 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.4 MEMOBUS/Modbus Setup Parameters
Setting 0: Disabled
No communication error detection. The drive continues operation.
Setting 1: Enabled
If the drive does not receive data from the master for longer than the time set to H5-09, then a CE fault will be triggered
and the drive will operate as determined by parameter H5-04.
H5-06: Drive Transmit Wait Time
Sets the time the drive waits after receiving data from a master before responding.
common_
TMonly
24 bit length H5-06 setting
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 397
C.4 MEMOBUS/Modbus Setup Parameters
398 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.5 Drive Operations by MEMOBUS/Modbus
Refer to b1-01: Speed Reference Selection on page 149 and Refer to b1-02: Up/Down Command Selection on
page 150 for details on operation mode parameter selections.
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 399
C.6 Communications Timing
<1> If the drive receives command type 1 data during the minimum wait time, it will perform the command and then respond. However, if it
receives a command type 2 or 3 during that time, either a communication error will result or the command will be ignored.
Figure C.6
common_
24 bit length
Master Send
Wait Time
TMonly
Figure C.6 Minimum Wait Time for Sending Messages
A timer should be set in the master to check how long it takes for the slave drive(s) to respond to the master. If no
response is received within a certain amount of time, the master should try resending the message.
common_
24 bit length H5-06 TMonly
setting
400 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.7 Message Format
SLAVE ADDRESS
FUNCTION CODE
common_
DATA TMonly
ERROR CHECK
Slave Address
The slave address in the message defines the note the message is sent to. Use addresses between 0 and FF (hex). If a
message with slave address 0 is sent (broadcast), the command from the master will be received by all slaves. The slaves
do not provide a response to a broadcast type message.
Function Code
The three types of function codes are shown in the table below.
Data
Configure consecutive data by combining the MEMOBUS/Modbus register address (test code in case of a loopback test)
and the data the register contains. The data length changes depending on the command details.
A drive MEMOBUS/Modbus register always has a data length of two bytes. Therefore data written into drive registers
must also always have a length of two bytes. Register data read out from the drive will always consist of two bytes.
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 401
C.7 Message Format
Error Check
The drive uses a CRC-16 (cyclic redundancy check, checksum method) for checking data validity. Use the procedure
described below when calculating the CRC-16 checksum for command data or when verifying response data.
Command Data
When the drive receives data, it calculates the CRC-16 checksum from the data and compares it to the CRC-16 value
received within the message. Both must match before a command is processed.
An initial value of FFFFH (i.e., all 16 bits equal 1) must be used for CRC-16 calculations in the MEMOBUS/Modbus
protocol.
Calculate the CRC-16 checksum using the following steps:
1. The starting value is FFFFH.
2. Perform an XOR operation of this value and the slave address.
3. Right shift the result.
4. When the overflow bit of the shift operation becomes 1, perform an XOR operation of the result from step 3
above and the fix value A001H.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 until eight shift operations have been performed.
6. After eight shift operations, perform an XOR operation with the result and the next data in the message (function
code, register address, data). Continue with steps 3 to 5 until the last data has been processed.
7. The result of the last shift or XOR operation is the checksum.
The example in Table C.3 shows the CRC-16 calculation of the slave address 02H and the function code 03H, yielding
the result 40D1H.
Note: This example does not show the calculation for a complete MEMOBUS/Modbus command. Normally data would follow in the
calculation.
Table C.3 CRC-16 Checksum Calculation Example
Description Calculation Overflow Description Calculation Overflow
Initial Value (FFFFH) 1111 1111 1111 1111 Function Code 03H 0000 0000 0000 0011
Address 02H 0000 0000 0000 0010 XOR w result 1000 0001 0011 1101
XOR w initial value 1111 1111 1111 1101 Shift 1 0100 0000 1001 1110 1
Shift 1 0111 1111 1111 1110 1 XOR w A001H 1010 0000 0000 0001
XOR w A001H 1010 0000 0000 0001 XOR result 1110 0000 1001 1111
XOR result 1101 1111 1111 1111 Shift 2 0111 0000 0100 1111 1
Shift 2 0110 1111 1111 1111 1 XOR w A001H 1010 0000 0000 0001
XOR w A001H 1010 0000 0000 0001 XOR result 1101 0000 0100 1110
XOR result 1100 1111 1111 1110 Shift 3 0110 1000 0010 0111 0
Shift 3 0110 0111 1111 1111 0 Shift 4 0011 0100 0001 0011 1
Shift 4 0011 0011 1111 1111 1 XOR w A001H 1010 0000 0000 0001
XOR w A001H 1010 0000 0000 0001 XOR result 1001 0100 0001 0010
XOR result 1001 0011 1111 1110 Shift 5 0100 1010 0000 1001 0
Shift 5 0100 1001 1111 1111 0 Shift 6 0010 0101 0000 0100 1
Shift 6 0010 0100 1111 1111 1 XOR w A001H 1010 0000 0000 0001
XOR w A001H 1010 0000 0000 0001 XOR result 1000 0101 0000 0101
XOR result 1000 0100 1111 1110 Shift 7 0100 0010 1000 0010 1
Shift 7 0100 0010 0111 1111 0 XOR w A001H 1010 0000 0000 0001
Shift 8 0010 0001 0011 1111 1 XOR result 1110 0010 1000 0011
XOR w A001H 1010 0000 0000 0001 Shift 8 0111 0001 0100 0001 1
XOR result 1000 0001 0011 1110 XOR w A001H 1010 0000 0000 0001
XOR result 1101 0001 0100 0000
1101 0001 0100 0000
Perform operations with next data (function code) CRC-16 D 1 4 0
(Lower) (Upper)
Continue from here with next data.
Response Data
Perform a CRC-16 calculation on the response message data as described above as a validation check. The result should
match the CRC-16 checksum received within the response message.
402 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.8 Message Examples
Loopback Test
Function code 08H performs a loopback test. This test returns a response message with exactly the same content as the
command message and can be used to check communications between the master and slave. User-defined test code and
data values can be set.
The following table shows a message example when performing a loopback test with the slave 1 drive.
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 403
C.8 Message Examples
Note: Double the number of the data quantity for the number of bytes in the command message.
404 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
Command Data
It is possible to both read and write command data.
Note: Bits that are not used should be set to 0. Refrain from writing to reserved registers.
<1> To enable torque compensation function by serial communications, set H3-02 or H3-10 to 14 and set register 000FH bit 3=1.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 405
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
Monitor Data
Monitor data can be read only.
406 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 407
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
408 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 409
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
410 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 411
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
<1> Parameter o1-03, Digital Operator Display Selection, determines the units.
<2> The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L20008 to 20033 and 40005 to 40018 display
values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L20047 to 20415 and 40024 to 40216 display values in 0.1 A units.
<3> Communication error contents are saved until the fault is reset.
<4> Set the number of motor poles to parameter E2-04, E4-04, or E5-05 depending on the motor being used.
412 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
Broadcast Messages
Data can be written from the master to all slave devices at the same time.
The slave address in a broadcast command message must be set to 00H. All slaves will receive the message, but will not
respond.
0020H Motor Overheat Fault (PTC thermistor input) (oH4) 0137H CI Check Error (oFA36)
Communications
0021H MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication Error (CE) 0138H Drive timeout waiting for response (oFA37)
0022H Option Communication Error (bUS) 0139H Control Command Selection Error (oFA38)
0025H Control fault (CF) 013AH Drive timeout waiting for response (oFA39)
0026H Position Lock Error (SvE) 013BH Control Response Selection 1 Error (oFA40)
0027H Option External Fault (EF0) 013CH Drive timeout waiting for response (oFA41)
0029H Undertorque Detection 1 (UL3) 013DH Control Response Selection 2 Error (oFA42)
002AH Undertorque Detection 2 (UL4) 013EH Control Response Selection Error (oFA43) C
0030H Hardware Fault (including oFx) 0201H Option Connection Error (oFb01)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 413
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
414 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.10 Enter Command
Note: Limit the number of times writing to the EEPROM because the EEPROM can only be written to 100,000 times. The Enter
command registers are write-only and if these registers are read, the register address will be invalid (Error code: 02H). An Enter
command is not required when reference or broadcast data are sent to the drive.
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 415
C.11 Communication Errors
Error Name
Error Code
Cause
Function Code Error
01H
• Attempted to set a function code from a PLC other than 03H, 08H, and 10H.
Register Number Error
02H • A register number specified in the command message does not exist.
• Attempted to send a broadcast message using other register numbers than 0001H or 0002H.
Bit Count Error
03H • Read data or write data is greater than 16 bits. Invalid command message quantity.
• In a write message, the “Number of Data Items” contained within the message does not equal twice the amount of data words (i.e., the total of Data 1+ Data
2, etc.).
Data Setting Error
21H • Control data or parameter write data is outside the allowable setting range.
• Attempted to write a contradictory parameter setting.
Write Mode Error
22H • During run, the user attempted to write a parameter that cannot be written to during run.
• During an EEPROM memory data error (CPF06), the master attempted to write to a parameter other than A1-00 to A1-05, E1-03, or o2-04.
• Attempted to write to read-only data.
DC Bus Undervoltage Write Error
23H
• During an undervoltage situation, the master attempted to write to parameters that cannot be written to during undervoltage.
Write Error During Parameter Process
24H
• Master attempted writing to the drive while the drive was processing parameter data.
416 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.12 Self-Diagnostics
C.12 Self-Diagnostics
The drive has a built-in self-diagnosing function of the serial communication interface circuits. To perform the self-
diagnosis function, use the following procedure.
DANGER! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not connect or disconnect wiring while the power is on. Failure to comply will result in death or
serious injury. Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment. The internal capacitor remains charged even after the power
supply is turned off. The charge indicator LED will extinguish when the DC bus voltage is below 50 Vdc. To prevent electric shock, wait
at least one minute after all indicators are OFF and measure the DC bus voltage level to confirm safe level.
YEG
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 417
C.12 Self-Diagnostics
418 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Appendix: D
Standards Compliance
This appendix explains the guidelines and criteria for maintaining CE and UL standards.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 419
D.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Always ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting the motor case.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing, and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Do not remove covers or touch circuit boards while the power is on.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
420 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Fire Hazard
Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
Do not use an improper voltage source.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire.
Verify that the rated voltage of the drive matches the voltage of the incoming power supply before applying power.
Do not use improper combustible materials in drive installation, repair or maintenance.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire. Attach the drive or braking resistors to metal or other
noncombustible material.
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Never connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in damage to the drive.
Do not use unshielded wire for control wiring.
Failure to comply may cause electrical interference resulting in poor system performance. Use shielded twisted-pair
wires and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the product.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive or braking circuit.
Carefully review instruction manual TOBP C720600 0 when connecting a braking option to the drive.
Do not modify the drive circuitry.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive and will void warranty.
Yaskawa is not responsible for modification of the product made by the user. This product must not be modified.
Check all the wiring to ensure that all connections are correct after installing the drive and connecting other
devices.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive.
Compliance
Standards
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 421
D.2 European Standards
The user(s) is solely responsible for ensuring that the end products used with this drive comply with all applicable
European directives and with other national regulations (if required).
422 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.2 European Standards
DC power supply
(converter)
Fuse U/ T1
+ +1
_ _ V/ T2 M
W/ T3
Drive
Fuse U/ T1
+1
_ V/ T2 M
W/ T3
YEC_common Drive
Figure D.2 Example of DC Power Supply Input (two L1000A drives connected in series)
Note: 1. When connecting multiple drives together, make sure that each drive has its own fuse. If any one fuse blows, all fuses should be
replaced.
2. For an AC power supply, refer to Standard Connection Diagram on page 50.
Note: The recommended fuses and fuse holders are made by Fuji Electric.
Table D.1 Fuses and Fuse Holders
DC Power Supply Input <1> DC Power Supply Input <1>
Fuse Fuse Holder Fuse Fuse Holder
Drive Model Drive Model
CIMR-L Rated CIMR-L Rated
Short-circuit Short-circuit
Type Breaking Qty. Type Qty. Type Breaking Qty. Type Qty.
Current (kA) Current (kA)
200 V Class 400 V Class
20008 40005
CR2LS-50
20011 2 CM-1A 1 40006 CR6L-50 2 CMS-4 2
20018 CR2LS-100 40009
20025 CR2L-125 40015
CR6L-75
20033 CR2L-150 2 CM-2A 1 40018
20047 CR2L-175 40024 CR6L-100 2 CMS-5 2
20060 CR2L-225 40031
100 CR6L-150 100
20075 CR2L-260 40039
20085 CR2L-300 40045 CR6L-200
20115 CR2L-350 40060
CR6L-250
20145 CR2L-400 40075
2 <2>
20180 CR2L-450 40091 CR6L-300
2 <2>
20215 40112 CR6L-350
CR2L-600
20283 40150 CR6L-400
20346 CS5F-800 40180
200 CS5F-600 200
20415 CS5F-1200 40216
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 423
D.2 European Standards
A D C
U/T1 U
V/T2 V
M
W/T3 W
E
A – Drive D – Metal conduit
B – 10 m max cable length between drive and motor E – Ground wire should be as short as possible.
C – Motor
Figure D.3 Installation Method
5. Make sure the ground conductor complies with technical standards and local safety rules. When an EMC filter is
installed, the leakage current exceeds 3.5 mA. Therefore according to IEC/EN 61800-5-1, at least one of the
conditions below must be satisfied:
a) The cross-section of the protective earthing conductor must be at least 10 mm2 (Cu) or 16 mm2 (Al).
b) The power supply must be disconnected automatically in case of discontinuity of the protective earthing
conductor.
Figure D.4
C B
A – Braided shield cable C – Cable clamp (conductive)
B – Metal panel
Figure D.4 Ground Area
6. Connect an AC or DC reactor to minimize harmonic distortion.
424 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.2 European Standards
L3
L2 Make sure the ground wire is grounded
L1
PE
Enclosure panel
Metal plate
Grounding surface
(remove any paint or sealant)
YEG
L3 L2 L1
Drive
Ground plate
(scrape off any visible paint)
Figure D.5 EMC Filter and Drive Installation for CE Compliance (Three-Phase 200 V / 400 V Class)
Compliance
Standards
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 425
D.2 European Standards
EMC Filters
Install the drive with the EMC filters below to comply with the IEC/EN 61800-3 and IEC/EN 12015 requirements.
Note: If the Safe Disable function of the drive is part of the safety concept of a machine or installation and used for a safe stop
according to EN 60204-1, stop category 0, use these filters recommended by Yaskawa. For all other EMC filters, additional
measurements must be performed to prove EMC compatibility. This also applies when using the safe disable function in one
motor contactor installations as described in Safe Disable Input Function on page 438.
Manufacturer: Schaffner
Table D.2 IEC/EN 61800-3 Filters (Manufacturer: Schaffner)
Filter Data (Manufacturer: Schaffner)
Model Dimensions
CIMR-L Type Rated Current Weight YxX
[W x D x H] Figure
(A) (kg) (mm)
(mm)
Three-Phase 200 V Class
20008
FS5972-18-07 18 1.3 141 330 46 115 313
20011
20018
FS5972-35-07 35 2.1 206 50 355 175 336 1
20025
20033
FS5972-60-07 60 4.0 236 65 408 205 390
20047
20060
FS5972-100-35 100 3.4 90 150 330 65 255
20075
20185
FS5972-170-40 170 6.0 120 170 451 102 365 2
20115
20145
FS5972-250-37 250 11.7 130240 610 90 498
20180
20215
FS5972-410-99 410 10.5 260 115 386 235 120
20283
3
20346
FS5972-600-99 600 11 260 135 386 235 120
20415
Three-Phase 400 V Class
40005
FS5972-10-07 10 1.2 141 330 46 115 313
40006
40009 FS5972-18-07 18 1.3 141 46 330 115 313
40015
40018 FS5972-35-07 35 2.1 206 50 355 175 336 1
40024
40031
40039 FS5972-60-07 60 4 236 65 408 202 390
40045
40060
FS5972-100-35 100 3.4 90 150 330 65 255 2
40075
40091
40112 FS5972-170-35 170 6.0 120 170 451 102 365
2
40150
40180 FS5972-250-37 250 11.7 130 240 610 90 498
40216 FS5972-410-99 410 10.5 260 115 386 235 120 3
426 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.2 European Standards
Figure D.6
PE
Recommended torque: 26 - 30Nm / PE: 15 - 17Nm
L1 L2 L3
LINE
L1 L2 L3
LINE
ZSNFS5972-250-37
ZSN3x480/275V 50/60Hz
250A@45°C 25/100/21
LINE
FS 5972 - 60 - 07
3x480/275VAC 50/60Hz
60A@45°C 25/100/21
MADE IN ........
H
X
X
LOAD
ZSN1234567 / 01 / 0840R
LOAD
L1' L2' L3'
LOAD
L1' L2' L3'
Recommended torque: 26 - 30Nm / PE: 15 - 17Nm
PE
L1
L2
L3
L1
L2
L3 L2 L1
X
LINE
PE
L3 L2 L1
LINE
3x520/300VAC 50/60Hz 600A@45??C 25/100/21
FS 5972 - 600 - 99
HIGH LEAKAGE CURRENT
first connect to earth!
MADE IN SWITZERLAND
R
H
YYWWR
LOAD
X
PE
LOAD
L3' L2' L1'
Y
Drive Side (LOAD)
W
Figure 3
Figure D.6 EMC Filter Dimensions
Manufacturer: Block
Table D.3 IEC/EN 61800-3 Filters (Manufacturer: Block)
Filter Data (Manufacturer: Block)
Model Dimensions
CIMR-L Weight
Type Rated Current (A) [W x D x H] YxX Figure
(kg)
(mm)
Three-Phase 200 V Class
20008
FB-40014A 12 2.4 140 50 301 120 285
20011 1
20018 FB-40025A 25 3.0 140 55 301 120 285
20025
20033 FB-40060A 60 4.5 85 135 310 60 255
20047
20060 FB-40072A 72 4.7 85 135 310 60 255
20075 FB-40105A 105 5.3 95 150 325 65 255 2
Compliance
20085
Standards
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 427
D.2 European Standards
W H W
D
D
H
X
Y Y
W
Y
X
Figure 1
Figure 2
H H
D
W W
Y
X X
YEG
Figure 3 Figure 4
428 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
2.1 to 2.3
M4
Standards
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 429
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
For Asia <1> For U.S.A <2> For Europe and China <3>
Tightening
Model Terminal Recommended Applicable Recommended Applicable Recommended Applicable Screw Torque
CIMR-L Gauge Gauge Gauge Gauge Gauge Gauge Size
Nm (lb.in.)
mm2 mm2 AWG, kcmil AWG, kcmil mm2 mm2
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 14 14 6 8 to 6 10 6 to 16
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 8 to 14 8 8 to 6 10 6 to 16 2.1 to 2.3
M4
20033 –, +1, +2 14 14 – 6 – 16 (18.6 to 20.4)
<4>
B1, B2 5.5 3.5 to 5.5 – 12 to 10 – 4 to 6
2.0 to 2.5
5.5 5.5 to 8 8 10 to 8 10 6 to 10 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 22 14 to 22 4 6 to 4 16 16 to 25
5.4 to 6.0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 14 to 22 4 6 to 4 16 16 to 25 M6
(47.8 to 53.1)
–, +1, +2 22 14 to 22 – 6 to 4 – 16 to 25
20047 2.7 to 3.0
B1, B2 14 5.5 to 14 – 10 to 6 – 6 to 10 M5
(23.9 to 26.6)
5.4 to 6.0
8 8 to 14 6 8 to 6 16 10 to 16 M6
(47.8 to 53.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 30 22 to 30 3 4 to 3 25 16 to 25
9.9 to 11.0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 22 14 to 30 3 4 to 3 16 16 to 25 M8
(87.6 to 97.4)
–, +1, +2 30 22 to 30 – 4 to 3 – 25
20060 2.7 to 3.0
B1, B2 14 8 to 14 – 8 to 6 – 10 to 16 M5
(23.9 to 26.6)
5.4 to 6.0
8 8 to 22 6 6 to 4 16 16 to 25 M6
(47.8 to 53.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 38 30 to 38 2 3 to 2 35 25 to 35
9.9 to 11.0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 30 22 to 38 2 3 to 2 25 25 to 35 M8
(87.6 to 97.4)
–, +1, +2 38 30 to 38 – 3 to 2 – 25 to 35
20075 2.7 to 3.0
B1, B2 14 14 – 6 – 16 M5
(23.9 to 26.6)
5.4 to 6.0
14 14 to 22 6 6 to 4 16 16 to 25 M6
(47.8 to 53.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 38 30 to 50 1/0 3 to 1/0 35 25 to 50
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 38 30 to 50 1/0 3 to 1/0 35 25 to 50
20085 –, +1 60 38 to 60 – 2 to 1/0 – 35 to 50 9 to 11
M8
<5> (79.7 to 97.4)
B1, B2 22 14 to 50 – 6 to 1/0 – 16 to 50
14 14 to 38 6 6 to 4 16 16 to 25
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 60 50 to 60 2/0 1 to 2/0 50 35 to 70
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 60 50 to 60 2/0 1 to 2/0 50 35 to 70 18 to 23
M10
20115 –, +1 80 60 to 80 – 1/0 to 3/0 – 50 to 70 (159 to 204)
<5>
B1, B2 30 22 to 60 – 4 to 2/0 – 25 to 70
9 to 11
22 22 to 38 4 4 25 25 M8
(79.7 to 97.4)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 80 60 to 100 4/0 2/0 to 4/0 70 50 to 95
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 80 60 to 100 4/0 3/0 to 4/0 70 50 to 95 18 to 23
20145 –, +1 50 2P 50 to 100 – 1 to 4/0 – 35 to 95 (159 to 204)
<5>
M10
+3 60 50 to 100 – 1/0 to 4/0 – 50 to 95
9 to 11
22 22 to 60 4 4 to 2 35 25 to 35
(79.7 to 97.4)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 100 80 to 100 1/0 2P 1/0 to 2/0 95 70 to 95
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 50 2P 50 to 60 1/0 2P 1/0 to 2/0 95 70 to 95 18 to 23
20180 –, +1 50 2P 50 to 100 – 1 to 4/0 – 35 to 95 (159 to 204)
<5>
M10
+3 80 60 to 100 – 1/0 to 4/0 – 50 to 95
9 to 11
22 22 to 60 4 4 to 1/0 50 25 to 50
(79.7 to 97.4)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 80 2P 38 to 150 3/0 2P 3/0 to 300 95 2P 95 to 150
32 to 40
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 80 2P 38 to 150 3/0 2P 3/0 to 300 95 2P 95 to 150 M12
(283 to 354)
20215 –, +1 80 2P 80 to 150 – 3/0 to 300 – 70 to 150
<5>
18 to 23
+3 80 2P 30 to 150 – 2 to 300 – 35 to 150 M10
(159 to 204)
32 to 40
22 22 to 150 3 3 to 300 95 95 to 150 M12
(283 to 354)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 80 2P 70 to 150 4/0 2P 3/0 to 300 95 2P 95 to 150
32 to 40
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 80 2P 70 to 200 3/0 2P 3/0 to 300 95 2P 95 to 150 M12
(283 to 354)
20283 –, +1 150 2P 80 to 150 – 3/0 to 300 – 70 to 150
<5>
18 to 23
+3 80 2P 80 to 150 – 3/0 to 300 – 70 to 150 M10
(159 to 204)
32 to 40
38 38 to 150 2 2 to 300 95 95 to 150 M12
(283 to 354)
430 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
For Asia <1> For U.S.A <2> For Europe and China <3>
Tightening
Model Recommended Applicable Recommended Applicable Recommended Applicable Screw
CIMR-L Terminal Size
Torque
Gauge Gauge Gauge Gauge Gauge Gauge Nm (lb.in.)
mm2 mm2 AWG, kcmil AWG, kcmil mm2 mm2
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 100 2P 80 to 325 250 2P 4/0 to 600 240 95 to 300
32 to 40
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 100 2P 80 to 325 4/0 2P 4/0 to 600 240 95 to 300 M12
(283 to 354)
20346 –, +1 150 2P 125 to 325 – 250 to 600 – 125 to 300
<5>
18 to 23
+3 80 2P 80 to 325 – 3/0 to 600 – 70 to 300 M10
(159 to 204)
32 to 40
38 38 to 200 1 1 to 350 120 120 to 240 M12
(283 to 354)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 125 2P 100 to 325 350 2P 250 to 600 120 2P 95 to 300
32 to 40
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 125 2P 125 to 325 300 2P 300 to 600 300 95 to 300 M12
(283 to 354)
20415 –, +1 200 2P 150 to 325 – 300 to 600 – 150 to 300
<5>
18 to 23
+3 100 2P 80 to 325 – 3/0 to 600 – 70 to 300 M10
(159 to 204)
32 to 40
60 60 to 200 1 1 to 350 120 120 to 240 M12
(283 to 354)
–, +1, +2 14 14 – 6 – 6 to 16
Standards
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 431
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
For Asia <1> For U.S.A <2> For Europe and China <3>
Tightening
Model Terminal Recommended Applicable Recommended Applicable Recommended Applicable Screw Torque
CIMR-L Gauge Gauge Gauge Gauge Gauge Gauge Size
Nm (lb.in.)
mm2 mm2 AWG, kcmil AWG, kcmil mm2 mm2
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 14 14 to 22 6 6 to 4 16 16 to 25
5.4 to 6.0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 14 to 22 6 6 to 4 16 16 to 25 M6
(47.8 to 53.1)
–, +1, +2 14 14 to 22 – 6 to 4 – 16 to 25
40039 2.7 to 3.0
B1, B2 8 5.5 to 8 – 10 to 8 – 6 to 10 M5
(23.9 to 26.6)
5.4 to 6.0
8 8 to 14 6 8 to 6 16 10 to 16 M6
(47.8 to 53.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 14 14 4 6 to 4 16 10 to 16
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 14 4 6 to 4 16 10 to 16
40045 –, +1 22 14 to 38 – 6 to 1 – 16 to 35 9 to 11
M8
<4> (79.7 to 97.4)
B1, B2 14 8 to 14 – 8 to 4 – 10 to 16
8 8 to 14 6 8 to 6 16 10 to 16
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 22 14 to 22 3 4 to 3 16 16 to 25
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 22 14 to 22 3 4 to 3 25 16 to 25
40060 –, +1 30 22 to 38 – 4 to 1 – 25 to 35 9 to 11
M8
<4> (79.7 to 97.4)
B1, B2 14 14 to 22 – 6 to 3 – 16 to 25
14 14 to 22 6 6 16 16 to 25
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 30 22 to 60 2 3 to 1/0 25 16 to 50
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 30 22 to 60 2 3 to 1/0 25 25 to 50
40075 –, +1 38 30 to 60 – 3 to 1/0 – 25 to 50 9 to 11
M8
<4> (79.7 to 97.4)
+3 22 14 to 60 – 6 to 1/0 – 16 to 50
22 14 to 22 4 6 to 4 16 16 to 25
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 38 30 to 60 1/0 2 to 1/0 35 25 to 50
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 38 30 to 60 1 2 to 1/0 35 25 to 50
40091 –, +1 60 30 to 60 – 3 to 1/0 – 25 to 50 9 to 11
M8
<4> (79.7 to 97.4)
+3 30 22 to 60 – 4 to 1/0 – 25 to 50
22 14 to 22 4 6 to 4 16 16 to 25
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 60 38 to 100 3/0 1/0 to 4/0 50 35 to 95
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 60 60 to 100 2/0 1/0 to 4/0 50 35 to 95
40112 –, +1 100 60 to 100 – 1/0 to 4/0 – 50 to 95 18 to 23
M10
<4> (159 to 204)
+3 50 30 to 100 – 3 to 4/0 – 25 to 95
22 22 4 4 25 25
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 80 60 to 100 4/0 3/0 to 4/0 70 50 to 95
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 80 80 to 100 4/0 3/0 to 4/0 70 70 to 95
40150 18 to 23
–, +1 50 2P 50 to 100 – 1 to 4/0 – 35 to 95 M10
<4> (159 to 204)
+3 60 50 to 100 – 1/0 to 4/0 – 50 to 95
22 22 to 30 4 4 to 2 35 25 to 35
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 150 30 to 150 300 2 to 300 95 35 to 95
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 150 30 to 150 300 2 to 300 95 35 to 95
40180 18 to 23
–, +1 80 2P 38 to 150 – 1 to 250 – 35 to 150 M10
<4> (159 to 204)
+3 80 22 to 80 – 3 to 3/0 – 25 to 70
22 22 to 150 4 4 to 300 50 50 to 150
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 150 38 to 325 400 1 to 600 120 95 to 300
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 150 38 to 325 400 1/0 to 600 120 95 to 300
40216 18 to 23
–, +1 200 80 to 325 – 3/0 to 600 – 70 to 300 M10
<4> (159 to 204)
+3 125 38 to 325 – 1 to 325 – 35 to 300
22 22 to 200 2 2 to 350 70 70 to 240
432 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
<1> Codes refer to a set of three crimp terminals and three insulation caps. Prepare input and output wiring using two sets for each connection.
Example 1: Models with 300 kcmil for both input and output require one set for input terminals and one set for output terminals, so the user
should order two sets of [100-051-272].
Example 2: Models with 4/0 AWG 2P for both input and output require two sets for input terminals and two sets for output terminals, so the
user should order four sets of [100-051-560].
Note: Use crimp insulated terminals or insulated shrink tubing for wiring connections. Wires should have a continuous maximum
allowable temperature of 75C 600 Vac UL-approved vinyl-sheathed insulation.
Compliance
Standards
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 433
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
<1> Maximum MCCB Rating is 15 A, or 200% of drive input current rating, whichever is larger. MCCB voltage rating must be 600 Vac or greater.
<2> Maximum Time Delay fuse is 175% of drive input current rating. This covers any Class CC, J or T class fuse.
<3> Maximum Non-time Delay fuse is 300% of drive input current rating. This covers any CC, J or T class fuse.
<4> When using semiconductor fuses, Bussmann FWH and FWP are required for UL compliance. Select FWH for 200 V Class and 400 V Class
models and FWP fuses for 600 V models.
<5> Class L fuse is also approved for this rating.
434 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
CSA B44.1 /
ASME A17.5
Figure D.10 CSA B44.1-04/ASME A17.5-2004 Mark
Compliance
Standards
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 435
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
When connecting the drive to more than one motor for simultaneous operation, disable the electronic overload protection
(L1-01 = 0) and wire each motor with its own motor thermal overload relay.
Enable the motor overload protection (L1-01 = 1 to 3, 5) when connecting the drive to a single motor, unless another
motor overload preventing device is installed. The drive electronic thermal overload function causes an oL1 fault, which
shuts off the output of the drive and prevents additional overheating of the motor. The motor temperature is continually
calculated while the drive is powered up.
436 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
10
7
3
Cold start
(Characteristics when an overload occurs
1 at a complete stop)
0.4
Hot start
(Characteristics when an overload occurs
during continuous operation at 100%)
0.1
Motor current (%)
0 100 150 200
E2-01 = 100% motor current
Figure D.11 Protection Operation Time for General Purpose Motors at the Rated Output Frequency
Setting Description
0 Ramp to Stop
1 Coast to Stop
2 Fast-Stop
3 Alarm Only (default setting)
Setting Description
0 Ramp to Stop
1 Coast to Stop (default setting)
2 Fast-Stop
Compliance
Standards
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 437
D.4 Safe Disable Input Function
Safety Standards
The TUV mark indicates compliance with safety standards.
Figure D.12
Specifications
The Safe Disable inputs provide a stop function in compliance with “Safe Torque Off” as defined in the IEC/EN 61800-
5-2. Safe Disable inputs have been designed to meet the requirements of the ISO/EN 13849-1 and IEC/EN 61508.
A Safe Disable Status Monitor for error detection in the safety circuit is also provided.
Table D.12 Specifications for Safe Disable Function
• Inputs: 2
Safe Disable inputs H1, H2
Signal ON level: 18 to 28 Vdc
Inputs / Outputs
Signal OFF level: -4 to 4 Vdc
• Outputs: 1
Safe Disable Monitor output EDM (DM+, DM-)
CIMR-LA: less than 1 ms
Response Time from Input Open to Drive Output Stop
CIMR-LF: less than 3 ms
Response Time from Input Open of H1 and H2 Terminals to CIMR-LA: less than 1 ms
EDM CIMR-LF: less than 4 ms
CIMR-LA: PFD = 5.15E-5
Demand Rate Low
CIMR-LF: PFD = 8.14E-6
Failure Probability
Demand Rate High or CIMR-LA: PFH = 1.2E-9
Continuous CIMR-LF: PFH = 1.96E-9
The Safe Disable inputs satisfy the following requirements (DC from EDM considered)
Performance Level CIMR-LA: Performance Level (PL) d according to ISO/EN 13849-1
CIMR-LF: Performance Level (PL) e according to ISO/EN 13849-1
HFT (Hardware Fault Tolerance) N=1
Classification of Subsystem Type B
438 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.4 Safe Disable Input Function
Precautions
DANGER! Sudden Movement Hazard. Improper use of the Safe Disable function will result in serious injury or death. Make sure the
entire system or machinery uses the Safe Disable function in compliance with safety requirements. When implementing the Safe
Disable function into the safety system of a machine, a thorough risk assessment and validation for the whole system must be carried
out to ensure it complies with relevant safety norms (e.g., ISO/EN 13849, IEC/EN 61508, IEC/EN 62061).
DANGER! Sudden Movement Hazard. When using a PM motor, even if the drive output is shut off by the Safe Disable function, a
break down of two output transistors can cause current to flow through the motor winding, resulting in a rotor movement for a
maximum angle of 180 degrees (electrically). Ensure this condition will not affect the safety of the application when using the Safe
Disable function. Failure to comply will result in death or serious injury.
DANGER! Electrical Shock Hazard. The Safe Disable function can switch off the drive output, but does not cut the drive power supply
and cannot electrically isolate the drive output from the input. Always shut off the drive power supply when performing maintenance or
installations on the drive input side as well as the drive output side. Failure to comply will result in death or serious injury.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. If the motor is subjected to an external force, use a mechanical brake that meets the safety
requirements of entire system or machinery to stop the machine connected to the load. The motor will move when an external
gravitational force in the vertical axis is applied even if the Safety Disable function is in operation. Failure to comply may result in
serious injury or death.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Connect the Safe Disable inputs to the devices in compliance with safety requirements.
Failure to comply will result in death or serious injury.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. When using the Safe Disable inputs, make sure to remove the wire links between terminals
H1, H2, and HC that were installed prior to shipment. Failing to do so will keep the Safe Disable circuit from operating properly and can
cause injury or even death.
WARNING! All safety features (including Safe Disable) should be inspected daily and periodically. If the system is not operating
normally, there is a risk of serious personal injury.
WARNING! Only a qualified technician with a thorough understanding of the drive, the instruction manual, and safety standards should
be permitted to wire, inspect, and maintain the Safe Disable input. Failure to comply may result in serious injury or death.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. The logic of terminals DM+/DM- is inverted between drive models CIMR-LA and CIMR-
LF. Check all wiring to ensure that the sequence is correct after installing the drive and connecting any other devices. Improper
wiring connections could result in death or serious injury.
NOTICE: From the moment terminal inputs H1 and H2 have opened, it takes up to 1 ms for the drive output of models CIMR-LA
to shut off completely, or up to 3 ms for the drive output of models CIMR-LF to shut off completely. The sequence set up to
trigger terminals H1 and H2 should confirm that both terminals remain open for at least 1 ms in order to properly interrupt the drive
output of models CIMR-LA, or for at least 3 ms in order to properly interrupt the drive output of models CIMR-LF. This may
result in the Safe Disable Input not activating.
NOTICE: The Safe Disable Monitor (output terminals DM+ and DM-) should not be used for any other purpose than to monitor the
Safe Disable status or to discover a malfunction in the Safe Disable inputs. The monitor output is not considered a safe output.
NOTICE: When utilizing the Safe Disable function, use only the EMC filters recommended in EMC Filter Installation on page 424.
Compliance
Standards
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 439
D.4 Safe Disable Input Function
Main Power
24 Vdc Control
Safety Relay or PLC HC Circuit
with safety functionality
Safety Jumper S3
Outputs Setting:
Feedback
SOURCE
H1 Gate Block 1
N Power Module P
H2 Gate Block 2
DM+
>=1
DM-
Drive
Motor coasts
Output to stop
Frequency
440 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.4 Safe Disable Input Function
external device, disconnection of the external wiring, short circuit in the external wiring, or a failure in the drive. Find the
cause and correct the problem.
• In normal operation, confirm the EDM signal by referring to Table D.13.
D
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 441
D.5 EN81-1 Conform Circuit with one Motor Contactor
Safety Chain
Circuit
Elevator Controller
K01
24 Vdc
K1
Drive H1 H2 HC Up/Down;
Speed selection; ...
K2
M
Note: 1. The drive output will immediately shut off when either of the inputs H1 or H2 is opened. In this case the brake should apply
immediately in order to prevent uncontrolled movement of the elevator.
2. Terminals H1 or H2 must be closed prior to setting the Up/Down command.
442 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Appendix: E
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 443
E.1 Drive and Motor Specifications
Items Value
Model CIMR-L
Serial Number
Motor Specifications
Induction Motor
Interface Resolution
444 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
E.2 Basic Parameter Settings
Basic Setup
Item Setting Value Memo Item Setting Value Memo
Control Mode A1-02 = Up/Down Command Selection b1-02 =
Speed Reference Selection
Speed Reference Selection b1-01 = d1-18 =
Mode
Motor Setup
Item Setting Value Memo Item Setting Value Memo
Motor Rated Current E2-01 = Number of Motor Poles E2-04 =
Induction
Motor Rated Slip E2-02 = Motor Line-to-Line Resistance E2-05 =
Motor
Motor No-Load Current E2-03 = Motor Leakage Inductance E2-06 =
Motor Rated Power E5-02 = Motor q-Axis Inductance E5-07 =
Motor Rated Current E5-03 = Motor Induction Volt. Const.1 E5-09 =
PM Motor Motor Poles E5-04 = Encoder Offset E5-11 =
Motor Stator Resistance E5-05 = Motor Induction Volt. Const. 2 E5-24 =
Motor d-Axis Inductance E5-06 = Encoder Resolution F1-01 =
Analog Inputs
Terminal Input Used Setting Value and Function Name Memo
A1 H3-02 =
A2 H3-10 =
Monitor Outputs
Quick Reference
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 445 E
E.2 Basic Parameter Settings
446 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
E.3 User Setting Table
User User
No. Name Setting No. Name Setting
A1-00 Language Selection C5-01 Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain 1
A1-01 Access Level Selection C5-02 Speed Control Loop Integral Time 1
A1-02 Control Method Selection C5-03 Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain 2
A1-03 Initialize Parameters C5-04 Speed Control Loop Integral Time 2
A1-04 Password C5-06 Speed Control Loop Primary Delay Time Constant
A1-05 Password Setting C5-07 Speed Control Loop Settings Switching Speed
A2-01 to C5-08 Speed Control Loop Integral Limit
User Parameters, 1 to 32
A2-32 C5-13 Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain 3
A2-33 User Parameter Automatic Selection C5-14 Speed Control Loop Integral Time 3
b1-01 Speed Reference Selection C5-16 Speed Control Loop Delay Time during Position Lock
b1-02 Up/Down Command Selection C5-17 Motor Inertia
b1-03 Stopping Method Selection C5-18 Load Inertia Ratio
b1-06 Digital Input Reading Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain Time during
C5-19
Up/Down Command Selection while in Programming Position Lock
b1-08
Mode C5-20 Speed Control Loop Integral Time during Position Lock
b1-14 Phase Order Selection C5-50 Set Vibrational Frequency Filter
b2-08 Magnetic Flux Compensation Value C6-03 Carrier Frequency
b4-01 Timer Function On-Delay Time C6-06 PWM Method
b4-02 Timer Function Off-Delay Time C6-09 Carrier Frequency during Rotational Auto-Tuning
b6-01 Dwell Speed at Start C6-21 Inspection Operation Carrier Frequency
b6-02 Dwell Time at Start C6-23 Carrier Frequency during Initial Motor Pole Search
b6-03 Dwell Speed at Stop C6-31 Carrier Frequency during Rescue Operation
b6-04 Dwell Time at Stop d1-01 Speed Reference 1
b7-01 Droop Control Gain d1-02 Speed Reference 2
b7-02 Droop Control Delay Time. d1-03 Speed Reference 3
b8-01 Energy Saving Control Selection d1-04 Speed Reference 4
b8-16 Energy Saving Control Constant (Ki) d1-05 Speed Reference 5
b8-17 Energy Saving Control Constant (Kt) d1-06 Speed Reference 6
C1-01 Acceleration Ramp 1 d1-07 Speed Reference 7
C1-02 Deceleration Ramp 1 d1-08 Speed Reference 8
C1-03 Acceleration Ramp 2 d1-18 Speed Reference Selection Mode
C1-04 Deceleration Ramp 2 d1-19 Nominal Speed
C1-05 Acceleration Ramp 3 (Motor 2 Accel Time 1) d1-20 Intermediate Speed 1
C1-06 Deceleration Ramp 3 (Motor 2 Decel Time 1) d1-21 Intermediate Speed 2
C1-07 Acceleration Ramp 4 (Motor 2 Accel Time 2) d1-22 Intermediate Speed 3
C1-08 Deceleration Ramp 4 (Motor 2 Decel Time 2) d1-23 Releveling Speed
C1-09 Emergency Stop Ramp d1-24 Inspection Operation Speed
C1-10 Accel/Decel Setting Resolution d1-25 Rescue Operation Speed
C1-11 Accel/Decel Switching Speed d1-26 Leveling Speed
C1-12 Motor 2 Acceleration Time d1-27 Motor 2 Speed Reference
C1-13 Motor 2 Deceleration Time d1-28 Leveling Speed Detection Level
C1-15 Inspection Deceleration Ramp d1-29 Inspection Speed Detection Level
C2-01 Jerk at Accel Start d6-03 Field Forcing Selection
C2-02 Jerk at Accel End d6-06 Field Forcing Limit
C2-03 Jerk at Decel Start E1-01 Input Voltage Setting
C2-04 Jerk at Decel End E1-03 V/f Pattern Selection
C2-05 Jerk below Leveling Speed E1-04 Maximum output speed
C3-01 Slip Compensation Gain E1-05 Maximum Voltage
C3-02 Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time E1-06 Base Frequency
C3-03 Slip Compensation Limit E1-07 Middle Output Frequency
C3-04 Slip Compensation Selection during Regeneration E1-08 Middle Output Frequency Voltage
C3-05 Output Voltage Limit Operation Selection E1-09 Minimum Output Frequency
C4-01 Torque Compensation Gain E1-10 Minimum Output Frequency Voltage
C4-02 Torque Compensation Primary Delay Time E1-11 Middle Output Frequency 2
C4-03 Torque Compensation at Forward Start E1-12 Middle Output Frequency Voltage 2
C4-04 Torque Compensation at Reverse Start E1-13 Base Voltage
C4-05 Torque Compensation Time Constant E2-01 Motor Rated Current
447 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
E.3 User Setting Table
E3-06 Motor 2 Base Frequency F6-06 Torque Limit Selection from Comm. Option
E3-08 Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency Voltage F6-35 CANopen Node ID Selection
E3-10 Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency Voltage H1-03 Terminal S3 Function Selection
E5-05 Motor Stator Resistance (Single Phase) H2-05 Terminal P2-C2 Function Selection (photocoupler)
E5-24 Motor Induction Voltage Constant 2 H3-09 Terminal A2 Signal Level Selection
F1-02 Operation Selection at PG Open Circuit (PGo) H3-11 Terminal A2 Gain Setting
F1-04 Operation Selection at Deviation H3-13 Analog Input Filter Time Constant
F1-06 PG 1 Pulse Monitor Output Division Ratio H3-17 Offset for Terminal A2
F1-11 Excessive Speed Deviation Detection Delay Time H4-04 Terminal AM Monitor Selection
F1-20 PG Option Card Disconnect Detection 1 H4-08 Terminal AM Signal Level Selection
F1-52 Communication Speed of Serial Encoder Selection H5-04 Stopping Method After Communication Error (CE)
448 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
E.3 User Setting Table
User User
No. Name Setting No. Name Setting
L3-01 Stall Prevention Selection during Acceleration n8-35 Initial Rotor Position Detection Selection
L3-02 Stall Prevention Level during Acceleration n8-36 High Frequency Injection Level
L3-05 Stall Prevention Selection during Run n8-37 High Frequency Injection Amplitude
L3-06 Stall Prevention Level during Run n8-62 Output Voltage Limit
L4-01 Speed Agreement Detection Level n8-81 High Frequency Injection during Rescue Operation
L4-02 Speed Agreement Detection Width High Frequency Injection Amplitude during Rescue
n8-82
L4-03 Speed Agreement Detection Level (+/-) Operation
L4-04 Speed Agreement Detection Width (+/-) n8-84 Polarity Detection Current
L4-05 Speed Reference Loss Detection Selection n8-86 Magnet Pole Search Error Detection Selection
L4-06 Speed Reference at Reference Loss n9-60 A/D Conversion Start Delay
L4-07 Speed Agree Detection Selection o1-01 Drive Mode Unit Monitor Selection
L4-13 Door Zone Level o1-02 User Monitor Selection After Power Up
L5-01 Number of Auto Reset Attempts o1-03 Digital Operator Display Unit Selection
L5-02 Fault Output Operation during Auto Reset o1-04 V/f Pattern Setting Units
L6-04 Torque Detection Selection 2 o1-10 User-Set Display Units Maximum Value
L6-05 Torque Detection Level 2 o1-11 User-Set Display Units Decimal Display
L7-04 Reverse Regenerative Torque Limit o1-23 HBB Non Display Select
L7-16 Torque Limit Process at Start o2-01 LO/RE Key Function Selection
L8-03 Overheat Pre-Alarm Operation Selection o2-03 User Parameter Default Value
L8-05 Input Phase Loss Protection Selection o2-04 Drive Model Selection
L8-06 Input Phase Loss Detection Level o2-05 Speed Reference Setting Method Selection
L8-07 Output Phase Loss Protection Selection Operation Selection when Digital Operator is
o2-06
Disconnected
L8-09 Output Ground Fault Detection Selection
o3-01 Copy Function Selection
L8-10 Heatsink Cooling Fan Operation Selection
o3-02 Copy Allowed Selection
L8-11 Heatsink Cooling Fan Off Delay Time
o4-01 Cumulative Operation Time Setting
L8-12 Ambient Temperature Setting
o4-02 Cumulative Operation Time Selection
L8-15 oL2 Characteristics Selection at Low Speeds
o4-03 Cooling Fan Operation Time Setting
L8-27 Overcurrent Detection Gain
o4-05 Capacitor Maintenance Setting
L8-29 Current Unbalance Detection (LF2)
o4-07 DC Bus Pre-charge Relay Maintenance Setting
L8-35 Installation Selection
o4-09 IGBT Maintenance Setting
L8-38 Automatic Torque Boost Selection
o4-11 U2, U3 Initialization
L8-39 Reduced Carrier Frequency
o4-12 kWh Monitor Initialization
L8-55 Internal Braking Transistor Protection
o4-13 Number of Travels Counter Reset
L8-62 Operation Selection at Input Phase Loss
o4-15 Maintenance Alarm Snooze Period
L8-77 Oscillation Suppression
o4-16 Maintenance Monitoring Selection
L8-88 Safe Disable Operation Mode
S1-01 Zero Speed Level at Stop
L8-89 Current Monitoring Selection
S1-02 DC Injection Current at Start
L8-99 Current Monitoring Level
S1-03 DC Injection Current at Stop
n1-08 Leakage Current Vibration Control Selection
S1-04 DC Injection / Position Lock Time at Start
n2-01 Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Gain
S1-05 DC Injection / Position Lock Time at Stop
n2-02 Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Time Constant 1
S1-06 Brake Release Delay Time
n2-03 Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Time Constant 2
S1-07 Brake Close Delay Time
n5-01 Inertia Compensation Selection
S1-10 Run Command Delay Time
n5-02 Motor Acceleration Time
S1-11 Output Contactor Open Delay Time
n5-03 Inertia Compensation Gain
S1-12 Motor Contactor Control During Auto-Tuning Selection
n5-07 Speed Feedback Compensation Selection
S1-26 Emergency Stop Start Level
n5-08 Speed Feedback Compensation Gain (P)
S2-01 Motor Rated Speed
n6-01 Online Tuning Selection
S2-02 Slip Compensation Gain in Motoring Mode
n6-05 Online Tuning Gain
S2-03 Slip Compensation Gain in Regenerative Mode
n8-01 Initial Polarity Estimation Current
S2-05 Slip Compensation Torque Detection Delay Time
n8-02 Pole Attraction Current
S2-06 Slip Compensation Torque Detection Filter Time Constant
n8-29 q-Axis Current Control Gain during Normal Operation
S3-01 Position Lock Gain at Start 1
q-Axis Current Control Integral Time during Normal
Quick Reference
d-Axis Current Control Integral Time during Normal S3-04 Position Lock Bandwidth
n8-33
Operation S3-10 Starting Torque Compensation Increase Time
Sheet
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 449 E
E.3 User Setting Table
S3-34 Anti-Rollback Torque Bias 1 Rotation Direction for Auto-Tuning of PG-E3 Encoder
T2-19
Characteristics
S3-35 Anti-Rollback Torque Bias 2
Position Deviation Level to Apply Anti-Rollback Torque
S3-37
Bias 1
Position Deviation Level to Apply Anti-Rollback Torque
S3-38
Bias 2
S3-39 Anti-Rollback Integral Gain
S3-40 Anti-Rollback Movement Detection
S3-41 Position Lock Gain at Start Reduction
S4-01 Light Load Direction Search Selection
S4-02 Light Load Direction Search Method
S4-03 Light Load Direction Search Time
S4-04 Light Load Direction Search Speed Reference
S4-05 Rescue Operation Torque Limit
S4-06 Rescue Operation Power Supply Selection
S4-07 UPS Power
S4-08 UPS Operation Speed Limit Selection
S4-12 DC Bus Voltage during Rescue Operation
Rescue Operation Power Supply Deterioration Detection
S4-13
Level
S4-15 Speed Reference Selection at Rescue Operation
S5-01 Short Floor Operation Selection
S5-02 Nominal Speed for Short Floor Calculation
S5-03 Short Floor Minimum Constant Speed Time
S5-04 Distance Calculation Acceleration Time Gain
S5-05 Distance Calculation Deceleration Time Gain
S5-10 Stopping Method Selection
S5-11 Deceleration Distance
S5-12 Stop Distance
S5-13 Direct Landing Minimum Speed Level
Motor Contactor Response Error (SE1) Detection/Reset
S6-01
Selection
S6-02 Starting Current Error (SE2) Detection Delay Time
S6-03 SE2 Detect Current Level
S6-04 Output Current Error (SE3) Detection Delay Time
S6-05 Brake Response Error (SE4) Detection Time
S6-10 Overacceleration Detection Level
S6-11 Overacceleration Detection Time
S6-12 Overacceleration Detection Selection
S6-15 Speed Reference Loss Detection
S6-16 Restart after Baseblock Selection
T1-01 Auto-Tuning Mode Selection
T1-02 Motor Rated Power
T1-03 Motor Rated Voltage
T1-04 Motor Rated Current
T1-05 Motor Base Frequency
T1-06 Number of Motor Poles
T1-07 Motor Base Speed
T1-08 Encoder Resolution (pulses per revolution)
T1-09 Motor No-Load Current (Stationary Auto-Tuning 1 and 2)
T1-10 Motor Rated Slip (Stationary Auto-Tuning 2)
T2-01 Auto-Tuning Mode Selection
T2-04 Motor Rated Power
T2-05 Motor Rated Voltage
450 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Attachment for External Heatsink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
Automatic Torque Boost Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Auto-Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99, 101, 104
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 451
CE Low Voltage Directive Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422 Copy Error (ECE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
CE Mark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422 Copy Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
CF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Copy Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Changing Parameter Settings or Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Copy Function Errors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Checksum Error (ECS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 Copy Unit Error (CSEr) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Closed Loop Vector control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 CopyUnitManager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Closed Loop Vector control for PM motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 CPEr . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
CN5-A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 CPF00, CPF01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
CN5-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 CPF02. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
CN5-C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 CPF03. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Coast to Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 CPF06. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Cold Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 CPF07. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Command Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405 CPF08. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Command Messages from Master to Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 CPF20, CPF21 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Communication Error (iFEr) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 CPF22. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Communication Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416 CPF23. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Communication Fault Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 CPF24. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Communication Fault Detection Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 CPF25. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261
Communication Option Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 CPF26 to CPF35 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261
Communication Option Node ID Setting Error (CANopen) CPyE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
(AEr). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 CRC-16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .402
Communication Parity Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396 CRC-16 Checksum Calculation Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .402
Communication Speed of Serial Encoder Selection . . . . . . . . 179 CrST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Communication Speed Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396 CSEr . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Communications Enter Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 Cumulative Fan Operation Time as a Percentage
Communications Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 of the Specified Maintenance Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Comparing Parameter Settings (flashing) (vrFy) . . . . . . . . . . . 284 Cumulative Operation Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
Component Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Cumulative Operation Time of the Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Conducted Noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331 Cumulative Operation Time Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
Connecting a DC Reactor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Cumulative Time the Capacitors are Used as
Connecting a Noise Filter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331 a Percentage of the Specified Maintenance Period . . . . . . . . . .293
Connecting an AC Reactor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Current Detection Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Connecting Braking Units in Parallel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327 Current Detection Error (Er-12). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Connecting Peripheral Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315 Current Monitoring Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
Connecting the Drive and Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Current Monitoring Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
Connecting to a Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394 Current Unbalance Detection (LF2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
Connecting to a PC (USB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Cyclic Redundancy Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .402
Continuous Electrothermal Operation Selection . . . . . . . . . . . 205 D
Control Board Connection Error (CPF03) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Daily Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Control Board Connection Error (CPF23) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Daily Inspection Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Control Circuit Error (CPF00, CPF01) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Data Error (ErE). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
Control Circuit Error (CPF20, CPF21) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
d-Axis Current Control Gain during Normal Operation . . . . . .224
Control Circuit Error (CPF26 to CPF34) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
d-Axis Current Control Integral Time during Normal
Control Circuit Input Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Control Circuit Output Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
DC Bus Overvoltage (ov) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268, 275
Control Circuit Terminal Arrangement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
DC Bus Pre-charge Relay Maintenance Setting . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Control Circuit Terminal Block Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
DC Bus Undervoltage (Uv1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190, 270
Control Circuit Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
DC Bus Voltage during Rescue Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Control Fault (CF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
DC Injection Current at Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Control I/O Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
DC Injection Current at Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Control Method Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
DC Injection Gain in Motoring Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
Control Mode Dependent Parameter Default Values . . . . . . . . 386
DC Injection Gain in Regenerative Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
Control Mode Mismatch (CPEr) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
DC Injection Time at Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Control Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 94
DC Injection Time at Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Control Mode Selection Error (oPE06) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
DC Reactor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
Control Modes and their Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Deceleration Ramps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Control Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249, 384
Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection
Control Power Supply Voltage Fault (Uv2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
(o1-03) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
Control Terminal Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
Defaults by Drive Model Selection (o2-04). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .387
Cooling Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 30, 31
dEv . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261, 273
Cooling Fan Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
dEv Detection Condition Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
Cooling Fan Maintenance Time (LT-1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
dFPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Cooling Fan Operation Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
DI-A3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
Cooling Fan Operation Time Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
DI-A3 Option Card Data Length Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180
Cooling Fan Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
DI-A3 Option Card Input Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
CoPy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
DI-A3 Option Card Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
Copy Allowed Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
452 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Diagnosing and Resetting Faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285 Dynamic Braking Transistor Fault (rr). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Digital Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67, 314 E
Digital Input Card Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
E (G). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Digital Input Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
E3-01 (Motor 2 Control Mode) Dependent Parameters. . . . . . 386
Digital Input Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
ECE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Digital Input Sink / Source / External Power Supply
ECS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
EdE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 30, 31, 81
EEPROM Memory Data Error. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Digital Operator Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
EEPROM Write Error (Err) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
Digital Operator Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 441
EF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Digital Operator Installation Methods and Required Tools . . . . 41
EF0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273
Digital Operator Menu and Screen Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
EF3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273
Digital Operator Remote Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
EF4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273
Digital Operator Remote Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
EF5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273
Digital Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
EF6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273
Digital Output Card Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
EF7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273
Dimensions for IP20/NEMA Type 1 Enclosure
EF8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273
200 V Class . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43, 44
EiF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
DIP Switch S2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33, 72
Electrical Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Disabling and Enabling the Drive Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440
Elevator Emergency Stop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
DM- . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Elevator Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
DM+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Elevator units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
DO-A3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
EMC Filter and Drive Installation for CE Compliance . . . . . . 425
DO-A3 Option Card Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
EMC Filter Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
Door Zone Level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
EMC Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426
Door Zone Reached . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
EMC Guidelines Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
Drive Capacity Setting Fault (oPE01) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Emergency Stop (N.O., N.C.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
Emergency Stop Ramp. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Drive Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 31
Emergency Stop Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Drive Derating Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
Emergency Stop Start Level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Drive Does Not Allow Selection of Rotational
EN81-1 Conform Circuit with one Motor Contactor . . . . . . . . 442
Auto-Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Encoder 1 Resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Drive Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86, 87
Encoder 1 Rotation Direction Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Drive Model Mismatch (dFPS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Encoder Adjust 1 to 16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Drive Model Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Encoder Communication Data Error (oFC53) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Drive Motor Overload Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436
Encoder Communication Timeout (oFC52). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Drive Overload (oL2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
Encoder Disconnected (PGo) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269, 276
Drive Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Encoder Disconnected (PGoH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269, 276
Drive Ready . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Encoder Error (oFC54). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Drive Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
Encoder Feedback Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Drive Short-Circuit Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98, 101
Drive Slave Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
Encoder Offset for PM motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Drive Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
Encoder Option AD Conversion Error (oFC50) . . . . . . . . . . . 265
Drive Standard Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Encoder Option Analog Circuit Error (oFC51) . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Drive Transmit Wait Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397
Encoder Resolution Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Drive Unit Signal Fault (CPF24) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Encoder Rotation Direction Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Drive Watt Loss Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Encoder Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
DriveWizard Plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142, 314
Encoder Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Droop Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Encoder Z Pulse Fault (dv1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
During Baseblock (N.C.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Encoder Z-Pulse Offset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
During Baseblock (N.O.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
End . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
During Down Direction (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . 193
End1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
During Frequency Output (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . 194
End10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
During Regeneration (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . . . . . 194
End2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
During Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
End3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
During Torque Limit (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . . . . . 194
End4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
dv1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
End5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
dv2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
End6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
dv3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
End7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
dv3 Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
End8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
dv4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
End9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
dv4 Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Energy Saving Control Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
dv6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Energy Savings Constants Error (oPE16) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
dv7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Enter Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
dv8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Enter Command Necessary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
Dwell Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Enter Command not Necessary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
Dwell Speed, Dwell Time at Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 453
Enter Command Settings when Upgrading the Drive . . . . . . . 415 Ferrule Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Enter Command Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415 Ferrule Terminal Types and Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Enter Data from the Motor Nameplate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Ferrule-Type Wire Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Entering the "Safe Torque Off" State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440 Field Forcing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
EPE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 Flux Position Detection (sensor) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .385
Er-01. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 FM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Er-02. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Formula to Calculate the Amount of Voltage Drop . . . . . . . . . . .61
Er-03. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Forward Regenerative Torque Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Er-04. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Forward Torque Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Er-05. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Frequency Accuracy (Temperature Fluctuation) . . . . . . . . . . . .338
Er-08. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Frequency Control Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
Er-09. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Frequency Reference Selection 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Er-10. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Frequency Setting Resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
Er-11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Frequency Setting Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
Er-12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 FrL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Er-13. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Front Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29, 30, 31
Er-18. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Front Cover Screw . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30, 31
Er-19. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 F-Type Insulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Er-20. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Function Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .401
Er-21. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 Function Key (F1, F2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Er-22. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 Function Key 1 (F1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Er-23. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 Function Key 2 (F2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Er-24. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 Functions for Terminals S3 to S8. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
ErE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 Fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332
Err. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 G
Error Reading Data (rdEr) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
General Precautions when Using Thermal Overload Relays. . .333
Error Writing Data (CPyE). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
General Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Errors and Displays When Using the Copy Function . . . . . . . 258
GF. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
E-Type Insulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Ground Fault (GF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
European Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422
Ground Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
EvE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Ground Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Excessive Speed Deviation Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . . 177
Excessive Speed Deviation Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 H
Excessive V/f Setting (End1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 H1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Exterior and Mounting Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 H1/H2 Sink/Source Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
External 24 Vdc Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 H2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
External Digital Operator Connection Fault (oPr) . . . . . . . . . . 268 Hbb. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
External fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 HBB Non Display Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
External Fault (input terminal S3) (EF3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273 HbbF. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
External Fault (input terminal S4) (EF4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273 HC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
External Fault (input terminal S5) (EF5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273 HCA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
External Fault (input terminal S6) (EF6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273 Heatsink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29, 30, 31
External Fault (input terminal S7) (EF7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273 Heatsink Cooling Fan Operation Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
External Fault (input terminal S8) (EF8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273 Heatsink Overheat (oH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266, 275
External Fault from Communication Option Detection Heatsink Overheat (oH1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Heatsink Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
High Current Alarm (HCA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
F
High Frequency Injection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222
Fan Connector Cable (CN6). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
High Frequency Injection Amplitude . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Fan Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
High Frequency Injection Amplitude during Rescue
Fan Finger Guard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 30, 31, 304
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Fan Relay Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
High Frequency Injection during Rescue Operation . . . . . . . . .223
Fan Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31, 303
High Frequency Injection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222
Fault (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
High Speed Limit Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Fault Displays. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
High Speed Limit Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Fault History. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249, 382
High Speed Reference Has Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Fault Output Operation during Auto Restart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Hot Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Fault Relay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Humidity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Fault Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Hybrid IC Failure (CPF22) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Fault Reset Command Active (Multi-Function Digital
Outputs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 I
Fault Reset Methods. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286 ID Mismatch (EPE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
Fault Restart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 IEC/EN61800-3 C2 Filters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426, 427
Fault Trace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249, 381 iFEr. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
Fault Trace / History Register Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413 IG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Fault Trace Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413 IGBT Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
Faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254, 255 IGBT Maintenance Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
454 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
IGBT Maintenance Time (90%) (LT-4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 LCD Contrast Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
IGBT Maintenance Time (90%) (TrPC). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 LCD Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
IGBT Short Circuit (SC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 LCD Operator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
Induced Noise. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331 Display Unit Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Induced Voltage Constant Unit Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Monitor Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Inductance Error (Er-19) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Leakage Current Vibration Control Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Induction Voltage Error (Er-18) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Leakage Inductance Alarm (End6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Inertia Compensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120, 219 Leakage Inductance Error (Er-13) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Inertia Compensation Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 LED Check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
Inertia Compensation Gain. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 LED Operator
Initial Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Display Unit Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Initial Polarity Estimation Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Monitor Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Initial Rotor Pole Search Error (Er-22) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 Leveling Speed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Initial Rotor Position Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Leveling Speed Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Leveling Speed Reference Has Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Initialize Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141, 145, 228 LF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
Input Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336, 337 LF2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
Input Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332 Light Load Direction (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . 195
Input Phase Loss (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . . . . . . . . 195 Light Load Direction Search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Input Phase Loss (PF). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 Light Load Direction Search Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Input Phase Loss Protection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Line-to-Line Resistance Error (Er-04) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336, 337 LO/RE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84, 91
Input Voltage Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 LO/RE (LOCAL/REMOTE) Key Function Selection . . . . . . . 228
Input-Side Noise Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331 LO/RE LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291, 292 LO/RE Light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Inspection Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Load Inertia Ratio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Inspection Operation Carrier Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 LOCAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Inspection Operation Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Locations of Jumpers and Switches on the Terminal Board . . . 72
Inspection Operation Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Loopback Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403
Inspection Speed Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Low Voltage Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
Installation Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Low Voltage Wiring for Control Circuit Terminals . . . . . . . . . 435
Installation Method Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342 LT-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274, 294
Installation Orientation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 LT-2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274, 294
Installation Orientation and Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 LT-3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274, 294
Installation Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 LT-4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274, 294
Installation Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 M
Installing a Braking Unit: CDBR Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
M1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Installing a Leakage Breaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
M2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Installing a Magnetic Contactor at the Power Supply Side . . . 329
M3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Installing a Molded Case Circuit Breaker (MCCB) . . . . . . . . . 328
M4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Installing a Motor Thermal Overload (oL) Relay . . . . . . . . . . 333
M5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Installing Peripheral Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
M6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Installing the Cooling Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298, 300, 306
MA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Intermediate Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Magnet Pole Search Error Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Internal Braking Transistor Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Magnetic Flux Compensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Inversion Detection (dv3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Magnetic Flux Compensation Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Inversion Prevention Detection (dv4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Main Circuit Connection Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53, 66
IP20 Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Main Circuit Terminal and Motor Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
J Main Circuit Terminal Block Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Jerk at Accel End . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Main Circuit Terminal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Jerk at Accel Start. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Main Circuit Terminal Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Jerk at Decel End . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Main Circuit Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Jerk at Decel Start. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293, 294
Jerk below Leveling Speed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Maintenance Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
Jerk Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Maintenance Monitor Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Jumper S3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33, 72, 73 Maintenance Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249, 382
Jumper S5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Maintenance Period (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . 194
K Maintenance Period Reached by the IGBTs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
Max. Current during Leveling Speed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384
Keys and Displays on the Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Max. Motor Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
kWh . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
Maximum Applicable Motor Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336, 337
kWh Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Maximum Output Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336, 337
kWh Monitor Initialization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Maximum Output Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336, 337
L MB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
L1000 Models. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 MC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Language Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Measuring Acceleration Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 455
Mechanical Gear Ratio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227 Motor No-Load Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106, 170
Mechanical Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Motor Overheat Alarm (PTC thermistor input) (oH3). . . .266, 275
MEMOBUS/Modbus Comm. Test Mode Complete (PASS) . . 276 Motor Overheat Alarm Operation Selection
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 (PTC thermistor input) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication Error (CE) . . . . . 259, 273 Motor Overheat Fault (PTC thermistor input) (oH4). . . . . . . . .267
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391 Motor Overheat Fault Operation Selection
MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405 (PTC thermistor input) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
MEMOBUS/Modbus Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416 Motor Overload (oL1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
MEMOBUS/Modbus Self Test Failed (SE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 Motor Overload Protection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201, 436
MEMOBUS/Modbus Setup Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396 Motor Overload Protection Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203, 437
MEMOBUS/Modbus Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 Motor Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
MEMOBUS/Modbus Switch Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Motor Pole Search Status (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . .195
MEMOBUS/Modbus Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Motor Poles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Menu Structure for Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Motor Poles for Induction Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Message Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 Motor Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
Minimum Wait Time for Sending Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 Motor Pull Out or Step Out Detection (STo) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Minor Fault (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 Motor q-Axis Inductance for PM motors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Minor Fault and Alarm Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 Motor Rated Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105, 169, 436
Minor Faults and Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254, 256 Motor Rated Current for PM motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Model Number and Nameplate Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Motor Rated Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105, 171
Model, Voltage Class, Capacity Mismatch (ndAT) . . . . . . . . . 284 Motor Rated Power for PM motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Motor Rated Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106, 169
Monitor Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406 Motor Rated Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Monitor Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Motor Rotation Direction Setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94
Monitor Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379 Motor Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Motor 2 Base Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Motor Speed Fault (Er-11) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Motor 2 Leakage Inductance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Motor Stator Resistance for PM motors (Single Phase) . . . . . .174
Motor 2 Line-to-Line Resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Motor Temperature Input Filter Time (PTC thermistor input) .205
Motor 2 Max Output Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Motor Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
Motor 2 Max Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Mounting Hole . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29, 30, 31
Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Multi-function Analog Input Selection Error (oPE07) . . . . . . .277
Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Multi-Function Analog Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Multi-Function Analog Outputs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Multi-function Digital Input Selection Error (oPE03). . . . . . . .277
Motor 2 Motor Poles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Multi-Function Digital Input Terminal Settings . . . . . . . . . . . .183
Motor 2 Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Multi-Function Digital Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
Motor 2 Rated Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Multi-Function Digital Output Terminal Settings . . . . . . . . . . .187
Motor 2 Rated No-Load Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Multi-Function Digital Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Motor 2 Rated Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Multi-Function Photocoupler Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Motor 2 Slip Compensation Gain. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Multi-Function Relay Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Motor 2 Slip Compensation Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Multi-Function Terminal Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Motor 2 Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . 159 Multiple Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395
Motor 2 Speed Reference. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Multiple Drive Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Motor 2 Torque Compensation Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Multi-Speed Inputs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Motor Acceleration Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Multi-Speed References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Motor Base Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 N
Motor Base Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Nameplate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
Motor Contactor Control During Auto-Tuning Selection . . . . 234
Navigating the Drive and Programming Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
Motor Contactor Feedback. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
ndAT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
Motor Contactor Response Error (SE1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
NEMA 1 Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
Motor Contactor Response Error (SE1) Detection/Reset
NEMA Type 1 Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Network Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395
Motor Data Error (Er-01) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Noise Filter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
Motor d-Axis Inductance for PM motors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Noise From the Drive or Output Lines When the Drive
Motor Direction Error (Er-10) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
is Powered On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
Motor Does Not Rotate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
No-Load Current Alarm (End7). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
Motor Induction Voltage Constant 1 for PM motors . . . . . . . . 175
No-Load Current Error (Er-05) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Motor Induction Voltage Constant 2 for PM motors . . . . . . . . 175
Nominal Speed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Motor Inertia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Non-rotating Encoder Offset Tuning Warning (Er-23) . . . . . . .282
Motor Iron Loss for Torque Compensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Not Zero Speed (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . . . . .195
Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient (End2). . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Notes on Motor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Number of Auto Reset Attempts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Number of Motor Poles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Motor is Too Hot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Number of PM Motor Poles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Motor Leakage Inductance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Number of Travels Counter Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
Motor Line-to-Line Resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Motor Mechanical Loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
456 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
O (oFb03 to oFb11, oFb12 to oFb17) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
oC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port CN5-C
oFA00 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 (oFC03 to oFC11, oFC12 to oFC17) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
oFA01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Option Card External Fault (EF0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 273
oFA05, oFA06 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Option Card Fault at Option Connector CN5-A (oFA01) . . . . 264
oFA10, oFA11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-B (oFb00). . . . . . . . . . 265
oFA12 to oFA17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-B (oFb01). . . . . . . . . . 265
oFA30 to oFA43 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-B (oFb02). . . . . . . . . . 265
oFb00 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-C (oFC01) . . . . . . . . . 265
oFb01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-C (oFC02) . . . . . . . . . 265
oFb02 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Option Card Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
oFb03 to oFb11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Option Communication Error (bUS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259, 272
oFb12 to oFb17. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Option Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
oFC00 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
oFC01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 oS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268, 275
oFC02 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Output Contactor Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
oFC03 to oFC11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Output Contactor Open Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
oFC12 to oFC17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Output Current Error (SE3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
oFC50 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Output Current Error (SE3) Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . . 247
oFC51 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Output Current Imbalance (LF2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
oFC52 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Output Ground Fault Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
oFC53 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Output Phase Loss (LF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
oFC54 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Output Phase Loss Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
oH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266, 275 Output Speed Resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
oH1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Output Terminal FM Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
oL1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 Output Voltage Detection Error (voF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271, 276
oL2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 Output Voltage Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
oL2 Characteristics Selection at Low Speeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 Output Voltage Limit Operation Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
oL3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267, 275 Output-Side Noise Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
oL4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267, 275 ov . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268, 275
Online Tuning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Overacceleration Detection (dv6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Online Tuning Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Overacceleration Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
oPE01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Overacceleration Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
oPE02 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Overacceleration Detection Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
oPE03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Overcurrent (oC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
oPE04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Overcurrent Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
oPE04 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Overheat Alarm Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
oPE05 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Overheat Pre-Alarm Operation Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
oPE06 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Overload Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338, 436
oPE07 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Overload Tolerance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336, 337
oPE08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Overload Tolerance for Internal Braking Transistor . . . . . . . . 216
oPE10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Overspeed (oS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268, 275
oPE16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Overspeed Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
oPE18 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Overspeed Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
oPE20 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Overtorque Detection 1 (oL3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267, 275
Open Loop Vector Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Overtorque Detection 2 (oL4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267, 275
Operation Error Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 Overvoltage Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
Operation Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254, 257 P
Operation Selection after Communications Error . . . . . . . . . . 181 P1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Operation Selection at Deviation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 P2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Operation Selection at Overspeed (oS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 Parameter Access Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Operation Selection at PG Open Circuit (PGo) . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 Parameter List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343
Operation Selection when Digital Operator is Disconnected. . 229 Parameter Range Setting Error (oPE02) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Operation Status Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249, 379 Parameter Selection Error (oPE08) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Operator Function Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 Parameter Setting Error, Online Tuning Parameter
Operator Programming Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Setting Error (oPE18). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
oPr. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 Parameter Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Parameter Settings in the Drive and Those Saved to
Option Card Connection Error at Option Connector CN5-A the Copy Function are not the Same (vFyE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
(oFA00). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 PASS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Option Card Connection Error at Option Port CN5-C Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
(oFC00). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Password Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Option Card Connector. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Password Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port CN5-A Performance Life Monitors Maintenance Monitors. . . . . . . . . 293
(oFA05, oFA06, oFA10, oFA11, oFA12 to oFA17, Performance Life of the Inrush Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
oFA30 to oFA43) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Periodic Inspection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port CN5-B
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 457
Periodic Inspection Checklist. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 rdEr. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
Periodic Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 rEAd . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
Peripheral Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311, 314 Reading Drive MEMOBUS/Modbus Register Contents . . . . . .403
PF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 Reading Parameter Settings (flashing) (rEAd) . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
PF5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 Reattaching the Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
PG Feedback Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 Reattaching the Front Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
PG Number of Pulses Per Revolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Reattaching the Terminal Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
PG Number of Pulses Per Revolution for PM Motor Reduced Carrier Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Reducing Radiated, Conducted, and Induced Noise . . . . . . . . .331
PG Open-Circuit Detection Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 Reference Source Selection Error (oPE05) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
PG Option Card Disconnect Detection 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 Releveling Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
PG1 Pulse Monitor Output Division Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 REMOTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
PG-B3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Remote Operator Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
PG-E3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Removing the Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
PG-F3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Removing the Fan Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
PGo. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269, 276 Removing the Front Cover. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
PGoH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269, 276 Removing the Terminal Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
PGoH Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178, 179 Removing Wires from the Terminal Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
PG-X3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Phase Order Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Replacing the Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .308
PM Motor Auto-Tuning Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Rescue Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121, 239
PM Motor Base Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Rescue Operation Power Supply Deterioration
PM Motor Control Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
PM Motor d-Axis Inductance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Rescue Operation Power Supply Deterioration Error (PF5) . . .268
PM Motor Induced Voltage Constant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Rescue Operation Power Supply Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
PM Motor q-Axis Inductance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Rescue Operation Rotor Polarity Detection Warning
PM Motor Rated Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 (End10). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
PM Motor Rated Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Rescue Operation Rotor Pole Position Search Warning
PM Motor Rated Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 (End9). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
PM Motor Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Rescue Operation Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
PM Motor Stator Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Rescue Operation Speed Warning (End8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
PM Rotor Position Estimation Error (dv8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 Rescue Operation Torque Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136, 240
Polarity Detection Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Reset Communication Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
Port CN19 cover. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 30, 31 Resistance Tuning Error (End5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
Position Deviation Level to Apply Torque Bias 1 . . . . . . . . . . 238 Response Messages from Drive to Master. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .400
Position Deviation Level to Apply Torque Bias 2 . . . . . . . . . . 239 Restart after Baseblock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Position Lock Completion Width. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 Restart Enabled (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . . . . .194
Position Lock Deviation Counter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385 Returning to Normal Operation after Safe Disable . . . . . . . . . .441
Position Lock Error (SvE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Reverse Regenerative Torque Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Position Lock Gain at Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 Reverse Torque Limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Position Lock Gain at Stop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 rF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Position Lock Time at Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 rollback. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
Position Lock Time at Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Roping Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227
Power On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Rotation Direction for Auto-Tuning of
Power Ratings (Three-Phase 200 V Class) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336 PG-E3 Encoder Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Power Ratings (Three-Phase 400 V Class) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337 Rotational Auto-Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Preface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 rr . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Preparing the Ends of Shielded Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 RS-422 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395
Programming Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86, 87 RS-422/485 Termination Resistor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Protection Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 RS-485 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395
PWM Method. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 RTS Control Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Q Rubber Bushing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29
Run Command Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
q-Axis Current Control Integral Time during Normal
RUN LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
RUN LED and Drive Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
R RUN LED Status and Meaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
R- . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 RUN Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
R+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
S
R/L1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
S- . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Radiated Noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
S+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Ramp to Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
S/L2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Rated Current Setting Alarm (End3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
S1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Rated Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
S2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Rated Output Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336, 337
S3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Rated Output Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336, 337
S4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Rated Slip Error (Er-08) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
S5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Rated Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336, 337
458 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
S6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Soft Charge Bypass Relay Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
S7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Soft Charge Bypass Relay Maintenance Time (LT-3) . . . . . . . 274
S8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Soft-Charge Bypass Circuit Fault (Uv3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Safe Disable Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440 Software version. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Safe Disable Circuit Fault Signal Input (HbbF) . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 Sourcing Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Safe Disable Function Wiring Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440 Sourcing Mode (PNP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Safe Disable Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 SP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67, 73
Safe Disable Input Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335
Safe Disable Input Sink / Source / External Power Supply Speed Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Speed agree 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Safe Disable Monitor Output Function and Digital Speed Agree 1 Time Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Operator Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 441 Speed agree 2 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Safe Disable Signal Input (Hbb). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 Speed Agree Detection Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Safe Disable Status (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . . 195 Speed Agreement Detection Level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Safe Disable Status Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 441 Speed Control Accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
Safe Torque Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440 Speed Control Loop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Safety Circuit Fault (SCF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Speed Control Loop Delay Time during Position Lock. . . . . . 163
Safety Hazard Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Speed Control Loop Integral Time during Position Lock . . . . 163
Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Safety Monitor Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain Time during Position
Safety Standard. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338 Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
SC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67, 269 Speed Control Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 338
SE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 Speed Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
SE1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Speed Detection 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
SE1 Detection/Reset Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Speed Detection 1 Time Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
SE2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Speed Detection 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
SE2 Detect Current Level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Speed Detection 2 Time Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
SE2 Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Speed Detection 3 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . . . . . . . 192
SE3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Speed Detection 4 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . . . . . . . 193
SE3 Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Speed Detection PG1 Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385
SE4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Speed Deviation (dEv) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261, 273
SE4 Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Gain . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Second Line Monitor Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Time Constant . . . 218
Self-Diagnosing Function of the Serial Communication Speed Loop Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Interface Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 Speed Reference. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86, 165
Self-Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 Speed Reference at Reference Loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Separate Speed Inputs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Speed Reference Bias. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
Serial Communication Stand By (CALL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 Speed Reference for Auto-Tuning of
Serial Communication Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 PG-E3 Encoder Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Serial Communications Cable Connection Terminals . . . . . . . 394 Speed Reference Loss Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Set Vibrational Frequency Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Speed Reference Loss Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Setting Motor Parameters Manually. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Speed Reference Missing (FrL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248, 263
Setting Sink/Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Speed Reference Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110, 149
Setup Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Speed Reference Selection at Rescue Operation . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Setup Group Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Speed Reference Selection Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Setup Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Speed Reference Setting Method Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Speed Reference Unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 Speed Response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 338
Shielded Twisted-Pair Cables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Speed Selection Using Digital Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Short Floor Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Stall Prevention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
Simplified Setup Using the Setup Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Stall Prevention During Acceleration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Sinking Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Stall Prevention Selection during Acceleration . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
Sinking Mode (NPN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Stall Prevention Selection during Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Sinking/Sourcing Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Standard Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
SI-S3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Starting Current Error (SE2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Slave Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 Starting Current Error (SE2) Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . 247
Slip Compensation for Elevators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Starting Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 338
Slip Compensation Gain. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Starting Torque Compensation Increase Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Slip Compensation Gain in Motoring Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Start-Up Flowcharts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Slip Compensation Gain in Regenerative Mode . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Stationary Auto-Tuning 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Slip Compensation Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Stationary Auto-Tuning 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Stationary Auto-Tuning for Line-to-Line Resistance . . . . . . . . 99
Slip Compensation Selection during Regeneration . . . . . . . . . 158 Stator Resistance Error (Er-20) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Slip Compensation Torque Detection Delay Time. . . . . . . . . . 235 Status Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Slip Compensation Torque Detection Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 STo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Slip Compensation Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384 STOP Button Input (Er-03) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
SN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67, 73 STOP Key Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 459
Stopping Method after Communication Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396 Torque Specifications, Three Phase 200 V Class . . . . . . . .61, 429
Stopping Method Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Torque Specifications, Three Phase 400 V Class . . . . . . . .63, 431
Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Traction Sheave Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227
SvE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Travel Start. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Switched Phase Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Travel Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Switches and Jumpers on the Terminal Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 TrPC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276, 294
Switching Between LOCAL and REMOTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Tuning Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
T Types of Alarms, Faults, and Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Types of Auto-Tuning for Induction Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
T/L3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Types of Auto-Tuning for Permanent Magnet Motors . . .100, 101
Task Complete (End) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Temperature Derating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342 U
Terminal A1 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 U/T1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Terminal A1 Gain. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 U2, U3 Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Terminal A1 Signal Level Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 UL and CSA Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .429
Terminal A2 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 UL/cUL Mark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .429
Terminal A2 Gain. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 UL3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270, 276
Terminal A2 Signal Level Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 UL4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270, 276
Terminal AM Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Undertorque Detection 1 (UL3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270, 276
Terminal AM Monitor Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Undertorque Detection 2 (UL4). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270, 276
Terminal AM Signal Level Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Undervoltage (Uv) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276
Terminal Block Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Undervoltage Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Terminal Board. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 30, 31, 33 Undervoltage Detection Level (Uv). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Terminal Board Connection Error (CPF07, CPF08) . . . . . . . . 260 Undervoltage Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
Terminal Board Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Unit Selection
Terminal Board Mismatch Error (oPE04) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Accel/Decel Ramps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
Terminal Board not Connected (CPF25) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 Elevator Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
Terminal Board Wiring Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Jerk. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
Terminal Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Speed Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
Terminal Connections for Communication Unit Selection for MEMOBUS/Modbus Register 0025H . . . . .397
Self-Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 Up/Down Command Error (EF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Terminal Cover. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 30, 31, 55 Up/Down Command Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Terminal Cover Screw . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Up/Down Command Selection while in Programming Mode . .151
Terminal FM Monitor Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Up/Down Command Source Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Terminal FM Signal Level Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 UPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
Terminal Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 UPS Operation Speed Limit Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Terminal M1-M2 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 UPS Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Terminal M3-M4 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 USB Copy Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142, 314
Terminal M5-M6 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 USB Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Terminal P1-C1 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 USB Port (type-B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29, 30, 31
Terminal P1-C2 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 User Monitor Selection after Power Up. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 User Monitor Selection Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
Test Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101, 102, 103, 104 User Parameter Automatic Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141, 148
Third Line Monitor Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 User Parameter Default Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141, 228
Through mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184, 191, 198 User Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141, 148
Tightening Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 User Parameters 1 to 32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Timer Function On-Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 User Set Speed Agree 1 Time Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
Timer Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 User-Set Display Units Decimal Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227
Torque Compensation (Multi-Function Analog Inputs). . . . . . 198 User-Set Display Units Maximum Value. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227
Torque Compensation at Forward Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 User-Set Speed Agree 1 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . .189
Torque Compensation at Reverse Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 User-Set Speed Agree 2 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . .192
Torque Compensation Diminish Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Using a PM Motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Torque Compensation Diminish Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Using Braking Units in Parallel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
Torque Compensation Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 Using the Safe Disable Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .440
Torque Compensation Time Constant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Uv. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276
Torque Compensation Value with Load Condition 1 . . . . . . . . 238 Uv1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Torque Compensation Value with Load Condition 2 . . . . . . . . 238 Uv2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Torque Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 Uv3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Torque Detection 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 V
Torque Detection 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
-V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Torque Detection Selection 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
V/f Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
Torque Detection Selection 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
V/f Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
Torque Limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211, 338
V/f Pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Torque Limit Process at Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
V/f Pattern for Motor 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Torque Limit Reduction Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
V/f Pattern Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Torque Limit Selection from
V/f Pattern Setting Error (oPE10) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Communications Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
V/T2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
460 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
vAEr . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Verify Error (EvE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Verify Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Verifying Parameter Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
vFyE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Vibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Viewing Fault Trace Data After Fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
voF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271, 276
Voltage Class, Capacity Mismatch (vAEr). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
vrFy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
W
W/T3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Watt Loss 200 V Class Three Phase Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Watt Loss 400 V Class Three Phase Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Wire Gauge, Three Phase 200 V Class. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61, 429
Wire Gauge, Three Phase 400 V Class. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63, 431
Wire Gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60, 69
Wire Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Wiring Checklist. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Wiring the Control Circuit Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Within Position Lock Bandwidth (Multi-Function Digital
Outputs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Write Data Error (EiF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Write Impossible (EdE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Writing Parameter Settings (CoPy) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Writing to Multiple Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404
Z
Z Pulse Correction Error (Er-21) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Z Pulse Noise Fault Detection (dv2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Zero Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Zero Speed Level at Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Zero-Speed Time Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 461
Revision History
The revision dates and the numbers of the revised manuals appear on the bottom of the back cover.
Revision number
Date of original publication
Date of publication
462 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Preface .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14
General Safety Information .............................................................................................................................................................................. 15
Safety Information............................................................................................................................................................................................ 15
Safety Hazard Definitions ................................................................................................................................................................................ 15
Notes on Motor Operation................................................................................................................................................................................ 21
Using a PM Motor ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 21
L1000 Models................................................................................................................................................................................................... 25
Control Mode Selection.................................................................................................................................................................................... 26
Control Modes and their Features .................................................................................................................................................................... 26
V/f Control........................................................................................................................................................................................................ 26
Open Loop Vector Control............................................................................................................................................................................... 26
Closed Loop Vector control ............................................................................................................................................................................. 26
Closed Loop Vector control for PM motors..................................................................................................................................................... 26
Speed Control Range........................................................................................................................................................................................ 26
Speed Accuracy ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 26
Speed Response ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 26
Starting Torque................................................................................................................................................................................................. 26
Model Number and Nameplate Check ............................................................................................................................................................. 27
Nameplate......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 27
Software version............................................................................................................................................................................................... 27
Software version............................................................................................................................................................................................... 27
Max. Motor Capacity........................................................................................................................................................................................ 28
Component Names ........................................................................................................................................................................................... 29
Fan Finger Guard.............................................................................................................................................................................................. 29
Rubber Bushing ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 29
Cooling Fan ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 29
Front Cover....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 29
Mounting Hole.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 29
USB Port (type-B) ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 29
Heatsink............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 29
Digital Operator................................................................................................................................................................................................ 29
Port CN19 cover ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 29
Terminal Cover................................................................................................................................................................................................. 29
Terminal Board................................................................................................................................................................................................. 29
Terminal Cover Screw...................................................................................................................................................................................... 29
Bottom Cover ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 29
Fan Finger Guard.............................................................................................................................................................................................. 30
Front Cover Screw............................................................................................................................................................................................ 30
Cooling Fan ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 30
Digital Operator................................................................................................................................................................................................ 30
Mounting Hole.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 30
Drive Cover ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 30
Heatsink............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 30
Terminal Cover................................................................................................................................................................................................. 30
Port CN19 cover ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 30
Terminal Board................................................................................................................................................................................................. 30
Front Cover....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 30
USB Port (type-B) ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 30
Mounting Hole.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 31
USB Port (type-B) ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 31
Heatsink............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 31
Digital Operator................................................................................................................................................................................................ 31
Port CN19 cover ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 31
Front Cover Screw............................................................................................................................................................................................ 31
Terminal Board ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 31
Drive Cover ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 31
Fan Finger Guard.............................................................................................................................................................................................. 31
Terminal Cover................................................................................................................................................................................................. 31
Cooling Fan ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 31
Fan Unit ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 31
Front Cover....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 31
Terminal Board Connector ............................................................................................................................................................................... 33
Terminal Board................................................................................................................................................................................................. 33
DIP Switch S2 .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 33
Jumper S3 ......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 33
Option Card Connector..................................................................................................................................................................................... 33
CN5-C............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 33
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 1
Ground Terminal ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 33
CN5-B ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 33
Terminal Board ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 33
CN5-A ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 33
Mechanical Installation ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 35
Installation Environment ................................................................................................................................................................................... 37
Ambient Temperature ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 37
Humidity............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 37
Storage Temperature ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 37
Altitude.............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 37
Vibration............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 37
Installation Orientation and Spacing ................................................................................................................................................................. 38
Installation Orientation...................................................................................................................................................................................... 38
Installation Orientation...................................................................................................................................................................................... 38
Installation Spacing ........................................................................................................................................................................................... 38
Digital Operator Remote Usage ........................................................................................................................................................................ 40
Digital Operator Remote Installation ................................................................................................................................................................ 40
Digital Operator Dimensions ............................................................................................................................................................................ 40
Digital Operator Installation Methods and Required Tools .............................................................................................................................. 41
Exterior and Mounting Dimensions .................................................................................................................................................................. 43
Dimensions for IP20/NEMA Type 1 Enclosure: 200 V Class.......................................................................................................................... 43
Dimensions for IP20/NEMA Type 1 Enclosure: 200 V Class.......................................................................................................................... 44
Electrical Installation......................................................................................................................................................................................... 45
Standard Connection Diagram .......................................................................................................................................................................... 50
Drive Standard Connection Diagram ................................................................................................................................................................ 51
Main Circuit Connection Diagram.................................................................................................................................................................... 53
Terminal Block Configuration .......................................................................................................................................................................... 54
Main Circuit Terminal Block Configuration..................................................................................................................................................... 54
Terminal Cover ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 55
Removing the Terminal Cover.......................................................................................................................................................................... 55
Removing the Terminal Cover.......................................................................................................................................................................... 55
Reattaching the Terminal Cover ....................................................................................................................................................................... 56
Reattaching the Terminal Cover ....................................................................................................................................................................... 56
Removing the Digital Operator ......................................................................................................................................................................... 57
Reattaching the Digital Operator....................................................................................................................................................................... 57
Removing the Front Cover................................................................................................................................................................................ 58
Reattaching the Front Cover ............................................................................................................................................................................. 59
Main Circuit Wiring .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
Main Circuit Terminal Functions...................................................................................................................................................................... 60
Main Circuit Terminal Functions...................................................................................................................................................................... 60
R/L1................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
S/L2 ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
T/L3................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
U/T1 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 60
V/T2 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 60
W/T3.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 60
B1 ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
B2 ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
+2....................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
+1....................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
-.......................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
+3....................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
Wire Gauges...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
Tightening Torque............................................................................................................................................................................................. 60
Wire Gauges...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60
Formula to Calculate the Amount of Voltage Drop.......................................................................................................................................... 61
Wire Gauge, Three Phase 200 V Class ............................................................................................................................................................. 61
Torque Specifications, Three Phase 200 V Class ............................................................................................................................................. 61
Wire Gauge, Three Phase 400 V Class ............................................................................................................................................................. 63
Torque Specifications, Three Phase 400 V Class ............................................................................................................................................. 63
Main Circuit Terminal and Motor Wiring......................................................................................................................................................... 64
Motor Wiring..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 64
Cable Length Between Drive and Motor .......................................................................................................................................................... 65
Ground Wiring .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 65
Multiple Drive Wiring....................................................................................................................................................................................... 65
Main Circuit Terminal Wiring .......................................................................................................................................................................... 66
Main Circuit Connection Diagram.................................................................................................................................................................... 66
2 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Control Circuit Wiring ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
Control Circuit Terminal Block Functions....................................................................................................................................................... 67
Control Circuit Input Terminals ....................................................................................................................................................................... 67
Digital Input...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
S1...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
S2...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
S3...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
S4...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
S5...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
S6...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
S7...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
S8...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
Digital Input Power Supply .............................................................................................................................................................................. 67
SC ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
SN ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
SP...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
Safe Disable Input ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 67
H1 ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
H2 ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
HC..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
Analog Input..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
+V ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
-V...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
A1 ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
A2 ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
AC..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 67
E (G) ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 67
Control Circuit Output Terminals .................................................................................................................................................................... 68
Fault Relay........................................................................................................................................................................................................ 68
MA.................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
MB.................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
MC.................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
Multi-Function Relay Output ........................................................................................................................................................................... 68
M1..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
M2..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
M3..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
M4..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
M5..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
M6..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
Multi-Function Photocoupler Output ............................................................................................................................................................... 68
P1...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
C1 ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
P2...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
C2 ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
Monitor Output................................................................................................................................................................................................. 68
FM .................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
AM.................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
AC..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
Safety Monitor Output...................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
DM+ ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 68
DM- .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 68
Serial Communication Terminals..................................................................................................................................................................... 68
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication............................................................................................................................................................. 68
R+ ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
R- ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
S+...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
S-....................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
IG...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68
Terminal Configuration .................................................................................................................................................................................... 69
Control Circuit Terminal Arrangement ............................................................................................................................................................ 69
Wire Size .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 69
Wire Gauges ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 69
Ferrule-Type Wire Terminals........................................................................................................................................................................... 69
Ferrule Dimensions .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 69
Ferrule Terminal Types and Sizes.................................................................................................................................................................... 69
Wiring the Control Circuit Terminal................................................................................................................................................................ 70
Terminal Board Wiring Guide.......................................................................................................................................................................... 71
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 3
Removing Wires from the Terminal Board....................................................................................................................................................... 71
Preparing the Ends of Shielded Cables ............................................................................................................................................................. 71
Shielded Twisted-Pair Cables ........................................................................................................................................................................... 71
Switches and Jumpers on the Terminal Board .................................................................................................................................................. 72
A2 Signal Selection........................................................................................................................................................................................... 72
Jumper S3.......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 72
H1/H2 Sink/Source Selection............................................................................................................................................................................ 72
DIP Switch S2 ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 72
RS-422/485 Termination Resistor..................................................................................................................................................................... 72
Jumper S5.......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 72
AM/FM Signal Selection .................................................................................................................................................................................. 72
Locations of Jumpers and Switches on the Terminal Board............................................................................................................................. 72
Control I/O Connections ................................................................................................................................................................................... 73
Setting Sink/Source ........................................................................................................................................................................................... 73
SN...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 73
SP ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 73
Digital Input Sink / Source / External Power Supply
Selection ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 73
External 24 Vdc Power Supply ......................................................................................................................................................................... 73
Sinking Mode (NPN) ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 73
Sourcing Mode (PNP) ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 73
Sinking/Sourcing Mode Selection..................................................................................................................................................................... 73
Jumper S3.......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 73
Safe Disable Input Sink / Source / External Power Supply
Selection ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 73
Sinking Mode .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 73
Sourcing Mode .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 73
MEMOBUS/Modbus Termination.................................................................................................................................................................... 74
Termination ....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 74
MEMOBUS/Modbus Switch Settings .............................................................................................................................................................. 74
USB Port ........................................................................................................................................................................................................... 75
Connecting to a PC (USB) ................................................................................................................................................................................ 75
Wiring Checklist ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 76
Digital Operator................................................................................................................................................................................................. 81
Keys and Displays on the Digital Operator....................................................................................................................................................... 81
Function Key (F1, F2)....................................................................................................................................................................................... 81
RUN Light......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 81
LO/RE Light...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 81
ALM LED Light................................................................................................................................................................................................ 81
LCD Display ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 82
Function Key 1 (F1) .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 82
Function Key 2 (F2) .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 82
Status Display.................................................................................................................................................................................................... 83
ALARM (ALM) LED Displays ........................................................................................................................................................................ 83
LO/RE ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 84
LO/RE LED....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 84
RUN LED.......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 84
RUN LED Status and Meaning......................................................................................................................................................................... 84
RUN LED and Drive Operation........................................................................................................................................................................ 84
Menu Structure for Digital Operator................................................................................................................................................................. 85
Digital Operator Menu and Screen Structure.................................................................................................................................................... 85
Modes ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 86
Drive Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 86
Programming Mode........................................................................................................................................................................................... 86
Navigating the Drive and Programming Modes ............................................................................................................................................... 86
Speed Reference................................................................................................................................................................................................ 86
Drive Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 87
Programming Mode........................................................................................................................................................................................... 87
Parameter Settings............................................................................................................................................................................................. 88
Changing Parameter Settings or Values............................................................................................................................................................ 88
Verifying Parameter Changes ........................................................................................................................................................................... 89
Verify Menu ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 89
Simplified Setup Using the Setup Group .......................................................................................................................................................... 90
Setup Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 90
Setup Group....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 90
Setup Group Parameters.................................................................................................................................................................................... 91
Switching Between LOCAL and REMOTE ..................................................................................................................................................... 91
4 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
LOCAL............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 91
REMOTE.......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 91
LO/RE............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 91
Start-Up Flowcharts.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 92
Initial Operation................................................................................................................................................................................................ 92
Basic Procedure Required to Install the Drive ................................................................................................................................................. 93
Power On .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 94
Control Mode Selection.................................................................................................................................................................................... 94
Motor Rotation Direction Setup ....................................................................................................................................................................... 94
Encoder Setup................................................................................................................................................................................................... 95
Encoder Resolution Setup ................................................................................................................................................................................ 95
Encoder Rotation Direction Setup.................................................................................................................................................................... 95
Auto-Tuning for Induction Motors................................................................................................................................................................... 96
Auto-Tuning for Permanent Magnet Motors.................................................................................................................................................... 97
Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning............................................................................................................................................................................ 98
Auto-Tuning ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 99
Auto-Tuning for Induction Motors................................................................................................................................................................... 99
Types of Auto-Tuning for Induction Motors.................................................................................................................................................... 99
Rotational Auto-Tuning.................................................................................................................................................................................... 99
Stationary Auto-Tuning 1................................................................................................................................................................................. 99
Stationary Auto-Tuning for Line-to-Line Resistance....................................................................................................................................... 99
Stationary Auto-Tuning 2................................................................................................................................................................................. 99
Auto-Tuning Input Data ................................................................................................................................................................................... 99
Auto-Tuning for Permanent Magnet Motors.................................................................................................................................................. 100
Types of Auto-Tuning for Permanent Magnet Motors................................................................................................................................... 100
Auto-Tuning of PG-E3 Encoder Characteristics............................................................................................................................................ 100
Auto-Tuning Input Data ................................................................................................................................................................................. 100
Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning.......................................................................................................................................................................... 101
Types of Auto-Tuning for Permanent Magnet Motors................................................................................................................................... 101
Auto-Tuning ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 101
Before Auto-Tuning the Drive ....................................................................................................................................................................... 101
Test Run.......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 101
Basic Auto-Tuning Preparations .................................................................................................................................................................... 101
Auto-Tuning Fault Codes ............................................................................................................................................................................... 102
Auto-Tuning Interruption and Fault Codes .................................................................................................................................................... 102
Test Run.......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 102
Enter Data from the Motor Nameplate........................................................................................................................................................... 103
Test Run.......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 103
Auto-Tuning ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 104
Auto-Tuning ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 104
Test Run.......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 104
Auto-Tuning Mode Selection ......................................................................................................................................................................... 105
Motor Rated Power......................................................................................................................................................................................... 105
Motor Rated Voltage ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 105
Motor Rated Current....................................................................................................................................................................................... 105
Motor Base Frequency ................................................................................................................................................................................... 105
Number of Motor Poles .................................................................................................................................................................................. 106
Motor Base Speed........................................................................................................................................................................................... 106
PG Number of Pulses Per Revolution ............................................................................................................................................................ 106
Motor No-Load Current ................................................................................................................................................................................. 106
Motor Rated Slip ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 106
PM Motor Auto-Tuning Mode Selection ....................................................................................................................................................... 107
PM Motor Rated Power.................................................................................................................................................................................. 107
PM Motor Rated Voltage ............................................................................................................................................................................... 107
PM Motor Rated Current................................................................................................................................................................................ 107
Number of PM Motor Poles ........................................................................................................................................................................... 107
PM Motor Base Speed.................................................................................................................................................................................... 107
PM Motor Stator Resistance........................................................................................................................................................................... 108
PM Motor d-Axis Inductance......................................................................................................................................................................... 108
PM Motor q-Axis Inductance......................................................................................................................................................................... 108
Induced Voltage Constant Unit Selection ...................................................................................................................................................... 108
PM Motor Induced Voltage Constant............................................................................................................................................................. 108
PG Number of Pulses Per Revolution for PM Motor
Tuning............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 108
Encoder Z-Pulse Offset .................................................................................................................................................................................. 108
Speed Reference for Auto-Tuning of
PG-E3 Encoder Characteristics ...................................................................................................................................................................... 108
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 5
Rotation Direction for Auto-Tuning of
PG-E3 Encoder Characteristics....................................................................................................................................................................... 109
Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications..................................................................................................................................................... 110
Speed Reference Selection .............................................................................................................................................................................. 110
Up/Down Command Source Selection ........................................................................................................................................................... 110
Travel Start...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 110
Travel Stop ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 111
Speed Selection Using Digital Inputs.............................................................................................................................................................. 111
Multi-Speed Inputs.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 111
Separate Speed Inputs ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 112
Multi-Function Terminal Setup....................................................................................................................................................................... 113
Elevator Emergency Stop................................................................................................................................................................................ 114
Inspection Operation ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 115
Inspection Operation Sequence....................................................................................................................................................................... 115
Brake Sequence ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 116
Brake Sequence without Torque Compensation ............................................................................................................................................. 116
Brake Sequence without Torque Compensation at Start................................................................................................................................. 116
Brake Sequence Using Torque Compensation................................................................................................................................................ 117
Brake Sequence Using Torque Compensation at Start ................................................................................................................................... 117
Adjusting the Torque Compensation at Start .................................................................................................................................................. 118
Adjustments for Riding Comfort..................................................................................................................................................................... 120
Adjustments for Riding Comfort:Eliminating Problem with Hunting............................................................................................................ 120
Adjustments for Riding Comfort:Eliminating Problem with Vibration.......................................................................................................... 120
Adjustments for Riding Comfort:Eliminating Problem with Rollback .......................................................................................................... 120
rollback............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 120
Speed Loop Adjustments ................................................................................................................................................................................ 120
Inertia Compensation ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 120
Adjusting Position Lock at Start ..................................................................................................................................................................... 120
Rescue Operation ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 121
Battery ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 121
UPS.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 121
Connecting the Drive and Battery................................................................................................................................................................... 131
Rescue Operation Torque Limit...................................................................................................................................................................... 136
Light Load Direction Search Function............................................................................................................................................................ 136
Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions ............................................................................................................................................... 137
Cannot Change Parameter Settings ................................................................................................................................................................. 137
Motor Does Not Rotate ................................................................................................................................................................................... 137
Frequency Reference Selection 1.................................................................................................................................................................... 137
Motor is Too Hot............................................................................................................................................................................................. 138
Drive Does Not Allow Selection of Rotational
Auto-Tuning .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 138
Noise From the Drive or Output Lines When the Drive
is Powered On ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 138
Backing Up Parameter Values ........................................................................................................................................................................ 141
User Parameter Default Value......................................................................................................................................................................... 141
Initialize Parameters........................................................................................................................................................................................ 141
Parameter Access Level .................................................................................................................................................................................. 141
Access Level Selection.................................................................................................................................................................................... 141
User Parameters............................................................................................................................................................................................... 141
User Parameters 1 to 32 .................................................................................................................................................................................. 141
User Parameter Automatic Selection .............................................................................................................................................................. 141
Password Settings............................................................................................................................................................................................ 141
Password.......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 141
Copy Function ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 142
USB Copy Unit ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 142
CopyUnitManager........................................................................................................................................................................................... 142
DriveWizard Plus ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 142
Initialization .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 144
Language Selection ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 144
Access Level Selection.................................................................................................................................................................................... 144
Control Method Selection ............................................................................................................................................................................... 145
Initialize Parameters........................................................................................................................................................................................ 145
oPE04 Reset .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 145
Password Setting ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 146
User Parameters............................................................................................................................................................................................... 148
User Parameter Automatic Selection .............................................................................................................................................................. 148
Speed Reference Selection .............................................................................................................................................................................. 149
6 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Up/Down Command Selection....................................................................................................................................................................... 150
Stopping Method Selection ............................................................................................................................................................................ 150
Ramp to Stop .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 150
Coast to Stop................................................................................................................................................................................................... 150
Digital Input Reading ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 150
Up/Down Command Selection while in Programming Mode ....................................................................................................................... 151
Phase Order Selection..................................................................................................................................................................................... 151
Switched Phase Order..................................................................................................................................................................................... 151
Magnetic Flux Compensation......................................................................................................................................................................... 151
Magnetic Flux Compensation Value .............................................................................................................................................................. 151
Timer Function On-Delay Time ..................................................................................................................................................................... 152
Dwell Function ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 152
Dwell Speed, Dwell Time at Start.................................................................................................................................................................. 152
Droop Control................................................................................................................................................................................................. 153
Energy Saving Control Selection ................................................................................................................................................................... 153
Acceleration Ramps;Deceleration Ramps...................................................................................................................................................... 155
Emergency Stop Ramp ................................................................................................................................................................................... 156
Accel/Decel Setting Resolution...................................................................................................................................................................... 157
Jerk Settings.................................................................................................................................................................................................... 157
Jerk at Accel Start........................................................................................................................................................................................... 157
Jerk at Accel End............................................................................................................................................................................................ 157
Jerk at Decel Start........................................................................................................................................................................................... 157
Jerk at Decel End............................................................................................................................................................................................ 157
Jerk below Leveling Speed............................................................................................................................................................................. 157
Slip Compensation Gain................................................................................................................................................................................. 158
Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time........................................................................................................................................................ 158
Slip Compensation Limit................................................................................................................................................................................ 158
Slip Compensation Selection during Regeneration........................................................................................................................................ 158
Output Voltage Limit Operation Selection..................................................................................................................................................... 159
Motor 2 Slip Compensation Gain................................................................................................................................................................... 159
Motor 2 Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time.......................................................................................................................................... 159
Motor 2 Slip Compensation Limit.................................................................................................................................................................. 159
Torque Compensation Gain............................................................................................................................................................................ 160
Torque Compensation at Forward Start ......................................................................................................................................................... 160
Torque Compensation at Reverse Start .......................................................................................................................................................... 160
Torque Compensation Time Constant............................................................................................................................................................ 161
Motor 2 Torque Compensation Gain.............................................................................................................................................................. 161
Speed Control Loop........................................................................................................................................................................................ 161
Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain.......................................................................................................................................................... 162
Speed Control Loop Delay Time during Position Lock ................................................................................................................................. 163
Motor Inertia................................................................................................................................................................................................... 163
Load Inertia Ratio........................................................................................................................................................................................... 163
Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain Time during Position
Lock................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 163
Speed Control Loop Integral Time during Position Lock .............................................................................................................................. 163
Set Vibrational Frequency Filter .................................................................................................................................................................... 163
Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain Time during Position
Lock................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 163
Carrier Frequency ........................................................................................................................................................................................... 164
PWM Method ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 164
Carrier Frequency during Rotational Auto-Tuning........................................................................................................................................ 164
Inspection Operation Carrier Frequency ........................................................................................................................................................ 164
Carrier Frequency during Initial Motor Pole Search ...................................................................................................................................... 164
Carrier Frequency during Rescue Operation.................................................................................................................................................. 164
Speed Reference ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 165
Speed Reference Selection Mode ................................................................................................................................................................... 165
Multi-Speed References ................................................................................................................................................................................. 165
High Speed Reference Has Priority................................................................................................................................................................ 165
Leveling Speed Reference Has Priority ......................................................................................................................................................... 165
Nominal Speed ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 166
Intermediate Speed ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 166
Releveling Speed ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 166
Inspection Operation Speed............................................................................................................................................................................ 166
Rescue Operation Speed................................................................................................................................................................................. 166
Leveling Speed ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 166
Motor 2 Speed Reference ............................................................................................................................................................................... 167
Leveling Speed Detection Level .................................................................................................................................................................... 167
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 7
Inspection Speed Detection Level................................................................................................................................................................... 167
Field Forcing ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 167
V/f Pattern ....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 168
Input Voltage Setting ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 168
V/f Pattern Selection ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 168
Motor Parameters ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 169
Motor Rated Current ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 169
Motor Rated Slip ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 169
Motor No-Load Current .................................................................................................................................................................................. 170
Motor Poles for Induction Motors................................................................................................................................................................... 170
Motor Line-to-Line Resistance ....................................................................................................................................................................... 170
E-Type Insulation............................................................................................................................................................................................ 170
B-Type Insulation............................................................................................................................................................................................ 170
F-Type Insulation ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 170
Motor Leakage Inductance.............................................................................................................................................................................. 170
Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient 1....................................................................................................................................................... 170
Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient 2....................................................................................................................................................... 170
Motor Mechanical Loss................................................................................................................................................................................... 171
Motor Iron Loss for Torque Compensation .................................................................................................................................................... 171
Motor Rated Power ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 171
Setting Motor Parameters Manually ............................................................................................................................................................... 171
V/f Pattern for Motor 2.................................................................................................................................................................................... 172
Motor 2 Max Output Frequency...................................................................................................................................................................... 172
Motor 2 Max Voltage...................................................................................................................................................................................... 172
Motor 2 Base Frequency ................................................................................................................................................................................. 172
Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency ...................................................................................................................................................................... 172
Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency Voltage......................................................................................................................................................... 172
Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency............................................................................................................................................................. 172
Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency Voltage .............................................................................................................................................. 172
Motor 2 Parameters ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 173
Motor 2 Rated Current .................................................................................................................................................................................... 173
Motor 2 Rated Slip .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 173
Motor 2 Rated No-Load Current..................................................................................................................................................................... 173
Motor 2 Motor Poles ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 173
Motor 2 Line-to-Line Resistance .................................................................................................................................................................... 173
Motor 2 Leakage Inductance........................................................................................................................................................................... 174
PM Motor Settings .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 174
Motor Rated Power for PM motors................................................................................................................................................................. 174
Motor Rated Current for PM motors............................................................................................................................................................... 174
Motor Poles ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 174
Motor Stator Resistance for PM motors (Single Phase) ................................................................................................................................. 174
Motor d-Axis Inductance for PM motors........................................................................................................................................................ 174
Motor q-Axis Inductance for PM motors........................................................................................................................................................ 174
Motor Induction Voltage Constant 1 for PM motors ...................................................................................................................................... 175
Encoder Offset for PM motors ........................................................................................................................................................................ 175
Motor Induction Voltage Constant 2 for PM motors ...................................................................................................................................... 175
Option Settings................................................................................................................................................................................................ 176
Encoder Feedback Settings;PG Feedback Settings......................................................................................................................................... 176
Encoder 1 Resolution ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 176
Operation Selection at PG Open Circuit (PGo) .............................................................................................................................................. 176
PG Open-Circuit Detection Time.................................................................................................................................................................... 176
Operation Selection at Overspeed (oS) ........................................................................................................................................................... 176
Overspeed Detection Level ............................................................................................................................................................................. 176
Overspeed Detection Delay Time ................................................................................................................................................................... 176
Operation Selection at Deviation .................................................................................................................................................................... 177
Excessive Speed Deviation Detection Level................................................................................................................................................... 177
Excessive Speed Deviation Detection Delay Time......................................................................................................................................... 177
Encoder 1 Rotation Direction Selection.......................................................................................................................................................... 177
PG1 Pulse Monitor Output Division Ratio ..................................................................................................................................................... 177
dv3 Detection Selection .................................................................................................................................................................................. 177
dv4 Detection Selection .................................................................................................................................................................................. 177
PG Option Card Disconnect Detection 1 ........................................................................................................................................................ 178
dEv Detection Condition Selection ................................................................................................................................................................. 178
Encoder Selection............................................................................................................................................................................................ 178
PGoH Detection Level .................................................................................................................................................................................... 178
Communication Speed of Serial Encoder Selection ....................................................................................................................................... 179
PGoH Detection Level .................................................................................................................................................................................... 179
8 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Encoder Adjust 1 to 16 ................................................................................................................................................................................... 179
Digital Input Card Settings;DI-A3 Option Card Settings............................................................................................................................... 179
DI-A3 Option Card Input Selection ............................................................................................................................................................... 179
DI-A3 Option Card Data Length Selection .................................................................................................................................................... 180
Analog Monitor Card Settings;AO-A3 Option Card Settings........................................................................................................................ 180
Digital Output Card Settings;DO-A3 Option Card Settings .......................................................................................................................... 181
Communication Option Card ......................................................................................................................................................................... 181
Operation Selection after Communications Error .......................................................................................................................................... 181
External Fault from Communication Option Detection
Selection ......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 182
bUS Error Detection Time.............................................................................................................................................................................. 182
Torque Limit Selection from
Communications Option................................................................................................................................................................................. 182
Reset Communication Parameters.................................................................................................................................................................. 182
CANopen Parameters ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 182
Terminal Functions......................................................................................................................................................................................... 183
Multi-Function Digital Inputs......................................................................................................................................................................... 183
Functions for Terminals S3 to S8 ................................................................................................................................................................... 183
Multi-Function Digital Input Terminal Settings............................................................................................................................................. 183
Baseblock Command...................................................................................................................................................................................... 184
Through mode ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 184
Fault Reset ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 184
Emergency Stop (N.O., N.C.) ......................................................................................................................................................................... 184
Emergency Stop Sequence ............................................................................................................................................................................. 184
Motor Selection .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 185
External fault .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 185
Motor Contactor Feedback ............................................................................................................................................................................. 186
High Speed Limit Up...................................................................................................................................................................................... 186
High Speed Limit Down................................................................................................................................................................................. 187
Brake Feedback .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 187
Multi-Function Digital Outputs...................................................................................................................................................................... 187
Terminal M1-M2 Function Selection;Terminal M3-M4 Function Selection;Terminal M5-M6 Function Selection;Terminal P1-C1 Function Selec-
tion;Terminal P1-C2 Function Selection........................................................................................................................................................ 187
Multi-Function Digital Output Terminal Settings.......................................................................................................................................... 187
During Run ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 188
Zero Speed...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 188
Zero-Speed Time Chart .................................................................................................................................................................................. 188
Speed agree 1.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 188
Speed Agree 1 Time Chart ............................................................................................................................................................................. 188
User-Set Speed Agree 1 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs)............................................................................................................................ 189
User Set Speed Agree 1 Time Chart............................................................................................................................................................... 189
Speed Detection 1........................................................................................................................................................................................... 189
Speed Detection 1 Time Chart ....................................................................................................................................................................... 189
Speed Detection 2........................................................................................................................................................................................... 189
Speed Detection 2 Time Chart ....................................................................................................................................................................... 190
Drive Ready.................................................................................................................................................................................................... 190
DC Bus Undervoltage (Uv1) .......................................................................................................................................................................... 190
During Baseblock (N.O.)................................................................................................................................................................................ 190
Torque Detection 1 ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 191
Torque Detection 2 ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 191
Fault (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) .......................................................................................................................................................... 191
Through mode ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 191
Minor Fault (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) ............................................................................................................................................... 191
Fault Reset Command Active (Multi-Function Digital
Outputs) .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 191
Timer Output .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 191
Speed agree 2 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs)............................................................................................................................................ 191
User-Set Speed Agree 2 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs)............................................................................................................................ 192
Speed Detection 3 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs)..................................................................................................................................... 192
Speed Detection 4 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs)..................................................................................................................................... 193
During Down Direction (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) ............................................................................................................................ 193
During Baseblock (N.C.) ................................................................................................................................................................................ 193
During Regeneration (Multi-Function Digital Outputs)................................................................................................................................. 194
Restart Enabled (Multi-Function Digital Outputs)......................................................................................................................................... 194
Maintenance Period (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) .................................................................................................................................. 194
During Torque Limit (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) ................................................................................................................................ 194
Within Position Lock Bandwidth (Multi-Function Digital
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 9
Outputs)........................................................................................................................................................................................................... 194
During Frequency Output (Multi-Function Digital Outputs).......................................................................................................................... 194
Input Phase Loss (Multi-Function Digital Outputs)........................................................................................................................................ 195
Input Phase Loss (Multi-Function Digital Outputs)........................................................................................................................................ 195
Brake Control .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 195
Output Contactor Control................................................................................................................................................................................ 195
Door Zone Reached......................................................................................................................................................................................... 195
Not Zero Speed (Multi-Function Digital Outputs).......................................................................................................................................... 195
Light Load Direction (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) ................................................................................................................................. 195
Safe Disable Status (Multi-Function Digital Outputs).................................................................................................................................... 195
Safe Disable Status (Multi-Function Digital Outputs).................................................................................................................................... 195
Motor Pole Search Status (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) .......................................................................................................................... 195
Multi-Function Analog Inputs......................................................................................................................................................................... 196
Terminal A1 Signal Level Selection ............................................................................................................................................................... 196
Terminal A1 Function Selection ..................................................................................................................................................................... 196
Terminal A1 Gain............................................................................................................................................................................................ 196
Terminal A2 Signal Level Selection ............................................................................................................................................................... 197
Terminal A2 Function Selection ..................................................................................................................................................................... 197
Terminal A2 Gain............................................................................................................................................................................................ 197
Analog Input Filter Time Constant ................................................................................................................................................................. 197
Speed Reference Bias...................................................................................................................................................................................... 198
Torque Compensation (Multi-Function Analog Inputs) ................................................................................................................................. 198
Through mode ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 198
Multi-Function Analog Outputs ...................................................................................................................................................................... 199
Terminal FM Monitor Selection;Terminal AM Monitor Selection ................................................................................................................ 199
Output Terminal FM Gain............................................................................................................................................................................... 199
Terminal AM Gain .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 199
Terminal FM Signal Level Selection .............................................................................................................................................................. 200
Terminal AM Signal Level Selection.............................................................................................................................................................. 200
Protection Functions........................................................................................................................................................................................ 201
Motor Protection ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 201
Motor Overload Protection Selection.............................................................................................................................................................. 201
Motor Overload Protection Time .................................................................................................................................................................... 203
Cold Start......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 203
Hot Start .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 203
Motor Overheat Alarm Operation Selection
(PTC thermistor input) .................................................................................................................................................................................... 204
Motor Overheat Fault Operation Selection
(PTC thermistor input) .................................................................................................................................................................................... 204
Motor Temperature Input Filter Time (PTC thermistor input) ....................................................................................................................... 205
Continuous Electrothermal Operation Selection............................................................................................................................................. 205
Undervoltage Detection................................................................................................................................................................................... 205
Undervoltage Detection Level (Uv) ................................................................................................................................................................ 205
Stall Prevention ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 205
Stall Prevention Selection during Acceleration .............................................................................................................................................. 205
Stall Prevention During Acceleration ............................................................................................................................................................. 206
Stall Prevention Selection during Run ............................................................................................................................................................ 206
Speed Detection............................................................................................................................................................................................... 207
Speed Agreement Detection Level.................................................................................................................................................................. 207
Speed Reference Loss Detection Selection ..................................................................................................................................................... 207
Speed Reference at Reference Loss ................................................................................................................................................................ 207
Speed Agree Detection Selection.................................................................................................................................................................... 208
Door Zone Level ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 208
Fault Restart .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 208
Number of Auto Reset Attempts..................................................................................................................................................................... 209
Fault Output Operation during Auto Restart................................................................................................................................................... 209
Torque Detection............................................................................................................................................................................................. 209
Torque Detection Selection 1.......................................................................................................................................................................... 210
Torque Detection Selection 2.......................................................................................................................................................................... 210
Torque Limit ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 211
Forward Torque Limit..................................................................................................................................................................................... 212
Reverse Torque Limit...................................................................................................................................................................................... 212
Forward Regenerative Torque Limit............................................................................................................................................................... 212
Reverse Regenerative Torque Limit ............................................................................................................................................................... 212
Torque Limit Process at Start.......................................................................................................................................................................... 212
Drive Protection .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 212
Overheat Alarm Level..................................................................................................................................................................................... 212
10 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Overheat Pre-Alarm Operation Selection....................................................................................................................................................... 212
Input Phase Loss Protection Selection ........................................................................................................................................................... 213
Output Phase Loss Protection......................................................................................................................................................................... 213
Output Ground Fault Detection Selection ...................................................................................................................................................... 214
Heatsink Cooling Fan Operation Selection .................................................................................................................................................... 214
Ambient Temperature Setting ........................................................................................................................................................................ 214
oL2 Characteristics Selection at Low Speeds ................................................................................................................................................ 214
Current Unbalance Detection (LF2) ............................................................................................................................................................... 215
Installation Selection ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 215
IP20 Enclosure................................................................................................................................................................................................ 215
NEMA Type 1 Enclosure ............................................................................................................................................................................... 215
Automatic Torque Boost Function ................................................................................................................................................................. 215
Reduced Carrier Frequency ............................................................................................................................................................................ 216
Internal Braking Transistor Protection ........................................................................................................................................................... 216
Overload Tolerance for Internal Braking Transistor ...................................................................................................................................... 216
Current Monitoring Selection......................................................................................................................................................................... 217
Current Monitoring Level............................................................................................................................................................................... 217
Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Gain ............................................................................................................................................ 218
Leakage Current Vibration Control Selection ................................................................................................................................................ 218
Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Gain ............................................................................................................................................ 218
Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Time Constant ........................................................................................................................... 218
Inertia Compensation...................................................................................................................................................................................... 219
Inertia Compensation Control ........................................................................................................................................................................ 219
Motor Acceleration Time ............................................................................................................................................................................... 219
Measuring Acceleration Time ........................................................................................................................................................................ 220
Inertia Compensation Gain............................................................................................................................................................................. 220
Online Tuning................................................................................................................................................................................................. 221
Online Tuning Gain........................................................................................................................................................................................ 222
PM Motor Control Tuning.............................................................................................................................................................................. 222
Initial Polarity Estimation Current ................................................................................................................................................................. 222
Initial Rotor Position Detection Selection...................................................................................................................................................... 222
High Frequency Injection ............................................................................................................................................................................... 222
High Frequency Injection Level ..................................................................................................................................................................... 222
High Frequency Injection Amplitude............................................................................................................................................................. 223
High Frequency Injection during Rescue Operation ...................................................................................................................................... 223
High Frequency Injection Amplitude during Rescue
Operation ........................................................................................................................................................................................................ 223
Polarity Detection Current.............................................................................................................................................................................. 223
Magnet Pole Search Error Detection Selection .............................................................................................................................................. 223
q-Axis Current Control Integral Time during Normal
Operation ........................................................................................................................................................................................................ 223
d-Axis Current Control Gain during Normal Operation ................................................................................................................................ 224
d-Axis Current Control Integral Time during Normal
Operation ........................................................................................................................................................................................................ 224
Output Voltage Limit ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 224
Current Detection Adjustments ...................................................................................................................................................................... 224
A/D Conversion Start Delay........................................................................................................................................................................... 224
Operator Function Setting .............................................................................................................................................................................. 225
LCD Operator:Monitor Selection;LED Operator:Monitor Selection............................................................................................................. 225
User Monitor Selection after Power Up ......................................................................................................................................................... 225
LCD Operator:Display Unit Selection;LED Operator:Display Unit Selection.............................................................................................. 225
Speed Reference Unit ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 225
Elevator units ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 225
LCD Contrast Control .................................................................................................................................................................................... 226
User Monitor Selection Mode ........................................................................................................................................................................ 226
Second Line Monitor Selection ...................................................................................................................................................................... 226
Third Line Monitor Selection ......................................................................................................................................................................... 226
User-Set Display Units Maximum Value....................................................................................................................................................... 227
User-Set Display Units Decimal Display ....................................................................................................................................................... 227
Traction Sheave Diameter .............................................................................................................................................................................. 227
Roping Ratio................................................................................................................................................................................................... 227
Mechanical Gear Ratio ................................................................................................................................................................................... 227
HBB Non Display Select................................................................................................................................................................................ 228
LO/RE (LOCAL/REMOTE) Key Function Selection ................................................................................................................................... 228
STOP Key Function Selection........................................................................................................................................................................ 228
User Parameter Default Value........................................................................................................................................................................ 228
Initialize Parameters ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 228
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 11
Drive Model Selection .................................................................................................................................................................................... 229
Speed Reference Setting Method Selection .................................................................................................................................................... 229
Operation Selection when Digital Operator is Disconnected.......................................................................................................................... 229
Copy Allowed Selection.................................................................................................................................................................................. 230
Maintenance Monitor Settings ........................................................................................................................................................................ 230
Cumulative Operation Time Setting ............................................................................................................................................................... 230
Cooling Fan Operation Time Setting .............................................................................................................................................................. 231
Capacitor Maintenance Setting ....................................................................................................................................................................... 231
DC Bus Pre-charge Relay Maintenance Setting ............................................................................................................................................. 231
IGBT Maintenance Setting.............................................................................................................................................................................. 231
U2, U3 Initialization........................................................................................................................................................................................ 231
kWh Monitor Initialization.............................................................................................................................................................................. 231
kWh Data......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 231
Number of Travels Counter Reset................................................................................................................................................................... 232
Elevator Parameters......................................................................................................................................................................................... 233
Brake Sequence ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 233
Zero Speed Level at Stop ................................................................................................................................................................................ 233
DC Injection Current at Start .......................................................................................................................................................................... 233
DC Injection Current at Stop........................................................................................................................................................................... 233
DC Injection Time at Start;Position Lock Time at Start................................................................................................................................. 233
DC Injection Time at Stop;Position Lock Time at Stop ................................................................................................................................. 233
Brake Release Delay Time.............................................................................................................................................................................. 234
Brake Close Delay Time ................................................................................................................................................................................. 234
Run Command Delay Time............................................................................................................................................................................. 234
Output Contactor Open Delay Time ............................................................................................................................................................... 234
Motor Contactor Control During Auto-Tuning Selection............................................................................................................................... 234
Emergency Stop Start Level............................................................................................................................................................................ 235
Slip Compensation for Elevators..................................................................................................................................................................... 235
Slip Compensation Gain in Motoring Mode ................................................................................................................................................... 235
Slip Compensation Gain in Regenerative Mode ............................................................................................................................................. 235
Slip Compensation Torque Detection Delay Time ......................................................................................................................................... 235
Slip Compensation Torque Detection Time.................................................................................................................................................... 235
Position Lock Gain at Start ............................................................................................................................................................................. 236
Position Lock Gain at Stop.............................................................................................................................................................................. 236
Position Lock Completion Width.................................................................................................................................................................... 236
Starting Torque Compensation Increase Time................................................................................................................................................ 236
Torque Compensation Diminish Speed........................................................................................................................................................... 237
Torque Compensation Diminish Time............................................................................................................................................................ 237
Torque Limit Reduction Time......................................................................................................................................................................... 237
DC Injection Gain in Regenerative Operation ................................................................................................................................................ 237
DC Injection Gain in Motoring Operation ...................................................................................................................................................... 238
Torque Compensation Value with Load Condition 1 ..................................................................................................................................... 238
Torque Compensation Value with Load Condition 2 ..................................................................................................................................... 238
Analog Input from Load Cell with Load Condition 1..................................................................................................................................... 238
Analog Input from Load Cell with Load Condition 2..................................................................................................................................... 238
Anti-Rollback Torque Bias 1 .......................................................................................................................................................................... 238
Anti-Rollback Torque Bias 2 .......................................................................................................................................................................... 238
Position Deviation Level to Apply Torque Bias 1 .......................................................................................................................................... 238
Position Deviation Level to Apply Torque Bias 2 .......................................................................................................................................... 239
Anti-Rollback Integral Gain............................................................................................................................................................................ 239
Anti-Rollback Movement Detection Level ..................................................................................................................................................... 239
Rescue Operation ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 239
Light Load Direction Search ........................................................................................................................................................................... 239
Rescue Operation Torque Limit...................................................................................................................................................................... 240
Rescue Operation Power Supply Selection..................................................................................................................................................... 240
UPS Power ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 240
UPS Operation Speed Limit Selection ............................................................................................................................................................ 240
DC Bus Voltage during Rescue Operation ..................................................................................................................................................... 240
Rescue Operation Power Supply Deterioration
Detection Level ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 241
Speed Reference Selection at Rescue Operation............................................................................................................................................. 241
Short Floor Function ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 241
Motor Contactor Response Error (SE1) Detection/Reset
Selection;SE1 Detection/Reset Selection........................................................................................................................................................ 247
Starting Current Error (SE2) Detection Delay Time;SE2 Detection Delay Time .......................................................................................... 247
SE2 Detect Current Level ............................................................................................................................................................................... 247
Output Current Error (SE3) Detection Delay Time;SE3 Detection Delay Time............................................................................................ 247
12 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Brake Response Error (SE4) Detection Delay Time;SE4 Detection Delay Time.......................................................................................... 247
Overacceleration Detection Level .................................................................................................................................................................. 247
Overacceleration Detection Time................................................................................................................................................................... 248
Overacceleration Detection Selection ............................................................................................................................................................ 248
Speed Reference Loss Detection .................................................................................................................................................................... 248
Speed Reference Missing (FrL)...................................................................................................................................................................... 248
Restart after Baseblock Selection ................................................................................................................................................................... 248
Operation Status Monitors.............................................................................................................................................................................. 249
Fault Trace...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 249
Fault History................................................................................................................................................................................................... 249
Maintenance Monitors.................................................................................................................................................................................... 249
Control Monitors ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 249
Types of Alarms, Faults, and Errors............................................................................................................................................................... 254
Faults .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 254
Minor Faults and Alarms................................................................................................................................................................................ 254
Operation Errors ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 254
Tuning Errors.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 254
Copy Function Errors ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 254
Alarm and Error Displays............................................................................................................................................................................... 255
Faults .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 255
Fault Displays................................................................................................................................................................................................. 255
Minor Faults and Alarms................................................................................................................................................................................ 256
Minor Fault and Alarm Displays.................................................................................................................................................................... 256
Operation Errors ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 257
Operation Error Displays................................................................................................................................................................................ 257
Auto-Tuning Errors ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 258
Auto-Tuning Error Displays........................................................................................................................................................................... 258
Errors and Displays When Using the Copy Function .................................................................................................................................... 258
Copy Errors .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 258
boL.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 259
Braking Transistor Overload (boL) ................................................................................................................................................................ 259
bUS ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 259
Option Communication Error (bUS) .............................................................................................................................................................. 259
CE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 259
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication Error (CE)......................................................................................................................................... 259
CF ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 259
Control Fault (CF) .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 259
CPF00, CPF01................................................................................................................................................................................................ 259
Control Circuit Error (CPF00, CPF01) .......................................................................................................................................................... 259
CPF02 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 260
A/D Conversion Error (CPF02)...................................................................................................................................................................... 260
CPF03 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 260
Control Board Connection Error (CPF03) ..................................................................................................................................................... 260
CPF06 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 260
EEPROM Memory Data Error ....................................................................................................................................................................... 260
CPF07 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 260
Terminal Board Connection Error (CPF07, CPF08) ...................................................................................................................................... 260
CPF08 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 260
CPF20, CPF21................................................................................................................................................................................................ 260
Control Circuit Error (CPF20, CPF21) .......................................................................................................................................................... 260
CPF22 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 260
Hybrid IC Failure (CPF22)............................................................................................................................................................................. 260
CPF23 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 260
Control Board Connection Error (CPF23) ..................................................................................................................................................... 260
CPF24 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 260
Drive Unit Signal Fault (CPF24).................................................................................................................................................................... 260
CPF25 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 261
Terminal Board not Connected (CPF25)........................................................................................................................................................ 261
CPF26 to CPF35............................................................................................................................................................................................. 261
Control Circuit Error (CPF26 to CPF34) ....................................................................................................................................................... 261
A/D Conversion Error (CPF35)...................................................................................................................................................................... 261
dEv.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 261
Speed Deviation (dEv) ................................................................................................................................................................................... 261
dv1 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 261
Encoder Z Pulse Fault (dv1)........................................................................................................................................................................... 261
dv2 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 261
Z Pulse Noise Fault Detection (dv2) .............................................................................................................................................................. 261
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 13
dv3................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 261
Inversion Detection (dv3)................................................................................................................................................................................ 261
dv4................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 261
Inversion Prevention Detection (dv4) ............................................................................................................................................................. 261
dv6................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 262
Overacceleration Detection (dv6) ................................................................................................................................................................... 262
dv7................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 262
dv8................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 262
PM Rotor Position Estimation Error (dv8) ..................................................................................................................................................... 262
EF0 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 262
Option Card External Fault (EF0)................................................................................................................................................................... 262
EF3 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 262
External Fault (input terminal S3) (EF3) ........................................................................................................................................................ 262
EF4 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 262
External Fault (input terminal S4) (EF4) ........................................................................................................................................................ 262
EF5 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 262
External Fault (input terminal S5) (EF5) ........................................................................................................................................................ 262
EF6 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 262
External Fault (input terminal S6) (EF6) ........................................................................................................................................................ 262
EF7 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 262
External Fault (input terminal S7) (EF7) ........................................................................................................................................................ 262
EF8 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 262
External Fault (input terminal S8) (EF8) ........................................................................................................................................................ 262
Err.................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 263
EEPROM Write Error (Err) ............................................................................................................................................................................ 263
FrL................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 263
Speed Reference Missing (FrL) ...................................................................................................................................................................... 263
GF.................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 263
Ground Fault (GF)........................................................................................................................................................................................... 263
LF .................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 263
Output Phase Loss (LF)................................................................................................................................................................................... 263
LF2 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 263
Output Current Imbalance (LF2)..................................................................................................................................................................... 263
oC .................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 264
Overcurrent (oC) ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 264
oFA00.............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 264
Option Card Connection Error at Option Connector CN5-A
(oFA00) ........................................................................................................................................................................................................... 264
oFA01.............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 264
Option Card Fault at Option Connector CN5-A (oFA01)............................................................................................................................... 264
oFA05, oFA06................................................................................................................................................................................................. 264
Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port CN5-A
(oFA05, oFA06, oFA10, oFA11, oFA12 to oFA17,
oFA30 to oFA43) ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 264
oFA10, oFA11................................................................................................................................................................................................. 264
oFA12 to oFA17.............................................................................................................................................................................................. 264
oFA30 to oFA43.............................................................................................................................................................................................. 264
oFb00............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 265
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-B (oFb00).......................................................................................................................................... 265
oFb01............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 265
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-B (oFb01).......................................................................................................................................... 265
oFb02............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 265
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-B (oFb02).......................................................................................................................................... 265
oFb03 to oFb11 ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 265
Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port CN5-B
(oFb03 to oFb11, oFb12 to oFb17) ................................................................................................................................................................. 265
oFb12 to oFb17 ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 265
oFC00 .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 265
Option Card Connection Error at Option Port CN5-C
(oFC00) ........................................................................................................................................................................................................... 265
oFC01 .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 265
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-C (oFC01) ......................................................................................................................................... 265
oFC02 .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 265
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-C (oFC02) ......................................................................................................................................... 265
oFC03 to oFC11 .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 265
Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port CN5-C
(oFC03 to oFC11, oFC12 to oFC17) .............................................................................................................................................................. 265
14 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
oFC12 to oFC17 ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 265
oFC50 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 265
Encoder Option AD Conversion Error (oFC50) ............................................................................................................................................ 265
oFC51 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 266
Encoder Option Analog Circuit Error (oFC51).............................................................................................................................................. 266
oFC52 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 266
Encoder Communication Timeout (oFC52) ................................................................................................................................................... 266
oFC53 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 266
Encoder Communication Data Error (oFC53) ............................................................................................................................................... 266
oFC54 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 266
Encoder Error (oFC54)................................................................................................................................................................................... 266
oH ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 266
Heatsink Overheat (oH).................................................................................................................................................................................. 266
oH1 ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 266
Heatsink Overheat (oH1)................................................................................................................................................................................ 266
Motor Overheat Alarm (PTC thermistor input) (oH3) ................................................................................................................................... 266
Motor Overheat Fault (PTC thermistor input) (oH4) ..................................................................................................................................... 267
oL1.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 267
Motor Overload (oL1) .................................................................................................................................................................................... 267
oL2.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 267
Drive Overload (oL2) ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 267
oL3.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 267
Overtorque Detection 1 (oL3) ........................................................................................................................................................................ 267
oL4.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 267
Overtorque Detection 2 (oL4) ........................................................................................................................................................................ 267
oPr................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 268
External Digital Operator Connection Fault (oPr) ......................................................................................................................................... 268
oS.................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 268
Overspeed (oS) ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 268
ov .................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 268
DC Bus Overvoltage (ov)............................................................................................................................................................................... 268
PF.................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 268
Input Phase Loss (PF)..................................................................................................................................................................................... 268
PF5.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 268
Rescue Operation Power Supply Deterioration Error (PF5) .......................................................................................................................... 268
PGo ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 269
Encoder Disconnected (PGo) ......................................................................................................................................................................... 269
PGoH .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 269
Encoder Disconnected (PGoH) ...................................................................................................................................................................... 269
rF..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 269
Braking Resistor Fault.................................................................................................................................................................................... 269
rr ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 269
Dynamic Braking Transistor Fault (rr)........................................................................................................................................................... 269
SC ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 269
IGBT Short Circuit (SC) ................................................................................................................................................................................ 269
Safety Circuit Fault (SCF).............................................................................................................................................................................. 269
SE1 ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 269
Motor Contactor Response Error (SE1) ......................................................................................................................................................... 269
SE2 ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 269
Starting Current Error (SE2) .......................................................................................................................................................................... 269
SE3 ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 269
Output Current Error (SE3) ............................................................................................................................................................................ 269
SE4 ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 269
Brake Response Error (SE4) .......................................................................................................................................................................... 269
SvE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 270
Position Lock Error (SvE) .............................................................................................................................................................................. 270
STo ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 270
Motor Pull Out or Step Out Detection (STo) ................................................................................................................................................. 270
UL3................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 270
Undertorque Detection 1 (UL3) ..................................................................................................................................................................... 270
UL4................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 270
Undertorque Detection 2 (UL4) ..................................................................................................................................................................... 270
Uv1 ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 270
DC Bus Undervoltage (Uv1) .......................................................................................................................................................................... 270
Uv2 ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 270
Control Power Supply Voltage Fault (Uv2) ................................................................................................................................................... 270
Uv3 ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 270
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 15
Soft-Charge Bypass Circuit Fault (Uv3)......................................................................................................................................................... 270
voF................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 271
Output Voltage Detection Error (voF) ............................................................................................................................................................ 271
Alarm Detection .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 272
AEr .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 272
Communication Option Node ID Setting Error (CANopen)
(AEr)................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 272
bb..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 272
Baseblock (bb)................................................................................................................................................................................................. 272
boL .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 272
Braking Transistor Overload (boL)................................................................................................................................................................. 272
bUS.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 272
Option Communication Error (bUS)............................................................................................................................................................... 272
CALL .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 272
Serial Communication Stand By (CALL)....................................................................................................................................................... 272
CE.................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 273
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication Error (CE) ......................................................................................................................................... 273
CrST ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 273
Cannot Reset (CrST) ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 273
dEv .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 273
Speed Deviation (dEv) .................................................................................................................................................................................... 273
EF .................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 273
Up/Down Command Error (EF)...................................................................................................................................................................... 273
EF0 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 273
Option Card External Fault (EF0)................................................................................................................................................................... 273
EF3 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 273
External Fault (input terminal S3) (EF3) ........................................................................................................................................................ 273
EF4 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 273
External Fault (input terminal S4) (EF4) ........................................................................................................................................................ 273
EF5 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 273
External Fault (input terminal S5) (EF5) ........................................................................................................................................................ 273
EF6 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 273
External Fault (input terminal S6) (EF6) ........................................................................................................................................................ 273
EF7 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 273
External Fault (input terminal S7) (EF7) ........................................................................................................................................................ 273
EF8 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 273
External Fault (input terminal S8) (EF8) ........................................................................................................................................................ 273
Hbb .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 274
Safe Disable Signal Input (Hbb) ..................................................................................................................................................................... 274
HbbF................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 274
Safe Disable Circuit Fault Signal Input (HbbF).............................................................................................................................................. 274
HCA ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 274
High Current Alarm (HCA) ............................................................................................................................................................................ 274
LT-1................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 274
Cooling Fan Maintenance Time (LT-1) .......................................................................................................................................................... 274
LT-2................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 274
Capacitor Maintenance Time (LT-2) .............................................................................................................................................................. 274
LT-3................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 274
Soft Charge Bypass Relay Maintenance Time (LT-3).................................................................................................................................... 274
LT-4................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 274
IGBT Maintenance Time (90%) (LT-4).......................................................................................................................................................... 274
oH .................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 275
Heatsink Overheat (oH) .................................................................................................................................................................................. 275
Motor Overheat Alarm (PTC thermistor input) (oH3).................................................................................................................................... 275
oL3 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 275
Overtorque Detection 1 (oL3) ......................................................................................................................................................................... 275
oL4 .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 275
Overtorque Detection 2 (oL4) ......................................................................................................................................................................... 275
oS..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 275
Overspeed (oS)................................................................................................................................................................................................ 275
ov..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 275
DC Bus Overvoltage (ov)................................................................................................................................................................................ 275
PASS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 276
MEMOBUS/Modbus Comm. Test Mode Complete (PASS).......................................................................................................................... 276
PGo.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 276
Encoder Disconnected (PGo) .......................................................................................................................................................................... 276
PGoH............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 276
16 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Encoder Disconnected (PGoH) ...................................................................................................................................................................... 276
SE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 276
MEMOBUS/Modbus Self Test Failed (SE) ................................................................................................................................................... 276
TrPC ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 276
IGBT Maintenance Time (90%) (TrPC) ........................................................................................................................................................ 276
UL3................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 276
Undertorque Detection 1 (UL3) ..................................................................................................................................................................... 276
UL4................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 276
Undertorque Detection 2 (UL4) ..................................................................................................................................................................... 276
Uv ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 276
Undervoltage (Uv).......................................................................................................................................................................................... 276
voF.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 276
Output Voltage Detection Error (voF) ........................................................................................................................................................... 276
Operator Programming Errors........................................................................................................................................................................ 277
oPE01 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 277
Drive Capacity Setting Fault (oPE01) ............................................................................................................................................................ 277
oPE02 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 277
Parameter Range Setting Error (oPE02)......................................................................................................................................................... 277
oPE03 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 277
Multi-function Digital Input Selection Error (oPE03) ................................................................................................................................... 277
oPE04 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 277
Terminal Board Mismatch Error (oPE04)...................................................................................................................................................... 277
oPE05 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 277
Reference Source Selection Error (oPE05) .................................................................................................................................................... 277
oPE06 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 277
Control Mode Selection Error (oPE06) .......................................................................................................................................................... 277
oPE07 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 277
Multi-function Analog Input Selection Error (oPE07)................................................................................................................................... 277
oPE08 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 278
Parameter Selection Error (oPE08) ................................................................................................................................................................ 278
oPE10 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 278
V/f Pattern Setting Error (oPE10) .................................................................................................................................................................. 278
oPE16 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 278
Energy Savings Constants Error (oPE16) ...................................................................................................................................................... 278
oPE18 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 278
Parameter Setting Error, Online Tuning Parameter
Setting Error (oPE18) ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 278
oPE20 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 278
Auto-Tuning Fault Detection ......................................................................................................................................................................... 279
End1................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 279
Excessive V/f Setting (End1) ......................................................................................................................................................................... 279
End2................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 279
Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient (End2)............................................................................................................................................. 279
End3................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 279
Rated Current Setting Alarm (End3) .............................................................................................................................................................. 279
End4................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 279
Adjusted Slip Calculation Error (End4) ......................................................................................................................................................... 279
End5................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 279
Resistance Tuning Error (End5) ..................................................................................................................................................................... 279
End6................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 279
Leakage Inductance Alarm (End6)................................................................................................................................................................. 279
End7................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 279
No-Load Current Alarm (End7) ..................................................................................................................................................................... 279
End8................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 280
Rescue Operation Speed Warning (End8)...................................................................................................................................................... 280
End9................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 280
Rescue Operation Rotor Pole Position Search Warning
(End9) ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 280
End10.............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 280
Rescue Operation Rotor Polarity Detection Warning
(End10) ........................................................................................................................................................................................................... 280
Er-01 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 280
Motor Data Error (Er-01) ............................................................................................................................................................................... 280
Er-02 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 280
Alarm (Er-02) ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 280
Er-03 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 280
STOP Button Input (Er-03) ............................................................................................................................................................................ 280
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 17
Er-04................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 280
Line-to-Line Resistance Error (Er-04) ............................................................................................................................................................ 280
Er-05................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 280
No-Load Current Error (Er-05) ....................................................................................................................................................................... 280
Er-08................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 280
Rated Slip Error (Er-08).................................................................................................................................................................................. 280
Er-09................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 281
Acceleration Error (Er-09) .............................................................................................................................................................................. 281
Er-10................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 281
Motor Direction Error (Er-10)......................................................................................................................................................................... 281
Er-11................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 281
Motor Speed Fault (Er-11) .............................................................................................................................................................................. 281
Er-12................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 281
Current Detection Error (Er-12)...................................................................................................................................................................... 281
Er-13................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 281
Leakage Inductance Error (Er-13)................................................................................................................................................................... 281
Er-18................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 281
Induction Voltage Error (Er-18)...................................................................................................................................................................... 281
Er-19................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 281
Inductance Error (Er-19) ................................................................................................................................................................................. 281
Er-20................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 281
Stator Resistance Error (Er-20) ....................................................................................................................................................................... 281
Er-21................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 282
Z Pulse Correction Error (Er-21) .................................................................................................................................................................... 282
Er-22................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 282
Initial Rotor Pole Search Error (Er-22) ........................................................................................................................................................... 282
Er-23................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 282
Non-rotating Encoder Offset Tuning Warning (Er-23)................................................................................................................................... 282
Er-24................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 282
CoPy ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 283
Writing Parameter Settings (CoPy)................................................................................................................................................................. 283
CPEr ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 283
Control Mode Mismatch (CPEr) ..................................................................................................................................................................... 283
CPyE................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 283
Error Writing Data (CPyE) ............................................................................................................................................................................. 283
CSEr ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 283
Copy Unit Error (CSEr) .................................................................................................................................................................................. 283
dFPS ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 283
Drive Model Mismatch (dFPS) ....................................................................................................................................................................... 283
ECE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 283
Copy Error (ECE)............................................................................................................................................................................................ 283
ECS.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 283
Checksum Error (ECS).................................................................................................................................................................................... 283
EdE .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 283
Write Impossible (EdE)................................................................................................................................................................................... 283
EiF ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 283
Write Data Error (EiF) .................................................................................................................................................................................... 283
End .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 284
Task Complete (End) ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 284
EPE.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 284
ID Mismatch (EPE)......................................................................................................................................................................................... 284
ErE................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 284
Data Error (ErE) .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 284
EvE .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 284
Verify Error (EvE) .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 284
iFEr.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 284
Communication Error (iFEr)........................................................................................................................................................................... 284
ndAT................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 284
Model, Voltage Class, Capacity Mismatch (ndAT)........................................................................................................................................ 284
rdEr.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 284
Error Reading Data (rdEr)............................................................................................................................................................................... 284
rEAd ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 284
Reading Parameter Settings (flashing) (rEAd)................................................................................................................................................ 284
vAEr ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 284
Voltage Class, Capacity Mismatch (vAEr) ..................................................................................................................................................... 284
vFyE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 284
Parameter Settings in the Drive and Those Saved to
18 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
the Copy Function are not the Same (vFyE) .................................................................................................................................................. 284
vrFy................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 284
Comparing Parameter Settings (flashing) (vrFy) ........................................................................................................................................... 284
Diagnosing and Resetting Faults .................................................................................................................................................................... 285
Viewing Fault Trace Data After Fault............................................................................................................................................................ 285
Fault Reset Methods ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 286
Inspection ....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 291
Daily Inspection.............................................................................................................................................................................................. 291
Daily Inspection Checklist ............................................................................................................................................................................. 291
Periodic Inspection ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 292
Inspection ....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 292
Periodic Inspection Checklist ......................................................................................................................................................................... 292
Inspection ....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 292
Periodic Maintenance ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 293
Maintenance ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 293
Replacement Parts .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 293
Performance Life Monitors Maintenance Monitors ....................................................................................................................................... 293
Performance Life Monitors Maintenance Monitors ....................................................................................................................................... 293
Cumulative Operation Time of the Fan.......................................................................................................................................................... 293
Cumulative Fan Operation Time as a Percentage
of the Specified Maintenance Period.............................................................................................................................................................. 293
Cumulative Time the Capacitors are Used as
a Percentage of the Specified Maintenance Period ........................................................................................................................................ 293
Performance Life of the Inrush Circuit .......................................................................................................................................................... 293
Maintenance Period Reached by the IGBTs .................................................................................................................................................. 293
Alarm Outputs for Maintenance Monitors ..................................................................................................................................................... 294
Maintenance Alarms....................................................................................................................................................................................... 294
LT-1................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 294
LT-2................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 294
LT-3................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 294
LT-4................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 294
TrPC ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 294
Maintenance ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 294
Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans ...................................................................................................................................................... 295
Cooling Fan Replacement .............................................................................................................................................................................. 296
Fan Cover ....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 296
Removing the Fan Cover................................................................................................................................................................................ 297
Installing the Cooling Fan .............................................................................................................................................................................. 298
Installing the Cooling Fan .............................................................................................................................................................................. 300
Fan Unit .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 303
Fan Relay Cable ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 303
Fan Connector Cable (CN6) ........................................................................................................................................................................... 303
Fan Finger Guard............................................................................................................................................................................................ 304
Installing the Cooling Fan .............................................................................................................................................................................. 306
Drive Replacement ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 307
Control Terminal Board ................................................................................................................................................................................. 307
Replacing the Drive........................................................................................................................................................................................ 308
Options ........................................................................................................................................................................................................... 311
Peripheral Devices.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 311
Option ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 314
Peripheral Devices.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 314
DC Reactor ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 314
AC Reactor ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 314
Braking Unit ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 314
Analog Monitor .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 314
AO-A3 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 314
Digital Input.................................................................................................................................................................................................... 314
DI-A3.............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 314
Digital Output................................................................................................................................................................................................. 314
DO-A3 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 314
PG-B3 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 314
PG-X3............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 314
PG-F3 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 314
PG-E3 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 314
SI-S3 ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 314
LCD Operator ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 314
Remote Operator Cable .................................................................................................................................................................................. 314
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 19
USB Copy Unit ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 314
NEMA 1 Kit .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 314
24 V Power Supply ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 314
DriveWizard Plus ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 314
Connecting Peripheral Devices ....................................................................................................................................................................... 315
Option Card Installation .................................................................................................................................................................................. 316
Installing Peripheral Devices .......................................................................................................................................................................... 326
Braking Options .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 326
Braking Resistor.............................................................................................................................................................................................. 326
Installing a Braking Unit\: CDBR Type.......................................................................................................................................................... 326
Using Braking Units in Parallel ...................................................................................................................................................................... 327
Connecting Braking Units in Parallel.............................................................................................................................................................. 327
Installing a Molded Case Circuit Breaker (MCCB)........................................................................................................................................ 328
Installing a Leakage Breaker........................................................................................................................................................................... 328
Installing a Magnetic Contactor at the Power Supply Side............................................................................................................................. 329
Connecting an AC Reactor.............................................................................................................................................................................. 330
Connecting a DC Reactor................................................................................................................................................................................ 330
Noise Filter...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 331
Connecting a Noise Filter................................................................................................................................................................................ 331
Reducing Radiated, Conducted, and Induced Noise ....................................................................................................................................... 331
Radiated Noise ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 331
Conducted Noise ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 331
Induced Noise.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 331
Input-Side Noise Filter .................................................................................................................................................................................... 331
Output-Side Noise Filter ................................................................................................................................................................................. 332
Fuse ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 332
Input Fuses ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 332
Attachment for External Heatsink................................................................................................................................................................... 332
Installing a Motor Thermal Overload (oL) Relay ........................................................................................................................................... 333
General Precautions when Using Thermal Overload Relays .......................................................................................................................... 333
Specifications .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 335
Power Ratings (Three-Phase 200 V Class) ..................................................................................................................................................... 336
Maximum Applicable Motor Capacity .......................................................................................................................................................... 336
Input Current ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 336
Rated Voltage.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 336
Allowable Voltage Fluctuation ....................................................................................................................................................................... 336
Allowable Frequency Fluctuation ................................................................................................................................................................... 336
Input Power ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 336
Rated Output Capacity .................................................................................................................................................................................... 336
Rated Output Current ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 336
Overload Tolerance ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 336
Carrier Frequency............................................................................................................................................................................................ 336
Maximum Output Voltage .............................................................................................................................................................................. 336
Maximum Output Speed ................................................................................................................................................................................. 336
Power Ratings (Three-Phase 400 V Class) ..................................................................................................................................................... 337
Maximum Applicable Motor Capacity ........................................................................................................................................................... 337
Input Current ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 337
Rated Voltage.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 337
Rated Frequency.............................................................................................................................................................................................. 337
Allowable Voltage Fluctuation ....................................................................................................................................................................... 337
Allowable Frequency Fluctuation ................................................................................................................................................................... 337
Input Power ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 337
Rated Output Capacity .................................................................................................................................................................................... 337
Rated Output Current ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 337
Overload Tolerance ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 337
Carrier Frequency............................................................................................................................................................................................ 337
Maximum Output Voltage .............................................................................................................................................................................. 337
Maximum Output Speed ................................................................................................................................................................................. 337
Drive Specifications ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 338
Frequency Control Range................................................................................................................................................................................ 338
Frequency Accuracy (Temperature Fluctuation) ............................................................................................................................................ 338
Frequency Setting Resolution ......................................................................................................................................................................... 338
Output Speed Resolution................................................................................................................................................................................. 338
Frequency Setting Signal ................................................................................................................................................................................ 338
Starting Torque................................................................................................................................................................................................ 338
Speed Control Range....................................................................................................................................................................................... 338
Speed Control Accuracy.................................................................................................................................................................................. 338
20 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Speed Response .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 338
Torque Limit................................................................................................................................................................................................... 338
Accel/Decel Ramp.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 338
Braking Transistor .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 338
V/f Characteristics .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 338
Overcurrent Protection ................................................................................................................................................................................... 338
Overload Protection........................................................................................................................................................................................ 338
Overvoltage Protection................................................................................................................................................................................... 338
Undervoltage Protection................................................................................................................................................................................. 338
Safety Standard............................................................................................................................................................................................... 338
Drive Watt Loss Data ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 339
Watt Loss 200 V Class Three Phase Models.................................................................................................................................................. 339
Watt Loss 400 V Class Three Phase Models.................................................................................................................................................. 339
Drive Derating Data ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 340
Carrier Frequency and Current Derating ........................................................................................................................................................ 340
Carrier Frequency Derating............................................................................................................................................................................ 341
Temperature Derating..................................................................................................................................................................................... 342
Ambient Temperature Setting ........................................................................................................................................................................ 342
Installation Method Selection......................................................................................................................................................................... 342
Parameter List................................................................................................................................................................................................. 343
Monitor Parameters ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 379
Operation Status Monitors.............................................................................................................................................................................. 379
Fault Trace...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 381
Fault History................................................................................................................................................................................................... 382
Maintenance Monitors.................................................................................................................................................................................... 382
Cumulative Operation Time ........................................................................................................................................................................... 382
Cooling Fan Operation Time.......................................................................................................................................................................... 382
Cooling Fan Maintenance............................................................................................................................................................................... 382
Capacitor Maintenance................................................................................................................................................................................... 382
Soft Charge Bypass Relay Maintenance ........................................................................................................................................................ 383
IGBT Maintenance ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 383
Heatsink Temperature .................................................................................................................................................................................... 383
LED Check ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 383
kWh ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 383
Control Monitors ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 384
Max. Current during Leveling Speed ............................................................................................................................................................. 384
Slip Compensation Value ............................................................................................................................................................................... 384
Car Acceleration Rate..................................................................................................................................................................................... 384
Flux Position Detection (sensor) .................................................................................................................................................................... 385
Speed Detection PG1 Counter........................................................................................................................................................................ 385
Position Lock Deviation Counter ................................................................................................................................................................... 385
Control Mode Dependent Parameter Default Values..................................................................................................................................... 386
A1-02 (Control Mode) Dependent Parameters............................................................................................................................................... 386
E3-01 (Motor 2 Control Mode) Dependent Parameters ................................................................................................................................. 386
Defaults by Drive Model Selection (o2-04) ................................................................................................................................................... 387
Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection
(o1-03) ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 389
Unit Selection:Jerk ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 389
Unit Selection:Accel/Decel Ramps ................................................................................................................................................................ 389
Unit Selection:Speed Reference ..................................................................................................................................................................... 389
Unit Selection:Elevator Unit .......................................................................................................................................................................... 389
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communications ......................................................................................................................................................... 391
MEMOBUS/Modbus Specifications .............................................................................................................................................................. 393
Connecting to a Network................................................................................................................................................................................ 394
Serial Communications Cable Connection Terminals ................................................................................................................................... 394
Multiple Connection ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 395
RS-485 Interface............................................................................................................................................................................................. 395
RS-422 Interface............................................................................................................................................................................................. 395
Network Termination ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 395
MEMOBUS/Modbus Setup Parameters......................................................................................................................................................... 396
Drive Slave Address ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 396
Communication Speed Selection.................................................................................................................................................................... 396
Communication Parity Selection.................................................................................................................................................................... 396
Stopping Method after Communication Error................................................................................................................................................ 396
Communication Fault Detection Selection..................................................................................................................................................... 397
CE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 397
Drive Transmit Wait Time ............................................................................................................................................................................. 397
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 21
RTS Control Selection .................................................................................................................................................................................... 397
Communication Fault Detection Time............................................................................................................................................................ 397
Unit Selection for MEMOBUS/Modbus Register 0025H............................................................................................................................... 397
Communications Enter Function Selection..................................................................................................................................................... 398
Enter Command Necessary ............................................................................................................................................................................. 398
Enter Command not Necessary ....................................................................................................................................................................... 398
Communications Timing................................................................................................................................................................................. 400
Command Messages from Master to Drive..................................................................................................................................................... 400
Minimum Wait Time for Sending Messages .................................................................................................................................................. 400
Response Messages from Drive to Master...................................................................................................................................................... 400
Message Format .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 401
Slave Address.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 401
Function Code ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 401
CRC-16............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 402
Cyclic Redundancy Check .............................................................................................................................................................................. 402
CRC-16 Checksum Calculation Example ....................................................................................................................................................... 402
Reading Drive MEMOBUS/Modbus Register Contents ................................................................................................................................ 403
Loopback Test ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 403
Writing to Multiple Registers.......................................................................................................................................................................... 404
MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table.................................................................................................................................................................... 405
Command Data................................................................................................................................................................................................ 405
Monitor Data ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 406
Broadcast Messages ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 413
Fault Trace Contents ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 413
Fault Trace / History Register Contents.......................................................................................................................................................... 413
Alarm Register Contents ................................................................................................................................................................................. 414
Alarm Register 007FH Contents ..................................................................................................................................................................... 414
Enter Command............................................................................................................................................................................................... 415
Enter Command Types.................................................................................................................................................................................... 415
Enter Command Settings when Upgrading the Drive..................................................................................................................................... 415
Communication Errors .................................................................................................................................................................................... 416
MEMOBUS/Modbus Error Codes .................................................................................................................................................................. 416
Self-Diagnostics .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 417
Self-Diagnosing Function of the Serial Communication
Interface Circuits ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 417
Terminal Connections for Communication
Self-Diagnostics .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 417
European Standards......................................................................................................................................................................................... 422
CE Mark .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 422
CE Low Voltage Directive Compliance.......................................................................................................................................................... 422
EMC Guidelines Compliance.......................................................................................................................................................................... 424
EMC Filter Installation.................................................................................................................................................................................... 424
EMC Filter and Drive Installation for CE Compliance................................................................................................................................... 425
EMC Filters ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 426
IEC/EN61800-3 C2 Filters.............................................................................................................................................................................. 426
IEC/EN61800-3 C2 Filters.............................................................................................................................................................................. 427
AC Reactors for IEC/EN 12015 Compliance ................................................................................................................................................. 428
UL and CSA Standards ................................................................................................................................................................................... 429
UL/cUL Mark.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 429
Wire Gauge, Three Phase 200 V Class ........................................................................................................................................................... 429
Torque Specifications, Three Phase 200 V Class ........................................................................................................................................... 429
Wire Gauge, Three Phase 400 V Class ........................................................................................................................................................... 431
Torque Specifications, Three Phase 400 V Class ........................................................................................................................................... 431
Low Voltage Wiring........................................................................................................................................................................................ 435
Low Voltage Wiring for Control Circuit Terminals ....................................................................................................................................... 435
Drive Short-Circuit Rating .............................................................................................................................................................................. 435
Drive Motor Overload Protection ................................................................................................................................................................... 436
Overload Protection......................................................................................................................................................................................... 436
Motor Rated Current ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 436
Motor Overload Protection Selection.............................................................................................................................................................. 436
Motor Overload Protection Time .................................................................................................................................................................... 437
Safe Disable Input Function............................................................................................................................................................................ 438
Using the Safe Disable Function..................................................................................................................................................................... 440
Safe Disable Circuit ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 440
Safe Disable Function Wiring Example.......................................................................................................................................................... 440
Disabling and Enabling the Drive Output ....................................................................................................................................................... 440
Safe Torque Off............................................................................................................................................................................................... 440
22 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Entering the "Safe Torque Off" State ............................................................................................................................................................. 440
Returning to Normal Operation after Safe Disable ........................................................................................................................................ 441
Safe Disable Monitor Output Function and Digital
Operator Display ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 441
Safe Disable Status Monitor........................................................................................................................................................................... 441
Digital Operator Display ................................................................................................................................................................................ 441
EN81-1 Conform Circuit with one Motor Contactor ..................................................................................................................................... 442
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 33G YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 23
YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A
AC Drive for Elevator Applications
Technical Manual
EUROPEAN HEADQUARTERS
YASKAWA EUROPE GmbH
Hauptstrasse 185, 65760 Eschborn, Germany
Phone: +49 (0)6196 569 300 Fax: +49 (0)6196 569 398
E-mail: [email protected] Internet: http://www.yaskawa.eu.com
YASKAWA ENGINEERING EUROPE GmbH
Hauptstrasse 185, 65760 Eschborn, Germany
Phone: +49 (0)6196 569 520 Fax: +49 (0)6196 888 598
E-mail: [email protected] Internet: http://www.yaskawa-eng.eu.com
U.S.A.
YASKAWA AMERICA, INC.
2121 Norman Drive South, Waukegan, IL 60085, U.S.A.
Phone: +1 800 YASKAWA (927-5292) or +1 847 887 7000 Fax: +1 847 887 7310
Internet: http://www.yaskawa.com
JAPAN
YASKAWA ELECTRIC CORPORATION
New Pier Takeshiba South Tower, 1-16-1, Kaigan, Minatoku, Tokyo, 105-6891, Japan
Phone: +81 (0)3 5402 4502 Fax: +81 (0)3 5402 4580
Internet: http://www.yaskawa.co.jp
DRIVE CENTER (INVERTER PLANT)
2-13-1, Nishimiyaichi, Yukuhashi, Fukuoka, 824-8511, Japan
Phone: +81 (0)930 25 3844 Fax: +81 (0)930 25 4369
Internet: http://www.yaskawa.co.jp
In the event that the end user of this product is to be the military and said product is to be employed in any weapons systems or the manufacture thereof,
the export will fall under the relevant regulations as stipulated in the Foreign Exchange and Foreign Trade Regulations. Therefore, be sure to follow all
procedures and submit all relevant documentation according to any and all rules, regulations and laws that may apply.
Specifications are subject to change without notice for ongoing product modifications and improvements.
© 2009-2014 YASKAWA ELECTRIC CORPORATION. All rights reserved.